Omron Printer NT631 User Manual

Cat. No. V063-E1-03  
NT631 and NT631C  
Programmable Terminals  
Setup Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NT631 and NT631C  
Programmable Terminals  
Setup Manual  
Revised September 2007  
POWER  
R
UN  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice:  
OMRON products are manufactured for use according to proper procedures by a qualified operator  
and only for the purposes described in this manual.  
The following conventions are used to indicate and classify precautions in this manual. Always heed  
the information provided with them. Failure to heed precautions can result in injury to people or dam-  
age to property.  
!DANGER  
Indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or  
serious injury. Additionally, there may be severe property damage.  
!WARNING  
!Caution  
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or  
serious injury. Additionally, there may be severe property damage.  
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, may result in minor or  
moderate injury, or property damage.  
OMRON Product References  
All OMRON products are capitalized in this manual. The word “Unit” is also capitalized when it refers to  
an OMRON product, regardless of whether or not it appears in the proper name of the product.  
The abbreviation “Ch,which appears in some displays and on some OMRON products, often means  
“word” and is abbreviated “Wd” in documentation in this sense.  
The abbreviation “PLC” means Programmable Controller. “PC” is used, however, in some Program-  
ming Device displays to mean Programmable Controller.  
Visual Aids  
The following headings appear in the left column of the manual to help you locate different types of  
information.  
Note Indicates information of particular interest for efficient and convenient opera-  
tion of the product.  
1,2,3...  
1. Indicates lists of one sort or another, such as procedures, checklists, etc.  
OMRON, 2000  
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form, or  
by any means, mechanical, electronic, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of  
OMRON.  
No patent liability is assumed with respect to the use of the information contained herein. Moreover, because OMRON is con-  
stantly striving to improve its high-quality products, the information contained in this manual is subject to change without  
notice. Every precaution has been taken in the preparation of this manual. Nevertheless, OMRON assumes no responsibility  
for errors or omissions. Neither is any liability assumed for damages resulting from the use of the information contained in  
this publication.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
2
3
Intended Audience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
General Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
xvi  
xvi  
xvi  
SECTION 1  
1-1 Role and Operation of the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2 Functions of the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-3 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4 Communications with the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-5 Communications Using Memory Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-6 Before Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2
4
16  
18  
21  
23  
SECTION 2  
2-1 Method for Connection to the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2 Names and Functions of Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
26  
29  
SECTION 3  
3-1 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2 Connecting to the Support Tool. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-3 Connecting a Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4 Connecting a Bar Code Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5 Using a Memory Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
32  
35  
36  
36  
39  
SECTION 4  
4-1 Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
48  
SECTION 5  
5-1 Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
5-2 Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
80  
93  
SECTION 6  
6-1 System Menu Operation Flow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-2 Starting the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-3 Operation Modes and the System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4 Memory Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
129  
129  
130  
135  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-5 Operations in the System Installer Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-6 Transmitting the Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-7 Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches. . . . . . . . .  
6-8 Starting Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9 Various System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-10 Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11 System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-12 Programming Console Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-13 Device Monitor Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-14 Version Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
144  
149  
152  
163  
164  
184  
187  
214  
220  
223  
SECTION 7  
7-1 Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-2 Responding to Displayed Error Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-3 Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
226  
229  
235  
A
B
C
D
E
F
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Transporting and Storing the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Making the Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Making the Cable for Connecting a PLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Making the Cable for Connection to a Bar Code Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Making the Cable for Connection to a Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Relationship between system program and hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
245  
255  
259  
265  
267  
271  
273  
275  
277  
281  
G
H
I
J
Revision History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About this Manual:  
This manual describes connecting the NT-series NT631 and NT631C Programmable Terminals (PTs)  
to a PLC (Programmable Controller) or other host and peripheral devices, and the settings required for  
communications and applications. It includes the sections described below.  
Please read this manual carefully and be sure you understand the information provided before  
attempting to install and operate the Programmable Terminal.  
Section 1 provides fundamental information about the functions and features of the PTs, types of con-  
nection, communications methods, etc. This information will enable you to understand the applications  
of the PTs.  
Section 2 describes the connection methods that are possible with the PTs, and the functions of the  
parts of PTs, as the required knowledge before connecting to the host and to the peripheral devices.  
Section 3 describes the settings of the PTs and methods for connection to peripheral devices.  
Section 4 describes the method for connecting to the host using the RS-232C port of the PT.  
Section 5 describes the method for connecting to the host using the RS-422A/485 port of the PT.  
Section 6 describes the operation of the System Menu, focusing on the procedure to start the PT.  
Functions that are convenient when using the PT and those that are useful for system maintenance  
are also explained here.  
Section 7 describes the action to take when errors occur in the PT, and how to carry out maintenance  
and inspection to prevent the occurrence of errors.  
The Appendices provide specifications, dimensions, procedures for using an RS-232C/RS-422A  
Adapter, procedures for transporting and storing the PT, information on cable preparation, information  
on the relationship between the system program and hardware, and product lists.  
!WARNING Failure to read and understand the information provided in this manual may result in per-  
sonal injury or death, damage to the product, or product failure. Please read each section  
in its entirety and be sure you understand the information provided in the section and  
related sections before attempting any of the procedures or operations given.  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Related Manuals:  
Related manuals are listed below.  
The @ symbol at the end of the catalog number is the revision number.  
Connecting and Setting Up the Programmable Terminal  
• NT631 and NT631C PT Setup Manual (V063-E1-@, this manual)  
This manual describes connecting the Programmable Terminals to a host and peripheral devices and  
settings required for communications and applications.  
The functions and actual operating methods for the NT631 and NT631C PTs are provided in the Refer-  
ence Manual (V064-E1-@).  
Programmable Terminal Functions and Operation  
• NT31/31C/631/631C PT Reference Manual (V064-E1-@)  
This manual is used for any of the following PTs: NT31, NT31C, NT631, and NT631C. It describes  
screen configurations, part functions, host control methods, and other application information.  
PT connection and setup procedures are described in the NT631 and NT631C PT Setup Manual  
(V063-E1-@).  
Creating and Transferring Screen Data, and Installing the System Program  
• NT-series Support Tool for Windows Ver. 4.@ Operation Manual (V061-E1-@)  
The screens displayed on the NT631 and NT631C PTs are created with the Support Tool and trans-  
ferred to the PT. This manual describes how to create and transfer screen data. It also describes how  
to download a system program to a PT using the System Installer.  
The NT-series Support Tool for Windows is normally referred to as merely the Support Tool.  
Connecting to Controllers Not Made by OMRON  
• PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@)  
The NT631 and NT631C PTs can be connected to controllers in the following series: Mitsubishi A  
Series and FX Series. This manual describes the connection and setup methods for these controllers.  
The NT-series Support Tool for Windows Version 4.@ is required to connect the NT631 and NT631C  
PTs to these controllers.  
• NT31/NT631 Multi Vendor Connection Manual (V060-E1-@)  
The NT631 and NT631C PTs can be connected to controllers in the following series: Allen-Bradley  
SLC 500 Series, GE Fanuc 90-20 and 90-30 Series, and Siemens S7-300 and S7-400 Series. This  
manual describes the connection and setup methods for these controllers.  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Read and Understand this Manual  
Please read and understand this manual before using the product. Please consult your OMRON  
representative if you have any questions or comments.  
Warranty and Limitations of Liability  
WARRANTY  
OMRON's exclusive warranty is that the products are free from defects in materials and workmanship for a  
period of one year (or other period if specified) from date of sale by OMRON.  
OMRON MAKES NO WARRANTY OR REPRESENTATION, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, REGARDING NON-  
INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, OR FITNESS FOR PARTICULAR PURPOSE OF THE  
PRODUCTS. ANY BUYER OR USER ACKNOWLEDGES THAT THE BUYER OR USER ALONE HAS  
DETERMINED THAT THE PRODUCTS WILL SUITABLY MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF THEIR  
INTENDED USE. OMRON DISCLAIMS ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.  
LIMITATIONS OF LIABILITY  
OMRON SHALL NOT BE RESPONSIBLE FOR SPECIAL, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES,  
LOSS OF PROFITS OR COMMERCIAL LOSS IN ANY WAY CONNECTED WITH THE PRODUCTS,  
WHETHER SUCH CLAIM IS BASED ON CONTRACT, WARRANTY, NEGLIGENCE, OR STRICT  
LIABILITY.  
In no event shall the responsibility of OMRON for any act exceed the individual price of the product on which  
liability is asserted.  
IN NO EVENT SHALL OMRON BE RESPONSIBLE FOR WARRANTY, REPAIR, OR OTHER CLAIMS  
REGARDING THE PRODUCTS UNLESS OMRON'S ANALYSIS CONFIRMS THAT THE PRODUCTS  
WERE PROPERLY HANDLED, STORED, INSTALLED, AND MAINTAINED AND NOT SUBJECT TO  
CONTAMINATION, ABUSE, MISUSE, OR INAPPROPRIATE MODIFICATION OR REPAIR.  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Application Considerations  
SUITABILITY FOR USE  
OMRON shall not be responsible for conformity with any standards, codes, or regulations that apply to the  
combination of products in the customer's application or use of the products.  
At the customer's request, OMRON will provide applicable third party certification documents identifying  
ratings and limitations of use that apply to the products. This information by itself is not sufficient for a  
complete determination of the suitability of the products in combination with the end product, machine,  
system, or other application or use.  
The following are some examples of applications for which particular attention must be given. This is not  
intended to be an exhaustive list of all possible uses of the products, nor is it intended to imply that the uses  
listed may be suitable for the products:  
• Outdoor use, uses involving potential chemical contamination or electrical interference, or conditions or  
uses not described in this manual.  
• Nuclear energy control systems, combustion systems, railroad systems, aviation systems, medical  
equipment, amusement machines, vehicles, safety equipment, and installations subject to separate  
industry or government regulations.  
• Systems, machines, and equipment that could present a risk to life or property.  
Please know and observe all prohibitions of use applicable to the products.  
NEVER USE THE PRODUCTS FOR AN APPLICATION INVOLVING SERIOUS RISK TO LIFE OR  
PROPERTY WITHOUT ENSURING THAT THE SYSTEM AS A WHOLE HAS BEEN DESIGNED TO  
ADDRESS THE RISKS, AND THAT THE OMRON PRODUCTS ARE PROPERLY RATED AND  
INSTALLED FOR THE INTENDED USE WITHIN THE OVERALL EQUIPMENT OR SYSTEM.  
PROGRAMMABLE PRODUCTS  
OMRON shall not be responsible for the user's programming of a programmable product, or any  
consequence thereof.  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disclaimers  
CHANGE IN SPECIFICATIONS  
Product specifications and accessories may be changed at any time based on improvements and other  
reasons.  
It is our practice to change model numbers when published ratings or features are changed, or when  
significant construction changes are made. However, some specifications of the products may be changed  
without any notice. When in doubt, special model numbers may be assigned to fix or establish key  
specifications for your application on your request. Please consult with your OMRON representative at any  
time to confirm actual specifications of purchased products.  
DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS  
Dimensions and weights are nominal and are not to be used for manufacturing purposes, even when  
tolerances are shown.  
PERFORMANCE DATA  
Performance data given in this manual is provided as a guide for the user in determining suitability and does  
not constitute a warranty. It may represent the result of OMRON's test conditions, and the users must  
correlate it to actual application requirements. Actual performance is subject to the OMRON Warranty and  
Limitations of Liability.  
ERRORS AND OMISSIONS  
The information in this manual has been carefully checked and is believed to be accurate; however, no  
responsibility is assumed for clerical, typographical, or proofreading errors, or omissions.  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xiv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRECAUTIONS  
This section provides general precautions for using the Programmable Terminal.  
The information contained in this section is important for the safe and reliable application of the Programmable  
Terminal. You must read this section and understand the information contained before attempting to set up or operate  
a Programmable Terminal.  
2
3
General Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
xvi  
xvi  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Intended Audience  
1
1
Intended Audience  
This manual is intended for the following personnel, who must also have  
knowledge of electrical systems (an electrical engineer or the equivalent).  
• Personnel in charge of introducing FA systems into production facilities.  
• Personnel in charge of designing FA systems.  
• Personnel in charge of installing and connecting FA systems.  
• Personnel in charge of managing FA systems and facilities.  
2
General Precautions  
The user must operate the product according to the performance specifica-  
tions described in the operation manuals.  
Before using the product under conditions which are not described in the  
manual or applying the product to nuclear control systems, railroad systems,  
aviation systems, vehicles, combustion systems, medical equipment, amuse-  
ment machines, safety equipment, and other systems, machines and equip-  
ment that may have a serious influence on lives and property if used  
improperly, consult your OMRON representative.  
Make sure that the ratings and performance characteristics of the product are  
sufficient for the systems, machines, and equipment, and be sure to provide  
the systems, machines, and equipment with double safety mechanisms.  
This manual provides information for using the Programmable Terminal. Be  
sure to read this manual before attempting to use the software and keep this  
manual close at hand for reference during operation.  
!WARNING It is extremely important that Programmable Terminals and related devices be  
used for the specified purpose and under the specified conditions, especially  
in applications that can directly or indirectly affect human life. You must con-  
sult with your OMRON representative before applying Programmable Termi-  
nals to the above-mentioned applications.  
!WARNING Do not use input functions such as PT touch switches for applications where  
danger to human life or serious damage is possible, or for emergency switch  
applications.  
3
Safety Precautions  
Read these safety precautions carefully and make sure you understand them  
before using the Programmable Terminal so that you can use it safely and cor-  
rectly.  
Safety Conventions and their Meanings  
This operation manual uses the following conventions and symbols to indicate  
cautions, warnings, and dangers in order to ensure safe use of the NT631/  
631C.  
The cautions, warnings, and dangers shown here contain important informa-  
tion related to safety. This instructions in these cautions, warnings, and dan-  
gers must be observed.  
The conventions used and their meanings are presented below.  
xvi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Safety Precautions  
3
!WARNING Indicates information that, if not heeded, could possibly result in loss of life or  
serious injury.  
!Caution Indicates information that, if not heeded, could result in relatively serious or  
minor injury, damage to the product, or faulty operation.  
WARNING  
Do not attempt to take the unit apart and do not touch any  
internal parts while the power is being supplied. Doing either  
of these may result in electrical shock.  
WARNING  
Switch OFF the NT631C power before replacing the  
backlight. Otherwise you could sustain an electric shock.  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Precautions  
3
xviii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 1  
General  
This section provides fundamental information about the functions and features of the NT631/NT631C, types of  
connection, communications methods, etc. This information will enable you to understand the applications of the  
1-1 Role and Operation of the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-1-1 Operation of an NT631/NT631C at an FA Production Site. . . . . . .  
1-1-2 Operations of the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2 Functions of the NT631/NT631C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2-1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2-2 Comparison between NT631 and NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2-3 Comparison between NT620S/NT620C/NT625C and NT631/NT631C  
1-2-4 Principal Functions of NT631/NT631C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-2-5 Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-3 System Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-3-1 Peripheral Devices That Can Be Connected . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-3-2 Connecting to the Host. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4 Communications with the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4-1 Direct Connection Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4-2 Host Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4-3 NT Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-4-4 Connecting to Other Companies’ PLCs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-5 Communications Using Memory Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-5-1 Memory Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-5-2 Comparison between Direct Connection and Memory Link . . . . . .  
1-5-3 Memory Link Online Transfer Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
1-6 Before Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2
2
3
4
4
7
8
10  
12  
16  
17  
18  
18  
18  
19  
19  
21  
21  
21  
22  
22  
23  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Role and Operation of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-1  
1-1 Role and Operation of the NT631/NT631C  
The NT631/NT631C is a sophisticated display unit (Programmable Terminal)  
which automatically displays information and can also be used for operations  
when necessary. The following gives a general description of the role and  
operation of the NT631/NT631C for those using a programmable terminal  
(PT) for the first time.  
1-1-1 Operation of an NT631/NT631C at an FA Production Site  
Production Line Status  
Monitoring  
The NT631/NT631C displays real-time information about the system and  
equipment operating status, etc. Its power of expression is enhanced by  
graphs and other visuals, making the displays easy to understand.  
Directions to Workers on  
the Shop Floor  
The NT631/NT631C warns of system or equipment failures and prompts the  
appropriate remedial action.  
Alarm  
Assembly line B  
Positioning pin  
is defective. Line stopped.  
Check the following.  
1. Defective pin L3  
2. Position of dog M2  
3. Mounting of photosensor P5  
Panel Switch Functions  
Setting touch switches on the NT631/NT631C allows workers to use the  
NT631/NT631C as an operating panel; the results of the operations are trans-  
mitted to the host.  
Electroplating control  
Wash. Corr. prv.  
Electr.  
head  
Transport  
head  
head  
Clamp  
Unclamp  
Adv.  
Rev.  
Corr.  
prv.fluid  
Electro-  
lyte  
Wash  
Int. stop  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Role and Operation of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-1  
1-1-2 Operations of the NT631/NT631C  
Displays Screens  
The information to be displayed (screen data) can be created on a computer  
using the Support Tool and stored in the NT631/NT631C. The screen data  
can be displayed on the NT631/NT631C in response to instructions from the  
host or touch switch operation.  
Host  
The screen data designated by  
instructions from the host or touch  
switch operation is displayed.  
Receives Data from a Host  
Sends Data to a Host  
Screen Data  
The NT631/NT631C can be connected to the host by a host link or NT link  
and receive necessary data from the host.  
Host Link, NT link  
Host  
Data input using the touch panel (switch ON/OFF statuses, numeric values,  
character strings) can be transmitted to the host.  
Host  
Touch panel  
ON/OFF information, numeric  
data, etc.  
The screen data to be displayed on the NT631/NT631C can be created on a  
personal computer using the Support Tool. Connect the NT631/NT631C to  
the personal computer with an RS-232C cable and transmit the screen data to  
the NT631/NT631C.  
Create screen data.  
RS-232C  
Personal  
computer  
(Support Tool)  
Screen data  
When the host is connected at serial port A,  
the personal computer is only connected  
when communicating screen data between  
the NT631/NT631C and Support Tool.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
1-2 Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
The NT631/NT631C has the following features.  
1-2-1 Features  
Slim Body  
• High-performance in a low-profile body (50 mm or less in the panel*).  
• The communications cable connectors are housed in the PT so that they  
do not protrude from the PT.  
* When mounted in a panel of the recommended thickness (page 32).  
Construction Best Suited  
to the FA Environment  
• The display panel is provided with a high-contrast monochrome EL dis-  
play for the NT631-ST211@-EV2, an STN color LCD display with back-  
light for the NT631C-ST141@-EV2, and a TFT color LCD high-definition  
display for NT631C-ST153@-EV3.  
• The backlight unit and battery can be replaced at the operation site. (The  
backlight for the NT631C-ST153@-EV3, however, cannot be replaced by  
the user.)  
• Protection equivalent to oil-proof IP65*, and waterproof structure equiva-  
lent to the NEMA4 standard*.  
* The panel may not be usable in environments where it is exposed to oil  
for long periods.  
640 dots  
POWER  
RUN  
480 dots  
Wide angle of visibility  
Touch Switch Operation  
Contrast and brightness are adjustable by touch switch operations (for  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2 only).  
Compatibility with Other  
PTs  
• There is upward compatibility between the NT631/NT631C and the follow-  
ing models for screen data and user programs: NT11S, NT20S, NT30,  
NT30C, NT31, NT31 NT600S, NT610G, NT610C, NT620S, NT620C,  
NT625C. (After being read to the Support Tool, screens must be modified  
in accordance with the screen size. Depending on the function used, par-  
tial modification of programs may also be necessary. For details on the  
compatibility of screen data, refer to the NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C  
Programmable Terminal Reference Manual and the NT-series Support  
Tool Operation Manual.  
• The dimensions of the panel cut-out to accommodate the NT631/NT631C  
are the same as for the NT625C.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Two Ports Featured as  
Standard:  
Port A for Common Use by Support Tool/Host and Port B for Exclusive  
Use by the Host  
• Communications with the host is possible via another port while con-  
nected to the Support Tool.  
• Reading bar code data from a bar code reader is possible via another port  
while communicating with the host.  
Rapid System Program &  
Screen Data Changes  
Possible Using a Memory  
Unit.  
• Installing a Memory Unit (type NT-MF261) on the rear of the NT631/  
NT631C makes it easy to write screen data into the NT631/NT631C on  
site. This enables a rapid response to setup changes.  
• NT631/NT631C can store a system program into a Memory Unit. This  
enables the system to handle more flexible setups.  
Screen Data Check  
Function  
Screen data can be checked simply by operations at the NT631/NT631C sys-  
tem menu, without connecting up to the Support Tool.  
Large Increase in  
Maximum Number of  
Registered Elements  
The number of elements that can be registered on one screen has been con-  
siderably increased, making it possible to create more expressive screens.  
For details, refer to Display Restrictions in Appendix A Specifications of the  
NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C Programmable Terminal Reference Manual.  
Binary Data can be Read  
to/Written from the Host  
It is now possible to write binary data stored in words at the host directly to the  
NT631/NT631C. This makes data conversion by a program at the host unnec-  
essary, reducing the load on the host.  
Character Display Using  
High Definition Fonts  
Any quadrupled characters are displayed with a 32 dot high-definition font.  
Simple Version Upgrades  
By using the system installer supplied with the Support Tool (Type NT-  
ZJCAT1-EV4), the system program at the NT631/NT631C can be changed  
easily from a personal computer.  
Complies with  
International Standards  
The NT631/NT631C meets UL/CSA standards and EC directives.  
Compatible with Other  
Vendors’ Devices  
Compatible with Sequencers in the following series: Mitsubishi A-series (Cal-  
culator Link) and FX-series (Programming Console), Allen-Bradley SLC 500  
Series, GE Fanuc 90-20 and 90-30 Series, and Siemens S7-300 and S7-400  
Series. Specialized system programs can be installed that allow the NT631/  
NT631C to be controlled from other companies’ Sequencers.  
Multiple Windows  
Up to 3 windows can be displayed simultaneously in the normal screen. A 9-  
word window control area has been allocated to the host; the contents of  
these 9 words can be changed from the Host to open, close, and move win-  
dows.  
High-speed 1:N NT Link  
The V2 versions are compatible with the high-speed 1:N NT Link as well as  
the earlier standard 1:N NT Link.  
Additional Mathematical  
Functions  
Operands (values referenced by formula) can be registered to allow the PT to  
perform calculations automatically and write the results of those calculations  
to numeral memory tables or words in the host.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Device Monitor Function  
The new device monitor function can be used to change the PLC’s operating  
mode or display/change values in the PLC’s memory areas. The present val-  
ues (PVs) of several words can be listed with the device monitor.  
Interlock Function  
PT operations and inputs can be disabled from the PLC if interlock bits have  
been allocated in the PLC for the corresponding PT touch switches, numeric  
inputs, or string inputs.  
Improved Lamp/Touch  
Switch Labels  
The following displays can be performed with lamp or touch switch labels:  
• Display several lines of labels.  
• Switch the display between different labels when OFF and ON.  
• Display the numeral memory table contents as labels.  
• Display the string memory table contents as labels.  
NT30/NT30C and NT620S/  
NT620C/NT625C  
Emulation  
The word configuration of the PT status control area and PT status notify area  
can be set to emulate those of the NT30/NT30C or NT620S/NT620C/  
NT625C; this mode is called NT30/620 compatible mode.  
When the PT is operating in NT30/620 compatible mode, it will be equivalent  
to an NT30/NT30C or NT620S/NT620C/NT625C in the functions listed below.  
The PT retains full V2 functionality in all functions other than the ones listed  
below. Refer to Appendix C in the NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C Programma-  
ble Terminal Reference Manual for more details.  
• Word configuration and functions of the PT status control area and PT  
status notify area  
• Image/library codes  
• Insertion of image/library data into character strings  
Additional CS/CJ-series  
Data Areas Accessible  
Data areas in CS/CJ-series PLCs that were previously inaccessible can be  
accessed. The data areas listed below can be accessed (read/written).  
All banks in the EM area, timer completion flags (TU), counter completion  
flags (CU), Work areas (WR), Task flags (TK), and the HR area.  
Recipe Function  
You can set the data (numeric values) for multiple words in record units using  
the tabular elements on the PT screen, and write these settings in a single  
operation to words on the host (i.e., PLC or PT memory) using a touch switch  
operation on the PT Unit. Also, multiple words of numeric data can be read  
from the host in one operation. In this way, groups of parameter settings can  
be edited at the PT Unit, and written to or read from the host.  
Adjusting Contrast and  
Brightness During PT  
Operation  
You can display the brightness and contrast adjustment screen using either  
the touch switch or commands from the host, even while the PT is in opera-  
tion.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
1-2-2 Comparison between NT631 and NT631C  
Two NT631 models — the NT631, which is capable of versatile graphic dis-  
plays (EL display, yellow), and the NT631C, which is also capable of color dis-  
play — are available. The differences between the NT631 and NT631C are  
tabled below:  
Function  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2  
NT631C-ST153@-EV3  
Type  
NT631-ST211-EV2 (Beige)  
NT631-ST211B-EV2 (Black)  
NT631C-ST141-EV2 (Beige)  
NT631C-ST141B-EV2 (Black) NT631C-ST153B-EV3 (Black)  
NT631C-ST153-EV3 (Beige)  
Display  
panel  
Monochrome EL display  
STN color LCD display  
(with white backlight)  
TFT color LCD display  
(with white backlight)  
Beige and black are the front panel colors of each NT631/NT631C types.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
1-2-3 Comparison between NT620S/NT620C/NT625C and NT631/  
NT631C  
Item  
Support Tool used  
DIP switches  
NT620S/NT620C/NT625C  
NT-ZJCAT1-EV4 or NT-ZA3AT-EV2  
On rear of PT  
NT631/NT631C  
NT-ZJCAT1-EV4  
None (software settings)  
Possible  
Use of Memory Unit  
RS-232C interface  
Not possible  
Connector (9-pin) also used as port for - Serial port A connector (also used for screen  
screen data transfer.  
data transfer, 9-pin)  
- Serial port B connector (for host communica-  
tions only, 9-pin)  
RS-422A/485 interface  
NT620S/NT620C: None  
Terminal block (serial port B; memory-switch  
selectable between RS232C and RS-422A/485)  
NT625C: Terminal block (DIP-switch  
selectable between RS232C and RS-  
422A/485)  
Replacement backlight  
NT620C-CFL01 (NT620C)  
NT610C-CFL02 (NT625C)  
NT631C-CFL01 (for ST151; the backlight for the  
NT631C-ST152@-EV2, NT631C-ST153@-EV3,  
however, cannot be replaced by the user)  
NT631C-CFL02 (for ST141)  
NT631/NT631C system pro-  
gram data  
NT620-ZS3AT-EV1/EMV1  
(including system installer)  
The system installer and system program data  
are supplied with the Support Tool.  
High-speed 1:N NT Link  
Not possible  
Possible  
Memory  
Link  
System program Exclusive use by Memory Link  
Same as OMRON connection  
Exclusive use by Memory Link  
Screen data  
Shared with OMRON connection  
By a control on the rear of the PT  
LCD contrast adjustment  
By touch panel operation  
(Possible in the NT631-ST141@-V2 only.)  
Backlight brightness adjust-  
ment  
Not possible  
By touch panel operation  
(Possible in the NT631-ST141@-V2 only.)  
Number of user-registered  
Maximum of 2000  
Maximum of 3999  
screens  
Screen data capacity*1  
(User program memory)  
Numeral string data  
Character string data  
Bit data  
NT620S: 512 KB  
NT620C/NT625C: 1 MB  
1 MB  
Maximum of 1000  
Maximum of 1000  
256  
Maximum of 2000  
Maximum of 2000  
Maximum of 1000  
Mathematical tables  
None  
256 max.  
Calculations can be executed automatically in  
the PT.  
Maximum of 4095*2  
Maximum of 12288*2  
Image data  
Library data  
Maximum of 224  
Maximum of 896  
Method for storing numeric  
values  
Fixed as BCD (binary coded decimal) Selectable from BCD (binary coded decimal) or  
binary  
(numeral memory data and PT  
status control area)  
5 words (partial change of contents)*2  
4 words  
2 words (partial change of contents)*2  
3 words  
PT status control area size  
PT status notify area size  
Window control area size  
None  
9 CH  
Registering continuous screen Possible  
Not possible (Use a screen switchover as a sub-  
stitute.)  
Lamp/Touch switch labels Fixed display (1 line only)  
- Multiple lines can be displayed  
- ON/OFF switching is possible  
- Numeral display is possible  
- Character string display is possible  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Item  
NT620S/NT620C/NT625C  
NT631/NT631C  
Interlock function  
None  
Operations can be disabled from the PLC by  
allocating interlock bits to the corresponding  
touch switch, numeral input, or character string  
input.  
Device monitor function  
Recipe function  
Not possible  
None  
Possible  
Possible  
Accessible CS/CJ-series PLC ---  
data areas  
The data areas listed below can be accessed in  
addition to the data areas accessible with the  
NT30/NT30C.  
- EM banks (EM_0 to EM_C)  
- Timer completion flags (TU)  
- Counter completion flags (CU)  
- Work areas (WR)  
- Task flags (TK)  
- HR area  
*1 This is the capacity of the flash memory that stores screen data.  
*2 The values are the same as the NT30/NT30C when the PT is in NT30/620 compatible mode.  
For differences in programming, refer to Appendix B in the NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C Programmable Termi-  
nal Reference Manual.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
1-2-4 Principal Functions of NT631/NT631C  
The following are the principal functions of the NT631/NT631C.  
Functions relating to data display  
Character display  
Characters of various sizes can be displayed. Characters can be flashed and displayed in reverse  
video. High grade fonts are available for the characters with their size enlarged.  
Graphic display  
Polylines, rectangles, polygons, circles, circular arcs, and sector shapes can be displayed.  
They can also be tiled with various patterns, flashed, or displayed in reverse video.  
Memory data display  
The contents of character string memory tables and numeral memory tables can be displayed.  
The contents of memory tables can be changed from the host.  
Graph display  
Not only bar graphs but also broken line graphs, trend graphs, and analogue meter graphs can  
be displayed using numeral memory tables  
Lamp display  
Lamps can be turned on and flashed under the control of the host. It is also possible to display  
different graphics in the ON and OFF states.  
Alarm list/history display  
Warning messages are automatically displayed in a list in response to the state of a host bit. The  
time and the number of times of the messages appeared can also be displayed.  
Functions relating to data output  
Buzzer  
A built-in buzzer can be sounded.  
Screen printing  
A hard copy of the currently displayed screen can be printed at the  
printer connected to the NT631/NT631C.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Functions relating to data input  
Input by touch switches  
Data can be input by simply touching touch switches displayed on the screen.  
The possible functions of touch switches include sending data to the host and changing the screen display.  
Inputs can be enabled and disabled from the host when interlock bits have been allocated.  
Pop-up window function  
A window overlaying the currently displayed screen can be alternately opened and closed by pressing a touch  
switch.In addition to fixed character and graphic displays, control keys and character keys created as touch  
switches can also be set inside the window.  
A maximum of three windows can be displayed simultaneously.  
Since the window need only be opened when input is required, the screen can be used efficiently.  
Numeral/character string setting function  
Numeric keys and character keys can be assigned to touch switches so that numeric values and character strings  
can be input at the operation site.  
The input data is written to numeral/character string memory tables and also sent to the host. It is also possible to  
disable input by control from the host.  
Recipe function  
Several words of numeric data can be edited at the PT Unit, and written to or read from the host in one operation.  
Input from a bar code reader  
Data read with a bar code reader can be input to a character string input field.  
Functions relating to communications  
Communications with the host  
The NT631/NT631C can communicate with the host by four methods: host link, 1:1 NT link, 1:N NT link (standard  
or high-speed), and Memory link. Data can be read from the host, and data input by means of touch switches and  
numeral/character string settings can be sent to the host. It is also possible to connect with other model PCs.  
Functions relating to the system  
System menu  
System settings and maintenance can be performed by selecting from system menus displayed on the screen.  
Creation of screen data  
Screen data created using the Support Tool at a personal computer can be transferred and stored in the built-in screen  
data memory.  
Resume function  
The status and memory table contents of the NT631/NT631C immediately before its operation is stopped can be stored  
while operation is stopped, or while the power is off, and then displayed on the screen again when operation is restarted.  
Screen saver function  
This function serves to extend the service life of the backlight and EL and prevent the formation of an afterimage on the screen.  
Clock function  
The time can be displayed in accordance with the internal clock data.  
Programming Console function  
When the NT631/NT631C is connected to a C-series CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, or C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z)E Programmable Controller in an NT link (1:1) connection, or is connected to CS/CJ-series in an NT link (1:N)  
connection, operations equivalent to those of a Programming Console (C200H-PR027-E) are possible.  
Device Monitor function  
When the PT is connected to a PLC in a 1:1 NT Link or 1:N NT Link, the PT can be used for operations such as  
changing the PLC's operating mode, displaying or changing the PVs of words, or reading the error log.  
System program install function  
The system program of the NT631/NT631C can be changed by using the system installer supplied with the Support Tool  
(NT-ZJ3AT1/ZJCAT-EV2). It can also be installed by using a memory unit (NT-MF261).  
Screen display history function/alarm history function  
The screen display history function records the time at which specific screens are displayed and the number of times  
they are displayed. The alarm history function records the time at which specific bits at the host are turned ON and the  
number of times they are turned ON.  
Trend graph logging function and background function  
Changes in the contents of numeral memory tables displayed in trend graphs can be recorded (logging function). Also, the  
record can be maintained even when the trend graph is not displayed (background function).  
Mathematical function  
This function allows calculations to be executed continuously during PT operation when mathematical table have been set  
in screen data. Arithmetic operations, bit operations, logic operations, and comparison operations can be performed.  
Operations with up to 5 terms are possible.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
1-2-5 Displays  
The NT631/NT631C can display various kinds of elements such as charac-  
ters, numeric values, graphs, lamps, and touch switches, on a screen. The  
screen data displayed by the NT631/NT631C are created by using the Sup-  
port Tool at a personal computer.  
Characters  
(fixed display)  
Touch switches  
Characters  
(character string display)  
Numeric values  
(numeral display)  
Bar graph  
Lamps  
Fixed Displays  
Characters and various graphics (circles, circular arcs, sectors, polylines,  
polygons and rectangles) whose display does not have to be changed, and  
mark data, image data, and library data that has already been registered, can  
be written directly onto the screen.  
Circle  
Arc  
Sector  
Polyline  
Polygon  
Rectangle  
* A polygon with up to  
255 vertices can be  
drawn.  
* A continuous straight line  
with up to 256 points can  
be drawn.  
Marks are graphics comprising 16 by 16 dots that can be used as characters.  
They can be used as custom characters within character strings.  
Image data are graphics comprising any required area of dots. They are regis-  
tered in advance and as many as required can be displayed at any position on  
the screen.  
Windows bit map (BMP) data can be used for images.  
There is a two-color mode, in which the display color and background color of  
the image are specified when it is registered in a screen, and an eight-color  
mode in which colors are assigned to the image in advance.  
Since image data is composed of dots, it requires a large data size but offers  
great powers of expression.  
Library data are combinations of fixed display graphics registered as a single  
graphic. They are registered in advance and as many as required can be dis-  
played at any position on the screen.  
Since it is generated by combining graphics, library data has a small data  
size.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Mark  
Image data  
Library data  
Lamps  
These are graphics whose display status changes in accordance with the  
states of bits at the host. Squares, circles, sectors and polygons can be used  
for lamps (normal (standard) lamps). In accordance with the status of the host  
bit, they can be lit (displayed in reverse video) or flashed (repeated alternation  
between normal and reverse video display states).  
Lamps can also display different image/library data for the ON and OFF states  
of the host bit (such lamps are called image/library lamps).  
There are four standard lamp labels: fixed display character strings, ON/OFF  
switching character strings, numeral displays, and character string displays.  
When fixed display character strings or ON/OFF switching character strings  
are used, several lines of labels can be displayed.  
Normal (Standard) Lamps  
ON  
ON  
Host  
Unlit state  
Lit state  
Image/Library Lamps  
ON  
Host  
Unlit state  
Lit state  
Touch Switches  
These switches can be set at any location on the screen. Pressing a touch  
switch on the screen where a touch switch has been set can have the follow-  
ing effects:  
Notification to a host bit (input notification function)  
Changing the displayed screen (screen switching function)  
Input of a numeric value or character string (input key function)  
Copying of a numeric value or character string (copy key function)  
Shifting to another numeric value or character string input field (cursor  
moving key function)  
Obtaining a hard copy of the screen (screen print function)  
Opening / Closing a window  
Moving a window  
Touch switches can be made to light or flash in accordance with the status of  
a host bit in the same way as lamps.  
The following 8 types of display graphic can be used for touch switches:  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Standard, shadow, 3-dimension, no display frame, rectangle, circle, poly-  
gon, sector  
When rectangle, circle, polygon, or sector is selected as the shape, the area  
within which pressing of the touch switch is sensed (the touch switch area)  
can be set independently of the position where the display graphic is set.  
When this  
Shown  
Touch  
switch area  
position is  
pressed...  
in  
reverse  
video  
Display  
frame  
Function executed  
There are four touch-switch labels: fixed display character strings, ON/OFF  
switching character strings, numeral displays, and character string displays.  
When fixed display character strings or ON/OFF switching character strings  
are used, several lines of labels can be displayed.  
Numeral Display  
Numeric values stored in the numeral memory tables are displayed. The dis-  
played numerals can be changed by changing the data stored in the numeral  
memory tables.  
Hexadecimal values can also be displayed.  
When decimal values are displayed, the number of digits for the integral part  
and fractional part of displayed values can be specified in advance.  
String Display  
Numeral Input  
Character strings stored in the character string memory tables are displayed.  
The displayed character strings can be changed by changing the data stored  
in the character string memory tables.  
Numeric values can be input at the PT by using touch switches. The input  
numeric values can also be stored in a numeral memory table and notification  
sent to the host.  
Numeral inputs can be enabled and disabled from the host when an interlock  
bit has been allocated.  
12345678  
7 8 9  
4 5 6  
1 2 3  
"
Input  
0 .  
Window  
String Input  
Character strings can be input at the PT by using touch switches, bar code  
readers, etc. The input character strings can also be stored in a character  
string memory table and notification sent to the host.  
String inputs can be enabled and disabled from the host when an interlock bit  
has been allocated.  
Character string setting input field  
Display  
NT631C  
Input  
NT31C  
NT631C NT631  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 1-2  
Thumbwheel Switches  
Numeric values can be input by incrementing or decrementing each digit with  
the corresponding touch switch (+, –). The input numeric values can also be  
stored in a numeral memory table and notification sent to the host.  
Thumbwheel switch inputs can be enabled and disabled from the host when  
an interlock bit has been allocated.  
Graphs  
These are graphics whose display changes in accordance with the numeric  
values stored in numeral memory tables. There are the following four types.  
Bar graphs:  
Bar graphs display the present value in a numeral memory table converted to  
a percentage within the range –100% to +100% of a preset value.  
60%  
Analogue meter:  
Analogue meters display, using a quarter, half, or full circle shape, the present  
value in a numeral memory table converted to a percentage within the range –  
100% to +100% of the preset value. Users can choose from moving pointer  
type and filling area type displays. Users can also add graduation to the  
graph.  
60%  
Broken line graphs:  
Broken line graphs display, in an easy-to-read form, a sequence of numeral  
memory table values converted to a percentage within the range –100% to  
+100% of a preset value.  
100%  
Example showing a series of  
0%  
11 numeral memory table  
values (with a check mark  
set for the display sign)  
100%  
Trend graphs:  
Trend graphs display chronological changes in the value in a numeral memory  
table, converting the value to a percentage within the range –100% to +100%  
of a preset value. The trend graph shifts position with the passage of time.  
Past data can also be recorded, and the numeral memory table can be read  
(sampled) even while the trend graph is not being displayed.  
The user can choose to stop sampling, restart sampling, or display past data,  
by pressing touch switches.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Configuration  
Section 1-3  
Alarm List/History  
The alarm list/history function displays messages in list form, or graphics  
(image/library data), in accordance with changes in bit memory table sta-  
tuses.  
For the alarm list, a series of bit memory tables are monitored, and messages  
(contents of character string memory tables) set for bit memory tables that  
come ON are displayed.  
For the alarm history, bit memory tables for which the history property is set  
are continually monitored, and the time when they come ON and number of  
times they come ON are recorded and displayed together with the message  
(character string) set for the bit memory table.  
The NT631/NT631C allows selection of the display order as the newest  
record first or the oldest record first by memory switch setting.  
The alarm list function is used to determine which bits are ON at the present  
time. The alarm history function is used to determine the times at which  
alarms occurred in the past and how many times alarms have occurred  
Alarm List  
Message (character string table No. 32)  
set for bit memory table No. 14  
No.13  
Character string table No. 50  
Image/library data 1002  
HOST  
Bit  
Character string table No. 32  
A000000  
L001003  
D010015  
0
1
0
Character string table No. 32  
Image/library data 113C  
No.14  
No.15  
1(ON)  
Character string table No. 54  
Image/library data 1125  
Image/library  
data 113C  
When the message displayed is pressed, the image/library  
data (113C) set for bit memory table No. 14 is displayed.  
Alarm History  
Message (character string table No. 13)  
set for bit memory table No. 24  
Recorded data  
Character string table No. 11  
Bit memory table No. 24  
97/12/04 11:19:20  
No. 22  
Character string table No. 13  
Character string table No. 12  
Image/library data 005F  
Character string table No. 12 No. 23  
Image/library data 102A  
Bit memory table No. 23  
97/12/04 11:25:12  
Image/library  
data 102B  
Character string table No. 13  
Image/library data 102B  
No. 24  
When the upper message displayed is pressed, the image/library  
data (102B) set for bit memory table No. 13 is displayed.  
Recipe  
You can set several words of numeric data at the PT in tabular format, and  
write it to the host. You can also read several words of numeric data from the  
host and display it on the PT screen.  
1-3 System Configuration  
This section shows the configuration of a system that uses an NT631/  
NT631C. For details on product models, refer to Appendix J Model List  
(page 281).  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Configuration  
Section 1-3  
1-3-1 Peripheral Devices That Can Be Connected  
The following peripheral devices can be connected to an NT631/NT631C.  
Host  
Controls the NT631/NT631C as required while controlling machines and  
monitoring the production line.  
Host Link: CS/CJ-series, C-series, and CVM1/CV-series PLC, and SRM1  
Can be connected to CPU Units, Host Link Units, and SRM1.  
However, connection is not possible to some models of CPU  
Unit and SRM1.  
Bar code reader  
Bar codes can be read  
as character strings.  
NT link: CS/CJ-series, C-series, and CVM1/CV-series PLC, and SRM1  
Can be connected to CPU Units and SRM1. However,  
connection is not possible to some models.  
Memory link: Can be connected to a personal computer, FA computer, etc.  
Other companies' PLCs can also be connected.  
RS-232C cable  
(max. 15 m) or  
RS-422A/485 cable  
(max. 500 m)  
Printer  
For printing out the  
currently displayed  
NT631/NT631C screen.  
Personal computer  
Running Windows 95/98/NT  
Support Tool  
Used to create screens for the  
NT631/NT631C at the personal  
computer and transmit them to  
the NT631/NT631C, and to  
make NT631/NT631C settings.  
System installer  
Used to change the system  
program of the NT631/NT631C.  
Memory unit  
NT631/NT631C  
Can store screen data  
and system program to  
be read out  
Displays production line monitoring and  
instructions to the operation site, and  
notifies the host of the switch ON/OFF  
status and numeric value inputs.  
When a 1:N NT Link is being used, up  
to 8 PTs can be connected to a single  
PLC.  
automatically at  
startup.  
• Bar code reader (page 36)  
• Recommended printers (page 36)  
It is also possible to use printers that can emulate an NEC PC-PR201H  
(using the NEC PC-PR201PL control protocol), and printers that comply  
with one of the following EPSON control standards: ESC/P 24-J83C (col-  
or), or ESC/P 24-J82 (monochrome).  
• Memory Unit (page 39)  
• NT-MF261 (made by OMRON)  
• Support Tool (page 35)  
NT-series Support Tool Version 4.@ for Windows (Made by OMRON)  
• NT-ZJCAT1-EV4 (CD-ROM version)  
• System installer (page 35)  
• System installer (made by OMRON)  
The system installer is supplied as a standard accessory with the Support  
Tool (NT-ZJCAT1-EV4).  
Reference:  
The following optional devices are available. All of them can be used either  
with NT631 or NT631C.  
Anti-reflective Protective  
Sheet (5 pcs/set)  
NT610C-KBA04  
Chemical-resistant Cover  
Replacement Battery  
NT625-KBA01  
3G2A9-BAT08  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Communications with the Host  
Section 1-4  
1-3-2 Connecting to the Host  
The NT631/NT631C has the following two communications ports.  
The serial port B is equipped with an RS-232C connector and an RS-422A/  
485 terminal block (selectable by memory switch).  
Serial Port A:  
D-SUB 9-pin connector  
For RS-232C use only (The Support Tool and bar code readers can be con-  
nected here.)  
Serial Port B:  
D-SUB 9-pin connector for RS-232C use only (The Support Tool and bar code  
readers can be connected here) or Terminal block for RS-422A/485 use only.  
The host can be connected at either of these two ports.  
The connection methods for each communications method at the PT and host  
sides are indicated below. Make the settings in accordance with the communi-  
cations method that can be used with the PLC to be connected and the condi-  
tions at the operation site.  
Reference:  
When using an RS-232C/422A adapter (NT-AL001) with the host link or NT  
link (1:1) communications method, RS-485 cannot be used. The connection  
must be made with RS-232C or RS-422A.  
1-4 Communications with the Host  
The NT631/NT631C is connected to the host by one of the following commu-  
nications methods.  
The following communications can be used to connect an OMRON PLC:  
• Host Link  
• 1:1 NT Link  
• 1:N NT Link (standard or high-speed)  
The following communications can be used to connect another companies’  
PLC or FA computer:  
• Communications protocol supported by the other company’s PLC  
• Memory link  
In all of these communications methods that can be used with NT631/  
NT631C, data communications with host are by direct connection (Memory  
link is, however, a quasi-direct connection).  
In the following, the host link and NT link that carry out the direct connection  
will be discussed. Memory link will be explained in 1-5 Communications Using  
Memory Links.  
1-4-1 Direct Connection Function  
With the NT631/NT631C, the bits and words referring to data required for dis-  
play, and those for storing input data, can be allocated to any part of the PLC  
memory area.  
The NT631/NT631C can directly write to and read from such allocated bits  
and words to change the display status of the elements on the PT screen,  
control the PT operating status, and notify the host of the status.  
This function, which directly reads and writes the statuses of words and bits  
without using a PLC program is called the direct connection function.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Communications with the Host  
Section 1-4  
The words and bits allocated for direct connection are called the allocated  
words and allocated bits.  
The direct connection function allows the data to be displayed at the NT631/  
NT631C to be read from the memory area in the PLC and written to memory  
tables in the NT631/NT631C. Also, the data input at the NT631/NT631C can  
be written to the memory area in the PLC. The NT631/NT631C screen can be  
changed in accordance with statuses in the PLC memory area, and the  
NT631/NT631C’s status data can be written to the PLC’s memory area.  
PLC  
NT631/NT631C  
DM area  
I/O relay area  
Auxiliary relay area Timers/counters  
Features of the Direct  
Connection Function  
The direct connection function has the following features.  
• The bits and words referring to operating status and work instruction infor-  
mation and those for storing input data can be freely allocated to almost  
any area of the PLC memory.  
• Since the NT631/NT631C can directly refer to PLC bit and word data with-  
out using the program at the PLC, it can be connected to the PLC without  
changing the PLC program which controls the currently running produc-  
tion line.  
• The area to control and provide notification of the NT631/NT631C status,  
including display screens, display/no display status, and buzzer output,  
can be freely allocated to any part of the PLC data area. This means that  
the PLC status can be read and controlled just by reading this area at the  
PLC side, without preparing a special communications program.  
The direct connection function allows the NT631/NT631C to directly read and  
write almost all bits and words in the PLC and to automatically change the  
NT631/NT631C screen display. This function can reduce the load on the PLC  
so that its program development efficiency is improved.  
1-4-2 Host Link  
1-4-3 NT Link  
The host is connected to a PT in a 1:1 connection, and the words and bits of  
the host are read and displayed by host link communications. This method  
can be used for connection to the majority of PLC types.  
NT link is a method for high-speed communications with a PLC using the  
direct connection function. The PLCs that can be connected with the NT link  
are as follows.  
CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, C200HS, C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z)E, CS1G/CS1H-E(V1), CS1D, CJ1G/CJ1H/CJ1M, CVM1/CV-series  
PLC (-EV1 or later version), SRM1  
Besides the 1:1 NT link method, in which one PLC is connected to one PT, the  
NT631/NT631C can also use the 1:N connection NT link method, which  
allows a maximum of eight PTs to be connected to one PLC port.  
PLCs that can be connected with the 1:N connection NT Link method are as  
follows: CQM1H, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CS1G/CS1H-E(V1), CS1D, CJ1G/  
CJ1H/CJ1M.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Communications with the Host  
Section 1-4  
The NT631/NT631C also supports OMRON’s high-speed 1:N NT Link that  
provides faster 1:N communications. The only PLCs that support the high-  
speed 1:N NT Link are CS1G/CS1H PLCs of version -EV1 and higher, CS1D  
PLCs, and CJ1G/CJ1H/CJ1M PLCs.  
In the following sections, the term NT Link is used to refer to the NT Link com-  
munications method in general, the term 1:1 NT Link is used to refer specifi-  
cally to NT Links with a 1:1 connection, and the term 1:N NT Link is used to  
refer to both standard and high speed NT Links with 1:N connections. When  
necessary, the standard 1:N NT Link is distinguished from the high-speed 1:N  
NT Link.  
Features of the NT Link  
The NT link has the following features.  
• High-speed communications with specific types of PLCs can be executed.  
The NT631/NT631C also supports OMRON’s high-speed 1:N NT Link.  
• Writing in units of bits to the PLC memory area is possible.  
This enables the other bits of words to which a touch switch has been al-  
located to be allocated for other purposes (e.g. a lamp).  
However, since data is written to the DM area in word units, the other bits  
of words allocated to touch switches in this area cannot be used for other  
purposes.  
• The NT link can be used even when the PLC is in the RUN mode. (When  
the host link method is used, the NT631/NT631C switches to the monitor  
mode when the PLC is in the RUN mode.)  
• In the case of PTs that support the standard 1:N NT Link (NT20S, NT31,  
NT31C, NT600S, NT620S, NT620C, NT625C, NT631, NT631C) up to 8  
PTs can be connected to one port of the PLC and used at the same time.  
Up to 8 PTs (NT31, NT31C, NT631, and NT631C) can also be connected  
simultaneously when the high-speed 1:N NT Link is being used.  
All of the PTs connected to a PLC port must use either the standard or  
high-speed 1:N NT Link; the two communications systems cannot share a  
single port.  
• When using a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E PLC and standard 1:N NT Links, up  
to three 1:N NT Link systems (i.e., 24 PTs) can be connected by installing  
a Communications Board in the option slot of the CPU Unit. (Only the  
standard 1:N NT Link can be used.) For details on the Communications  
Board, refer to the SYSMAC Communications Board Operation Manual  
(W304-E1-@).  
• When using a CQM1H PLC and standard 1:N NT Links, multiple 1:N NT  
Link systems can be connected by installing Serial Communications  
Boards in the Inner Board slots. For details on the Serial Communications  
Board, refer to the CQM1H Serial Communications Board Operation Man-  
ual (W365-E1-@).  
• Multiple 1:N NT Link systems (standard or high-speed) can be connected  
by installing a Communications Board in the Inner Board slot of the CPU  
Unit for a CS1G/H/D PLC or installing a Serial Communications Unit on  
the Backplane for a CS1G/H/D or a CJ1G/M/H PLC. For details on the  
Communications Board/Communications Unit, refer to the CS/CJ-series  
Serial Communications Board/Unit Operation Manual (W336-E1-@).  
• If the PLC supports the Programming Console function, the NT631/  
NT631C can be used as a Programming Console.  
• If the PLC supports the Device Monitor function, the NT631/NT631C can  
be used to change the PLC’s operating mode and read/change data in the  
PLC’s memory areas.  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communications Using Memory Links  
Section 1-5  
The NT link is compatible with the host link. The NT631/NT631C screen data  
and PLC programs used with the host link direct connection method can be  
used with the NT link method as they are.  
1-4-4 Connecting to Other Companies’ PLCs  
Installing a system program for multi-venders by using a specific system  
installer enables the NT631/NT631C to be connected to the PLCs of other  
models in direct connection. This system installer is supplied with the Support  
Tool (NT-ZJCAT1-EV4).  
Compatible PLC  
The NT631/NT631C can be connected to the following model PLCs.  
• Mitsubishi A-series programmable controller (computer link module)  
• Mitsubishi FX-series programmable controller  
• SLC 500 Series by Allen-Bradley  
• 90-20 and 90-30 Series by GE Fanuc  
• S7-300 and S7-400 Series by Siemens  
For details on the procedure for connecting to other model PLCs, refer to the  
PLC Connection Manual or NT31/631 Multi Vendor Connection Manual.  
1-5 Communications Using Memory Links  
In this section, a communications method other than the direct connection,  
called the memory link, is discussed.  
1-5-1 Memory Link  
Memory link is a method to send and receive data between a personal com-  
puter or a FA computer and the NT631/NT631C by using RS-232C/422A  
communications.  
In memory link, there is an area called PT Memory, as shown below, inside  
the NT631/NT631C, and this area is treated as a virtual area on the PLC. This  
allows PT memory and the display elements of the NT631/NT631C to make a  
quasi-direct connection. By sending a command for the memory link, the host  
can make the NT631/NT631C execute processes through PT memory. Fre-  
quently used commands are kept handy for read and write tasks of the  
numeral memory table, character-string memory table, and bit memory table.  
PT  
PT memory  
Numeral  
memory  
table  
Lamp  
Direct connection  
RS-232C/422A  
communications  
In the memory link method, the only difference is that the NT631/NT631C  
finds its communications target inside instead of outside. In the memory link  
method, therefore, change of the target is all that is needed to be capable of  
using the exact screen data that is acquired by the direct connection. (With  
the NT631/NT631C, the Support Tool must be used to convert the data to  
screen data for the memory link.)  
When compared to the direct connection of the host link or NT link methods,  
the memory link method has some restrictions regarding the use of some  
functions, as described below.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Communications Using Memory Links  
Section 1-5  
• The Programming Console and Device Monitor functions cannot be used.  
• The following strobes of PT status notify bits do not turn ON (pages 7 to  
27).  
• Screen switching strobe  
• Numerals input strobe  
• Character-string input strobe  
• The usable area for allocation is the PT memory only.  
1-5-2 Comparison between Direct Connection and Memory Link  
The major differences between the direct connection and the memory link are  
as follows:  
1,2,3...  
1. In the memory link method, the communications with the host should be  
carried out by using commands. Compared to the ordinal direct connec-  
tion, which can be used requiring almost no programs, the memory link  
method requires a program that is necessary for interchange of com-  
mands.  
This, however, gives advantages to the memory link method by using a  
large variety of functions available in the direct connections from major  
models such as a personal computer and a FA computer equipped with  
RS-232C/RS-422A communications means, allowing the PT to be suited  
for larger usage.  
2. Actual PLCs have many kinds of areas, where as PT memory is a single  
area with only one kind. When creating screen data by using the memory  
link methods, it is always necessary to allocate display parts in the PT  
memory.  
For communications between the host and the PT by the memory link method  
and for handling screen display elements, refer to the NT31/NT31C/NT631/  
NT631C Programmable Terminal Reference Manual.  
1-5-3 Memory Link Online Transfer Function  
When memory link communications are being used, the NT631/NT631C can  
be switched to Transmit mode from the host even if the NT631/NT631C is  
operating and screen data can be written. (The NT631/NT631C can be  
returned to RUN mode after the screen data is written.)  
The memory link online transfer function can be used to replace screen data  
at a fixed time each day or replace screen data with maintenance screen data  
for maintenance.  
For more details on the memory link online transfer function, refer to informa-  
tion on the memory link online transfer function in the NT31/NT31C/NT631/  
NT631C Programmable Terminal Reference Manual.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Before Operating  
Section 1-6  
1-6 Before Operating  
Follow the procedure given below to start the system of the NT631/NT631C.  
Host  
Support Tool  
NT631/NT631C  
Set the host settings.  
Install the Support  
Tool at the computer.  
Install the PT in the  
operation panel.  
• For the host link, refer to  
pages 48 and 94, and the  
manuals for the Host Link  
Unit and Programming  
Devices.  
(page 32)  
(Refer to the manual for  
the Support Tool.)  
Connect the power supply.  
(page 33)  
• For the NT link (1:1), refer  
to pages 61 and 106.  
Install the system program.*1  
• For the NT link (1:N), refer  
• For the high-speed NT  
link (1:N), refer to pages  
70 and 112.  
(Refer to page 145 and the  
Support Tool manual)  
system installer mode.*2  
Create the screens.  
• For the Memory link, refer  
(Refer to the NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C  
Programmable Terminal Reference Manual  
and the Support Tool Operation Manual.)  
(page 144)  
(page 149)  
Transmit the screen data.  
Set the memory switches.  
(page 152)  
Connect to the host.  
Connect to the  
NT631/NT631C.  
When RS-232C used at the PT: refer to section 4  
When RS-422A/485 used at the PT: refer to section 5  
Confirm the settings and  
check communications.  
Create the host program.  
Start operation.  
*1 System program installation is only done in special circumstances, for  
example when changing the system program, or to recover the original sta-  
tus of the installed program. This operation is not normally necessary.  
When using other PLC models (sequencers), however, it is necessary to  
install specific system programs.  
*2 Display of the system menu, and all change operations, can be inhibited.  
This enables you to prevent the accidental deletion or alteration of screens  
and settings.  
Reference:  
• For the system program, use the NT631/NT631C system program sup-  
plied as an accessory with the NT-series Support Tool (NT-ZJCAT1-EV4).  
• For the Support Tool, use NT-series Support Tool for Windows (Ver. 4.@).  
Refer to the following manuals for the devices and software.  
Device or Software  
Manual Title  
Manual Number  
NT31/NT31C, NT631/  
NT631C  
Reference Manual  
V064-E1-1  
System Installer  
Support Tool  
NT-series Support Tool for Windows (Ver. 4.@) Operation Manual  
NT-series Support Tool for Windows (Ver. 4.@) Operation Manual  
V061-E1-@  
V061-E1-@  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Before Operating  
Section 1-6  
Device or Software  
Manual Title  
SYSMAC CPM1 Operation Manual  
Manual Number  
W262-E1-@  
PLCs  
SYSMAC CPM1A Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CPM2A Operation Manual  
W317-E1-@  
W352-E1-@  
SYSMAC CPM1/CPM1A/CAM2A/CPM2C/SRM1(-V2)  
Programmable Controllers Programming Manual  
W353-E1-@  
SYSMAC CPM2C Operation Manual  
W356-E1-@  
W130-E1-@  
W217-E1-@  
W236-E1-@  
W235-E1-@  
W302-E1-@  
W303-E1-@  
W322-E1-@  
W140-E1-@  
W228-E1-@  
W363-E1-@  
W202-E1-@  
SYSMAC C200H Operation Manual (for CPU01/03/11) (programming)  
SYSMAC C200H Operation Manual (for CPU21/23/31) (programming)  
SYSMAC C200HS Installation Guide  
SYSMAC C200HS Operation Manual (programming)  
SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE-ZE Installation Guide  
SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE Programming Manual  
SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE-Z Programming Manual  
SYSMAC C1000H/C2000H Operation Manual (programming)  
SYSMAC CQM1 Programming Manual  
SYSMAC CQM1H Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CVM1/CV500/CV1000/CV2000 Operation Manual:  
Ladder Diagrams  
SYSMAC CS Series Programmable Controllers Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CJ Series Programmable Controllers Operation Manual  
W339-E1-@  
W393-E1-@  
SYSMAC CS Series, CJ Series, NSJ Series Programmable Controllers W394-E1-@  
Programming Manual  
SYSMAC CS Series, CJ Series, NSJ Series Programmable Controllers W340-E1-@  
Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CS/CJ Series Programming Consoles Operation Manual  
W341-E1-@  
SYSMAC CS/CJ/CP Series, NSJ Series Communications Commands  
Reference Manual  
W342-E1-@  
SYSMAC CS/CJ Series Serial Communications Boards,  
Serial Communications Units Operation Manual  
W336-E1-@  
W365-E1-@  
W318-E1-@  
SYSMAC CQM1H Series Serial Communications Board Operation  
Manual  
CompoBus Master  
Control Unit  
SRM1 Operation Manual  
Programming Devices  
SYSMAC Support Software Operation Manual: C-series PLCs  
SYSMAC Support Software Operation Manual: CVM1 PLCs  
SYSMAC CPT User Manual and Quick Start Guide  
W248-E1-@  
W249-E1-@  
W332-E1-@  
W333-E1-@  
CX-Programmer Operation Manual  
W446-E1-@  
W143-E1-@  
W205-E1-@  
Host Link Units and  
Serial Communications  
Boards  
SYSMAC C-series Host Link Unit Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CVM1/CV-series Host Link Operation Manual  
SYSMAC C200HW-COM01 C200HW-COM02-V1 to C200HW-COM06- W304-E1-@  
EV1 Serial Communications Board Operation Manual  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 2  
Preparing for Connection  
This section describes the connection methods that are possible with the PT, and the functions of the parts of PT, as the  
2-1 Method for Connection to the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2 Names and Functions of Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
26  
29  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Method for Connection to the Host  
Section 2-1  
2-1 Method for Connection to the Host  
This section describes the methods for connection to the host used with the  
NT631/NT631C, and the relationship between the connection method and the  
communications method.  
NT631/NT631C Communications Ports and Communications Methods  
The NT631/NT631C has two communications ports. Their uses are indicated  
in the table below.  
Communications Port  
Usable Communications  
Methods  
Communications Type  
Serial port A  
Host link  
RS-232C  
NT Link (1:1)  
NT Link (1:N) (See note.)  
Memory link  
(Support Tool connection)  
(bar code reader input function)  
Serial port Connector Host link  
B
RS-232C  
NT Link (1:1)  
(select between con-  
nector and terminal  
block)  
NT Link (1:N) (See note.)  
Memory link  
Terminal  
block  
Host link  
RS-422A/485  
NT Link (1:1)  
(select between con-  
nector and terminal  
block)  
NT Link (1:N) (See note.)  
Note  
There are two NT Link (1:N) communications rates: standard and high-speed.  
Communications Methods That Can Be Used with the Host  
The following communications methods can be used with the hosts that can  
be connected to the NT631/NT631C.  
• RS-232C  
• RS-422A  
• RS-485  
host. For details, refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-  
232C Port and SECTION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485  
Port.  
Converting the Communications Type with an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
The following communications type conversions are possible by using an RS-  
232C/RS-422A adapter (NT-AL001, made by OMRON).  
• RS-232C RS-422A  
• RS-232C RS-485  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Method for Connection to the Host  
Section 2-1  
Combinations of Communications Method and Connection Method  
The connection methods that can be used depending on the communications  
method used and the communications type for communications between the  
NT631/NT631C and the host are indicated in the table below.  
Communica- Communica-  
tions Type at tions Type at  
Usable Connection Method  
Usable Communications  
Method  
Details  
PT  
Host  
Host NT  
link Link Link  
(1:1) (1:N) link  
NT Mem-  
ory  
RS-232C  
RS-232C  
page 73  
Direct 1:1 connection  
PT  
Host  
Host  
RS-232C (max. 15 m)  
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
page 82  
page 86  
1:1 connection via a convertor unit  
Convertor unit  
(NT-AL001)  
PT  
RS-232C  
(max. 2 m)  
RS-422A  
(max. 500 m)  
×
×
×
1:N connection via a convertor unit  
Convertor unit  
PT  
Host  
(NT-AL001)  
RS-232C  
(max. 2 m)  
RS-422A  
(total length 500 m)  
RS-422A  
page 115  
page 119  
Direct 1:1 connection  
PT  
Host  
RS-422A (max. 500 m)  
×
×
×
1:N connection  
Host  
PT  
RS-422A (total length 500 m)  
: Connection possible ×: Connection not possible  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Method for Connection to the Host  
Section 2-1  
Communica-  
Communica-  
Usable Connection Method  
Usable Communications  
Method  
Host NT NT Mem-  
link Link Link ory  
(1:1) (1:N) link  
Details  
tions Type at tions Type at  
PT  
Host  
RS-485  
RS-232C  
×
×
×
page 82  
1:1 connection via a convertor unit  
PT  
Convertor unit  
(NT-AL001)  
Host  
RS-485  
(max. 500 m)  
RS-232C  
(max. 2 m)  
×
×
×
page 86  
1:N connection via a convertor unit  
PT  
Convertor unit  
(NT-AL001)  
Host  
RS-232C  
(max. 2 m)  
RS-485  
(total length 500 m)  
RS-485  
×
×
×
×
×
×
page 118  
page 121  
Direct 1:1 connection  
PT  
Host  
RS-485 (max. 500 m)  
1:N connection  
PT  
Host  
RS-485 (total length 500 m)  
: Connection possible ×: Connection not possible  
• The RS-232C/RS-422A adapter (NT-AL001) requires +5 V, 150 mA at pin  
6 of the RS-232C connector. Check the signals of the RS-232C connector  
at the host.  
• +5 V is not output from serial port B of the NT631/NT631C. When con-  
necting an NT-AL001 at serial port B, a separate power supply is required  
for the NT-AL001.  
• The cable of an NT-AL001 cannot be connected or disconnected while the  
power is ON. Always connect or disconnect the cable while the power  
supply from the RS-232C cable is OFF (while the host power supply is  
OFF).  
• NT Link (1:N) connection is possible even when RS-232C is used at the  
NT631/NT631C side for communications with the host, but in this case  
one NT-AL001 Adapter is required for each NT631/NT631C. In this case,  
it is convenient to use serial port A of the NT631/NT631C. +5 V is not out-  
put from serial port B.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Names and Functions of Parts  
Section 2-2  
2-2 Names and Functions of Parts  
Before starting operation, the names and functions of the parts of the NT631/  
NT631C are described here as a confirmation. A method of hardware settings  
is also described.  
Front View  
POWER LED  
Lit in green when the power is supplied.  
POWER  
RUN  
RUN LED  
Display  
Depending on the model, different display types are used.  
NT631-ST211@-EV2: Monochrome EL display  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2: STN color LCD display with backlight  
NT631C-ST151/152@-EV2: TFT color LCD high intensity display with backlight  
Lit in green while the  
unit is in the RUN mode.  
Lit in orange or red when  
the battery is low (orange  
in the RUN mode, red in  
other modes).  
The whole area of the screen is a touch panel which works as an input device.  
Reference:  
The NT631/NT631C comes in two body colors.  
NT631 (EL)  
NT631-ST211-EV2  
NT631-ST211B-EV2  
NT631C (STN)  
NT631C (TFT)  
Body Color  
NT631C-ST141-EV2  
NT631C-ST153-EV3  
Beige  
NT631C-ST141B-EV2 NT631C-ST153B-EV3 Black  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Names and Functions of Parts  
Section 2-2  
Rear View  
Reset switch (inside the cover)  
Used to initializes all the statuses of the NT631/NT631C.  
However, registered data such as screen data, and memory  
switch settings, retain their statuses before initialization.  
Serial port B terminal block  
Connect the cable for RS-  
422A/485 connection to the host  
here. Depending on the setting  
made at the NT631/NT631C  
system menu, communications  
through RS-422A/485 are  
available. It is not possible to use  
this terminal block and the serial  
port B connector (9-pin) at the  
same time.  
Warning label  
Expansion interface connector  
(under the label)  
When using an expansion  
interface unit such as a  
memory unit, peel off the label  
and connect it here.  
RESET  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
GR terminal  
Grounding terminal to prevent  
malfunction due to noise.  
24V  
+DC  
PRINTER  
PORT  
B
PORT  
A
Power input terminals  
Connect the power to  
the NT631/NT631C at  
these terminals.  
Serial port A connector  
Connect the cable for connection to the host or  
Support Tool here. A bar code reader can also  
be connected here. This is a 9-pin connector for  
RS-232C use only.  
Battery cover  
The battery is secured  
underneath this cover.  
Serial port B connector  
Connect the cable for RS-232C connection to the host here.  
Depending on the setting made at the NT631/NT631C  
system menu, communications through RS-232C are  
available. This is a 9-pin connector for RS-232C use only.It is  
not possible to use this connector and the serial port B  
terminal block at the same time.  
Printer connector  
Connect the printer cable here.  
Output conforms to Centronics  
specifications.  
Note  
Confirm system safety before turning the power ON/OFF or resetting.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SECTION 3  
Hardware Settings and Connections  
This section describes the settings of the NT631/NT631C and methods for connection to peripheral devices.  
For details on the method for connection to the host, refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C  
3-1 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-1 Installation Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-2 Installation in the Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-3 Power Supply Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-4 Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2 Connecting to the Support Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-3 Connecting a Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-3-1 Connection Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4 Connecting a Bar Code Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-1 Connection Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-2 Setting a Bar Code Reader. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-3 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5 Using a Memory Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5-1 Installation Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5-2 Method of Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
32  
32  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
36  
36  
37  
37  
38  
39  
40  
40  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation  
Section 3-1  
Note  
On unpacking the NT631/NT631C and peripheral devices, check their exter-  
nal appearance and confirm that there is no damage. Also confirm that there  
is no abnormal noise on shaking the PT lightly.  
3-1 Installation  
Install the NT631/NT631C in the operation panel and connect the power to  
the NT631/NT631C as described below.  
3-1-1 Installation Environment  
Observe the following points when installing the PT in an operation panel.  
Note  
1. Do not install the PT at sites subject to the following conditions.  
• Severe temperature variations  
Temperatures or humidities outside the ranges stated in the specifica-  
tions  
• High humidity, condensation  
• Splashing chemical agents  
• Severe oil splashing  
• Corrosive or flammable gases  
• Strong vibrations or shocks  
• Direct exposure to wind and rain (outdoor sites)  
• Strong ultra-violet irradiation  
2. Take adequate measures to ensure shielding if the PT is used at a location  
subject to any of the following conditions.  
• Static electricity, or noise from other equipment  
• Strong electromagnetic fields  
• Nearby power cables  
• Potential exposure to radioactivity  
3-1-2 Installation in the Operation Panel  
The NT631/NT631C is mounted in an operation panel by embedding it in the  
panel.  
Use the panel fittings and tool (Phillips screwdriver) included in the product  
package and follow the procedure below.  
1,2,3...  
1. Open a hole of the dimensions shown below in the panel and install the  
NT631/NT631C from the front side of the panel.  
238+ 0.5 mm  
0 mm  
+ 0.5 mm  
0 mm  
303  
2. Attach the panel fittings at the following positions shown below, from the  
rear of the NT631/NT631C.  
Fit the hook of the fitting in the square hole in the body and tighten the  
screw with the Phillips head screwdriver while lightly pulling the fitting.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Installation  
Section 3-1  
Fittings at the two (*) positions are not necessary if you do not need it dust  
proof and waterproof.  
(:)  
RESET  
RDA  
T
RM  
RDB  
S
S
DA  
DB  
CSA  
CSB  
24  
V
PRINTER  
PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+
DC  
(:)  
Note  
1. During work at the panel, take care to ensure that no metal scraps enter  
the PT.  
2. The thickness of applicable operation panel is 1.6 mm to 4.8 mm. All fit-  
tings must be tightened uniformly to a torque of 0.5 to 0.6 Nm in order to  
ensure water- and dust-resistance. Front sheet of NT631/NT631C may be  
warped if the tightening is too strong or not uniformity. The panel must not  
be soiled or warped, and must be able to support an installation that will  
remain secure and strong.  
3-1-3 Power Supply Connection  
Connect a 24 VDC power supply to the power input terminals.  
Note  
1. Depending on how the power is switched ON/OFF, the entire system may  
stop. Follow the correct procedure when switching the power ON/OFF.  
2. Carefully check the wiring before switching ON the power.  
3. Do not connect AC power to the DC terminals.  
4. Use DC power supplies with low voltage fluctuation.  
5. Do not perform a dielectric strength test.  
6. If complying with EC directives (low voltage directives), the following points  
must be noted (compliance with EC directives):  
a. Use a power supply with reinforced insulation.  
b. When installing NT631-ST211(B)-EV2 on the ultimate system, the  
rear of the NT631 must be placed within an enclosure to restrict the  
operators’ use only to the front panel.  
7. When using NT631-ST211(B)-EV2, warm-up time of the power supply  
must be 200 ms or less. If longer than this, NT631 may not boot up.  
24 VDC  
Breaker  
24 VDC  
power supply  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installation  
Section 3-1  
Power Supply  
The applicable power supply specifications are as follows.  
Item  
Value  
Power supply  
24 VDC  
Allowable power supply voltage  
fluctuation range  
20.4 to 26.4 VDC (24 VDC –15% to +10%)  
Power supply voltage capacity  
NT631-ST211 (B)-EV2:  
30 W or more (Power supply warm-up time  
within 200 ms.)  
NT631C-ST141 (B) /ST153 (B)-EV3:  
18 W or more  
Parts Used for Connection  
Note  
For the connection to the power supply terminal block, twisted wires of 2 mm2  
or greater cross sectional area and M3.5 size crimp terminals must be used.  
Tighten the screws on the terminal block to a torque of 0.8 Nm.  
Fork type  
Round type  
7 mm max.  
7 mm max.  
Recommended Terminals  
Maker  
Type  
Type  
Applicable Wire  
(fork type) (round type) (stranded wire)  
2.0 to 2.63 mm2  
Japan Solderless Terminal MFG  
Fuji Terminal  
2-YS3A  
2-YAS3.5  
2Y-3.5  
2-3.5  
V2-S3.5  
2-3.5  
Nichifu Terminal  
Note  
Conformance to Shipbuilding Standard  
• Cover the entire PT with electromagnetic shielding, and ground the elec-  
tromagnetic shielding to the control panel with copper tape or other elec-  
trically conductive tape.  
Recommended electromagnetic shielding: E09F100 or E09R13502P  
Manufacturer: Seiwa Electric MFG, Co., Ltd.  
• Use gaskets or other materials to completely shield all openings and  
other gaps in the control panel.  
• Use copper tape or other electrically conductive tape to shield gaps  
between the cutout and the PT before securing the PT in place.  
To suppress noise terminal voltage, perform installation under the follow-  
ing conditions. It is recommended to use the following product for the DC  
power supply.  
Recommended Power Supply model: S82K-03024  
Manufacturer: OMRON  
3-1-4 Grounding  
The NT631/NT631C has a functional ground terminal ( ).  
Carry out wiring under the following conditions.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting to the Support Tool  
Section 3-2  
1,2,3...  
1. In cases where there is a potential difference between the grounds of the  
NT631/NT631C and the host, ground as shown in Fig. If there is some dis-  
tance between the NT631/NT631C and host and grounding at a single  
point is difficult, do not connect the functional ground terminal ( ) of the  
NT631/NT631C.  
2. If the NT631/NT631C is installed in the same panel as equipment that gen-  
erates noise, such as a motor or inverter, do not ground the functional  
ground terminal ( ) of the NT631/NT631C.  
NT631/  
NT631C  
Host  
Grounding at a single point  
Note  
Carry out grounding correctly in order to prevent operating errors due to  
noise.  
3-2 Connecting to the Support Tool  
In order to install the system program in the NT631/NT631C, or to transmit  
screen data created with the Support Tool to the NT631/NT631C, the NT631/  
NT631C must be connected to a personal computer with an RS-232C cable.  
The NT631/NT631C connects the RS-232C cable from a personal computer  
at serial port A. When the host is connected at serial port B, the connection  
with the host can be maintained as it is while the NT631/NT631C is connected  
to the RS-232C cable from a personal computer.  
However, when a bar code reader is being used, it must be disconnected, so  
that the RS-232C cable can be connected, since they both use serial port A.  
RESET  
RDA  
TR  
M
RD  
B
SDA  
SDB  
CSA  
CSB  
24V  
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+DC  
Serial port A  
(RS-232C, 9-pin)  
Communications Conditions  
The communications conditions are automatically set when the system  
installer and Support Tool are started.  
Recommended Connector Cable  
Use the cable indicated below.  
• CV500-CN228 (length: 2 m), made by OMRON  
(D-SUB 9-pin, male D-SUB 25-pin, male)  
• XW2Z-S001 (conversion cable), made by OMRON  
(D-SUB 25-pin, female half pitch 14-pin, male)  
• XW2Z-S002 (length: 2 m), made by OMRON  
(D-SUB 9-pin, male D-SUB 9-pin, female)  
For details on making a connector cable, refer to Appendix F Making the  
Cable for Connecting a PLC.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting a Printer  
Section 3-3  
3-3 Connecting a Printer  
Connecting a printer to the NT631/NT631C enables printing of hard copies of  
the currently displayed screen (printing of screen images), and, by system  
menu operations, printing of the screen display history and alarm history.  
The following types of data can be printed, depending on the printer con-  
nected to the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to the pages cited.  
• Hard copies of the screen (Refer to information on printing data and  
checking the printer status in the NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C Program-  
mable Terminal Reference Manual.)  
• Screen display history record data (page 194)  
• Alarm history record data (page 196)  
3-3-1 Connection Method  
Connect the printer to the NT631/NT631C with a Centronics cable, as shown  
below. The length of the cable should not exceed 1.5 m.  
Reference:  
If the connector cable is connected or disconnected while the power to the  
printer is on, the NT631/NT631C may malfunction. Always turn off the power  
to the printer before connecting or disconnecting the cable.  
RESET  
RDA  
TR  
M
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
CSA  
CSB  
24V  
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+DC  
Recommended Connector Cable  
The following connection cables are recommended.  
NT-CNT121 (1.5 m, 20-pin to 36-pin), made by OMRON  
Recommended Printers  
When using a printer, use one that can emulate an NEC PC-PR201H (us-  
ing the NEC PC-PR201PL control protocol) or complies with one of the fol-  
lowing EPSON control standards: ESC/P 24-J83C (color), or ESC/P 24-  
J82 (monochrome).  
When using a monochrome printer with an NT631C, set Tone printing with  
the NT631C memory switches (page 169).  
3-4 Connecting a Bar Code Reader  
Connecting a bar code reader to the NT631/NT631C enables bar code data  
to read as character strings into character string input fields, and set in char-  
acter string memory tables.  
In order to use a bar code reader, the Comm. A Method memory switch must  
be set to Bar-Code Reader.  
For details on the method for inputting character strings with a bar code  
reader, refer to 3-7 Input of Numeric values and Character Strings in the  
NT31/NT31C/NT631/NT631C Programmable Terminal Reference Manual.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Connecting a Bar Code Reader  
Section 3-4  
Note  
Make sure that the power supply to the bar code reader and the power supply  
to the PT are both OFF before connecting or disconnecting the cable.  
3-4-1 Connection Method  
Connect the bar code reader to serial port A of the NT631/NT631C, as shown  
in the figure below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Bar code reader  
RESET  
RDA  
TR  
M
RD  
B
SDA  
SDB  
CSA  
CSB  
24V  
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+DC  
Serial port A  
(RS-232C, 9-pin)  
9-pin connector  
Connector cable  
Bar code reader cable  
Bar code reader must match the communications setting (3-4-2 Setting a Bar  
Code Reader, page 37) and data format (3-4-3 Data Format, page 38) in  
order to connect to the NT631/NT631C. Please confirm the specification of  
the bar code reader before using.  
For details on making a connector cable, refer to Appendix G Making the  
Cable for Connection to a Bar Code Reader.  
Reference:  
The bar code reader must be connected to serial port A. This means that it  
cannot be connected at the same time as the Support Tool. Note also that  
when a bar code reader is used, the host must be connected at serial port B.  
3-4-2 Setting a Bar Code Reader  
After connecting a bar code reader, set the communications conditions and  
other settings for it by selection from the system menu.  
Settings at the NT631/  
NT631C  
At the NT631/NT631C, set the communications conditions for communica-  
tions with the bar code reader by using the memory switches, selecting from  
For more detailed information on the actual system menu operations, refer to  
6-10 Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function.  
Item  
Possible Settings  
7 or 8 bits  
Default Setting  
Data bits  
7 bits  
2 bits  
Even  
Stop bit(s)  
Parity  
1 or 2 bits  
None, odd, even  
Communications speed 4800, 9600, 19200 bps  
Input Method Manual, Auto  
9600 bps  
Manual  
Settings at the Bar Code  
Reader  
Make the settings shown in the table below at the bar code reader. Make sure  
that the communications speed, parity, stop bit, and data bit settings match  
the communications settings made at the NT631/NT631C. For details on the  
setting method, refer to the instruction manual for the bar code reader used.  
Item  
Communications speed  
Possible Settings  
4800, 9600, 19200 bps  
EVEN, ODD, NONE  
1 or 2 bits  
Parity  
Stop bits  
Data bits  
7 or 8 bits  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting a Bar Code Reader  
Section 3-4  
Item  
Possible Settings  
Preamble  
STX  
ETX  
Postamble  
RS/CS control  
Available  
Communications protocol  
No-protocol mode  
Transmission of number of bar code label digits Transmission prohibited  
Transmission of ID characters  
Bar code types  
Transmission prohibited  
Multi-reading (all types can be  
read)  
Trigger switch setting  
Automatic reading mode  
About RS/CS Control  
During bar code reading, the NT631/NT631C performs RS/CS control. When  
the Input Method setting of the NT631/NT631C is set to Auto, the RS signal is  
turned OFF, prohibiting the next input, until the read data has been sent to the  
host as notification.  
Because of this, when the Auto setting is made, the next input is not possible  
until the data has been sent to the host as notification.  
However, when the setting is Auto and the RS/CS signals of the cable are  
shorted, RS/CS control is ineffective. Consequently, data input from the bar  
code reader to the NT631/NT631C is updated regardless of whether or not  
the data is sent to the host as notification.  
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the bar code reader used.  
3-4-3 Data Format  
The data format for communications when using the bar code input function of  
the NT631/NT631C is shown below.  
STX  
Data  
Data  
Data  
ETX  
(02H)  
(03H)  
The characters which are effective as data are hexadecimal codes from 20 to  
7FH, and the maximum data length is 40 bytes.  
Data which does not follow the data format described above is invalidated and  
discarded.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
3-5 Using a Memory Unit  
This section discusses the use of the Memory Unit.  
Reference:  
The Memory Unit functions are determined by the model of PT being used,  
regardless of the version of the system program installed in the PT.  
PT Model  
Without V@ suffix System programs can not be transmitted using Memory Unit.  
With V@ suffix System programs can be transmitted using Memory Unit.  
Function of Memory Unit  
By installing a Memory Unit (NT-MF261) on the NT631/NT631C, the screen  
data in the NT631/NT631C can be recorded (backed up) in the Memory Unit.  
In addition, the screen data in the Memory Unit can be automatically read into  
the NT631/NT631C when it starts up. This means that system program and  
screen data can be changed easily at the operation site without connecting to  
the Support Tool.  
The data in the Memory Unit is retained without backup by a battery or other  
means.  
In systems where there are frequent setup changes, by preparing a number of  
Memory Units in advance and recording screen data in them in accordance  
with the control performed in each case, the NT631/NT631C screen data can  
be changed simply by installing the Memory Unit, without connecting to the  
Support Tool.  
In addition, even if NT631/NT631C is replaced, the previous status can be  
maintained simply by installing the Memory Unit that retains the system pro-  
gram and screen data of the previous NT631/NT631C.  
By using the following combinations, data can be stored (backed up) to a  
Memory Unit.  
• Screen data for two PTs.  
• System program for two PTs.  
• System program and screen data for one PT.  
One Memory Unit can store the screen data for two PTs.  
Note  
1. Make sure that the power supply to the PT is OFF before connecting or dis-  
connecting a Memory Unit.  
After mounting a Memory Unit, be sure to tighten its two screws.  
2. During data transmission, do not turn off the power supply to the NT631/  
NT631C or reset it.  
3. Do not touch the PCB (printed circuit board) with bare hands.  
Reference:  
• When a Memory Unit is mounted, the NT631/NT631C cannot be set to  
the operating status. On completion of data transmission with a Memory  
Unit, always disconnect the Memory Unit from the NT631/NT631C before  
starting NT631/NT631C operation.  
• Memory Units (NT-MF261) can be used in common for the following PT  
models: NT31, NT31C, NT631, and NT631C. One Memory Unit can store  
screen data for up to two PTs of different models. However, since the data  
compatibility is not complete between NT31/NT31C and NT631/NT631C,  
an error may occur if an attempt is made to read NT631C data with an  
NT31C. (The data must be converted using the Support Tool.)  
Note also that although there is data compatibility between the NT31  
and NT31C, and between the NT631 and NT631C, the display may not  
be correct since these models have different numbers of colors.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
• One Memory Unit can store a system program for up to two PTs of differ-  
ent models. In order to transmit a system program from the Memory Unit  
to the NT631/NT631C, the system program must be compatible to the tar-  
get PT model.  
• The statuses of memory switch settings and system settings can be  
recorded to the Memory Unit besides screen data. When the data in the  
Memory Unit is written into the NT631/NT631C, make sure that these set-  
tings can be adapted to the NT631/NT631C used before transmission.  
3-5-1 Installation Method  
Install the Memory Unit (NT-MF261) at the expansion interface connector at  
the rear of the NT631/NT631C as shown in the figure below (the expansion  
interface connector is located underneath the note label.).  
Mounting screws  
3-5-2 Method of Use  
As shown in the figure below, a Memory Unit has two sets of four DIP  
switches, and the operation is determined by the DIP switches that are set at  
startup.  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
Factory setting is turned all to off.  
OFF  
OFF  
SW1  
SW2  
Note  
1. Always confirm that the power to the NT631/NT631C is off before setting  
the DIP switches.  
2. Do not touch the PCB (printed circuit board) directly with bare hands.  
DIP Switch Functions  
The functions of the DIP switches on the Memory Unit are indicated in the  
table below.  
SW1  
Switch  
Function  
SW1-1 Automatic transmission (writing from the Memory  
Unit to the PT)  
OFF: Not executed  
ON: Executed  
SW1-2 Automatic transmission (writing from the PT to the  
Memory Unit)  
OFF: Not executed  
ON: Executed  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
Switch  
Function  
SW1-3 Manual transmission (Direction of transmission and OFF: Not executed  
bank used selected at the PT touch panel)  
ON: Executed  
SW1-4 Data type to transfer  
OFF: Screen data  
ON: System program  
SW2  
Switch  
Function  
SW2-1 Disable/enable writing to PT  
OFF: Disable  
ON: Enable  
OFF: Disable  
ON: Enable  
OFF: Bank 0  
ON: Bank 1  
OFF: Disable  
ON: Enable  
SW2-2 Disable/enable writing to the Memory Unit  
SW2-3 Area (bank) selection of automatic transmission. *  
SW2-4 System/Screen simultaneous transmission  
*: The Memory Unit stores system program or screen data for one PT in each  
of areas (bank 0, bank 1). (The total data storage is for two PTs.) SW2-3  
sets which of these two banks is used for automatic transmission.  
Reference:  
• In the following cases, a mode setting error occurs.  
• More than one of the SW1-1 to SW1-3 switches are set to ON.  
• None of the SW1-1 to SW1-3 switches are set to ON.  
• In the following case, a protect setting error occurs.  
Transmitting to the write destination has been disabled by the setting for  
SW2-1 or SW2-2.  
• In the following cases, a data transmission error occurs.  
• An attempt is made to transmit data other than the system program to  
PT system program area.  
• An attempt is made to transmit the system program to PT screen data  
area.  
• For details on mode setting errors and protect setting errors, refer to  
Errors When Using a Memory Unit (page 45).  
Writing Screen Data to a  
Memory Unit Using  
Automatic Transmission  
(PT to Memory Unit)  
In this mode, system program or the screen data in the NT631/NT631C is  
forcibly written to the Memory Unit irrespective of the setting status of the  
NT631/NT631C.  
This mode is convenient if the touch panel is broken and touch switch opera-  
tion is not possible, or if someone unfamiliar with touch switch operation at the  
operation site is using the system.  
Reference:  
When screen data is written to the Memory Unit, the data that has been  
stored in the specified area up until that point is lost (if the data is written into  
only one Bank, the other Bank will not be affected).  
Method of Execution  
Use the following procedure to write the screen data in the NT631/NT631C to  
the Memory Unit by automatic transmission.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
1,2,3...  
1. Check that the power supply to the NT631/NT631C is OFF, then set the  
DIP switches of the Memory Unit as follows after installing Memory Unit to  
NT631/NT631C.  
SW2  
SW1  
SW2-4 ON: System/Screen transmitted simultaneously  
OFF: System/Screen not transmitted simultaneously  
SW2-3 ON: Bank 1  
OFF: Bank 0  
SW1-4 ON: System program  
OFF: Screen data  
It is not strictly necessary to set SW2-1 to OFF (to disable writing to the  
PT), but it is recommended to do so to avoid loss of data in the event of  
operating errors.  
Reference:  
• Setting SW2-4 to ON (System/Screen transmitted simultaneously) dis-  
ables the setting of SW1-4.  
• Setting SW2-4 to ON (System/Screen transmitted simultaneously) dis-  
ables the setting of SW2-3, writes the system program into bank 0, and  
the screen data into bank 1 at all times.  
2. Switch the NT631/NT631C power ON.  
The screen data is automatically written into the Memory Unit. The screen  
data in the NT631/NT631C is preserved.  
The messages Preparing, Transmitting, Verifying, and Finished are dis-  
played on the screen in accordance with the progress of data writing.  
At the same time, the progress of the data writing status is displayed by the  
means of the number of bytes and blocks (1 bank = 16 block = 1024k byte).  
RUN LED operates as follows according to the processing status.  
Preparing:  
Transmitting:  
Verifying:  
flashes at intervals of 1 second  
flashes at intervals of 0.5 second  
flashes at intervals of 0.5 second  
lights up  
Finished:  
3. Switch the NT631/NT631C power OFF, remove the Memory Unit.  
To operate NT631/NT631C continuously, switch the NT631/NT631C pow-  
er back ON.  
Writing Screen Data to the  
PT Using Automatic  
Transmission (Memory  
Unit to PT)  
In this mode, the system program or screen data in the Memory Unit is forcibly  
written to NT631/NT631C irrespective of the setting status of the NT631/  
NT631C.  
Since data transmission by this method is faster than when the Support Tool  
or system installer is used, it can save a lot of time. When transmitting the  
same system program or screen data to multiple NT631/NT631C, this mode  
becomes convenient.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
Reference:  
When data is written to the NT631/NT631C, the data that has been stored up  
until that point is lost. When the system program is changed, the operation of  
NT631/NT631C also changes.  
Method of Execution  
Use the following procedure to write the screen data in the Memory Unit to the  
NT631/NT631C by automatic transmission.  
1,2,3...  
1. Check that the NT631/NT631C power is OFF, then set the DIP switches on  
the Memory Unit as follows after installing Memory Unit to NT631/NT631C.  
SW1  
SW2  
SW2-4 ON: System/Screen transmitted simultaneously  
OFF: System/Screen not transmitted simultaneously  
SW2-3 ON: Bank 1  
OFF: Bank 0  
SW1-4 ON: System program  
OFF: Screen data  
It is not strictly necessary to set SW2-2 to OFF (to disable writing to the  
Memory Unit), but it is recommended to do so to avoid loss of data in the  
event of operating errors.  
Reference:  
• Setting SW2-4 to ON (System/Screen transmitted simultaneously) dis-  
ables the setting of SW1-4.  
• Setting SW2-4 to ON (System/Screen transmitted simultaneously) dis-  
ables the setting of SW2-3. In this case, the data transmission becomes  
possible only if the data inside Memory Unit is in either of following combi-  
nations.  
Bank 0: system program, Bank 1: other than system program  
Bank 0: other than system program, Bank 1: system program  
If the combination is not as listed above, a data transmitting error occurs.  
• When writing the system program into the NT631/NT631C, the type of  
system program inside Memory Unit and the type of PT must correspond.  
2. Switch the NT631/NT631C power ON.  
The screen data is automatically written into the PT.  
The messages Preparing, Transmitting, Verifying and Finished are dis-  
played on the screen in accordance with the progress of data writing.  
At the same time, the progress of data writing status is displayed by the  
means of the number of bytes and blocks (1 bank = 16 block = 1024k byte).  
The RUN LED operates as follows according to the processing status.  
Preparing:  
flashes at intervals of 1 second  
Transmitting: flashes at intervals of 0.5 second  
Verifying:  
Finished:  
flashes at intervals of 0.5 second  
lights up  
3. Switch the NT631/NT631C power OFF, remove the Memory Unit.  
To operate NT631/NT631C continuously, switch the NT631/NT631C pow-  
er back ON.  
Reading and Writing Data  
by Manual Transmission  
In this method, the direction of transmission and area of the Memory Unit  
used are set by touch switch operations at the NT631/NT631C. Transmission  
can be executed while checking the settings.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
Reference:  
When data is written to the NT631/NT631C or Memory Unit, the data that has  
been stored up until that point is lost.  
Method of Execution  
Use the following procedure to write screen data using manual transmission.  
1,2,3...  
1. Check that the NT631/NT631C power is OFF, then set the DIP switches on  
the Memory Unit as follows.  
SW2  
SW1  
Setting of SW2-4 not relevant  
Setting of SW2-3 not relevant  
Setting of SW1-4 not relevant  
In order to avoid loss of data in the event of operating errors, it is advisable  
to set SW2-1 and SW2-2 so as to disable writing to the PT from which the  
data is to be read.  
2. Switch the NT631/NT631C power ON.  
Display language select screen appears.  
3. Press the Japanese or English touch switches to select the display lan-  
guage.  
The following descriptions are for when English is selected.  
The screen shown below is displayed.  
Current PT Screen Data, System  
The first line:  
Compatible PT type for the system program inside PT.  
The second line:  
System program name and Version for the system pro-  
gram inside PT.  
(The second line may not be displayed in the kind of system program.)  
Current PT Screen Data, Screen  
The comment for the screen data in the NT631/NT631C is displayed here.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
Current Memory Unit Screen Data  
• In the case of system program:  
The first line:  
Compatible PT type for the system program in-  
side the Memory Unit.  
The second line:  
System program name and Version for the sys-  
tem program inside the Memory Unit.  
(The second line may not be displayed in the system program for some  
models.)  
• In the case of screen data:  
The comment for the screen data in the NT631/NT631C is displayed  
here.  
The available transmitting destinations are altered depending on the settings  
of the origin of transmitting as described in the table below.  
Source  
PT screen  
Destination  
Memory unit Bank 1  
Memory unit Bank 0  
PT system  
PT system/screen  
Memory Unit Bank 0  
Memory Unit Bank 1  
Memory Unit Bank 0/1 (fixed)  
If system program is selected  
PT system (fixed)  
If screen data is selected  
PT screen (fixed)  
Memory Unit Bank 0/1 PT system/screen (fixed)  
Reference:  
• When transmitting the system program and screen data simultaneously  
from the PT to the Memory Unit, the setting of banks is Bank 0: system  
program, Bank 1: screen data, and when transmitting them from the  
Memory Unit to the PT, either of the following combinations must be used.  
Bank 0: system program, Bank 1: other than system program  
Bank 0: other than system program, Bank 1: system program  
• When writing the system program into the NT631/NT631C, the type of  
system program inside Memory Unit and the type of PT must correspond.  
4. Press Execute.  
The data is transmitted.  
The messages Preparing, Transmitting, Verifying, and Finished are dis-  
played in accordance with the progress of data transmission. At the same  
time, the progress of data transmitting status is displayed by the means of  
the number of bytes and blocks (1 bank = 16 block = 1024k byte).  
When the data transmission is operated manually, RUN LED remains OFF.  
5. Switch the NT631/NT631C power OFF, remove the Memory Unit, then  
switch the NT631/NT631C power back ON.  
Errors When Using a  
Memory Unit  
If an error occurs when using the Memory Unit, the NT631/NT631C operates  
as follows.  
• The details of the error and remedial action are displayed on the screen.  
Each screen has touch switches to change the display language from  
one to the other. When the manual data transmission is operating, the  
content of error and remedial action are shown with selected lan-  
guage. When the automatic transmission is operating, it is displayed in  
Japanese.  
• The continuous buzzer sounds.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using a Memory Unit  
Section 3-5  
• The RUN LED flashes.  
If a protect setting error occurs when executing manual transmission, it is pos-  
sible to return to the Memory Unit manual transmission screen by pressing  
the OK touch switch, but in the case of other errors, the status described  
above remains in effect until the NT631/NT631C power is turned OFF or  
reset.  
Within the PT Model, the  
system program inside  
memory compatible PT  
model  
The compatibility relationships are shown below.  
NT631  
NT631C  
System program for NT631/NT631C without the -V suffix, and for  
NT631/NT631C with the -V1 and -V2 suffix  
NT631C-EV3 System program for NT631C with the -V3 suffix  
When an error occurs, take remedial action by referring to the table below.  
Error  
Probable Cause  
Remedial Action  
Mode setting error  
DIP switches SW1-1 to  
SW1-3 are all OFF, or  
more than one is ON.  
Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
OFF, set the Memory Unit DIP  
switches correctly, then turn the  
NT631/NT631C power back ON.  
Protect setting error Writing to the data write Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
(automatic transmis- destination has been pro- OFF, set the Memory Unit DIP  
sion)  
hibited by the setting of  
SW2-1 or SW2-2.  
switches correctly, then turn the  
NT631/NT631C power back ON.  
Protect setting error Writing to the data write Perform either of the following pro-  
(manual transmis-  
sion)  
destination has been pro- cedures.  
hibited by the setting of  
• Press the OK touch switch to  
SW2-1 or SW2-2.  
return to the Memory Unit manual  
transmission screen, make the  
correct settings, then try again.  
Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
OFF, correct the DIP switches set-  
tings of the Memory Unit, then  
turn the power back ON.  
Flash memory error An error occurred during Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
initialization of the OFF, then back ON. If the error  
NT631/NT631C or Mem- recurs, the flash memory at the  
ory Unit flash memory, or write destination may be faulty. In  
during write processing. this case, replace the PT.  
Verify error  
An error occurred during Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
verification processing at OFF, then back ON. If the error  
the flash memory of the  
NT631/NT631C or the  
Memory Unit.  
recurs, the flash memory at the  
write destination may be faulty. In  
this case, replace the PT.  
Transmitting data  
error  
(The automatic  
transmission only)  
An attempt is made to  
transmit data other than a cedures.  
system program or the  
Perform either of the following pro-  
Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
system program of a dif-  
ferent PLC model into the  
NT631/NT631C as the  
system program.  
An attempt is made to  
write a system program  
into the NT631/NT631C  
as screen data.  
OFF, correct the DIP switch set-  
tings of the Memory Unit, and  
then turn the power back ON.  
Turn the NT631/NT631C power  
OFF, set the DIP switch settings  
to the manual transmission, and  
then check the data inside the  
Memory Unit.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 4  
Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port  
4-1 Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-1-1 Host Types and Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-1-2 Connecting Directly between RS-232C Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
48  
48  
73  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
4-1 Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
The method for connecting between the RS-232C port of the PT and the RS-  
232C port of the host is as follows.  
The following discussion is focused on the connection method to OMRON  
PLCs (By using the memory link method, a connection can be made to any  
arbitrary RS-232 unit). When making a connection to a host other than  
OMRON PLCs, refer to the PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@) or NT31/  
631 Multi Vendor Connection Manual (V060-E1-@).  
Direct Connection Between The RS-232C Ports Using an RS-232C Cable  
(page 73)  
This is the easiest connection method. Depending on the host to which the  
connection is to be made, it may be possible to use OMRON cables with con-  
nectors.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-232C cable (max. 15 m)  
Reference:  
The CS/CJ-series CPU Unit cannot be connected with the 1:1 connection NT  
Link method. Use the 1:N connection NT Link method instead to make the 1:1  
connection. For details, refer to Using the NT Link (1:N) Method (page 65) or  
Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method (page 70).  
4-1-1 Host Types and Settings  
The types of host that can be connected to a PT by using the RS-232C ports  
of both Units, and the settings to be made at the host, are described here.  
When Using the Host Link  
Method  
Compatible Host Units  
Some models and series of OMRON PLCs have the host link function built in.  
In the CS/CJ-series or CQM1H PLCs, the host link method can be used by  
installing a Serial Communications Board/Unit. In addition, some C200HX/  
HG/HE(-Z)E CPU Unit can be connected in the host link method by installing  
a Communications Board.  
Check the model and series of the PLC, the type of installed Serial Communi-  
cations Board, Serial Communications Unit, or Host Link Unit before making a  
connection.  
The hosts that can be connected to the NT631/NT631C by the host link  
method using the RS-232C ports of both Units are indicated in the table  
below.  
PLC  
Series  
Units with Built-in Host Link  
Function  
CPU Units Connectable with  
Host Link Units or Expansion  
Communications Board/Units  
Host Link Unit or  
Communications  
Board/Unit  
Connect-  
able to  
CS Series CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CS1W-SCB21(-V1)  
CS1W-SCB41(-V1)  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*1)  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CJ Series CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/22/23  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/22/23  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
PLC  
Series  
Units with Built-in Host Link  
Function  
CPU Units Connectable with  
Host Link Units or Expansion  
Communications Board/Units  
Host Link Unit or  
Communications  
Board/Unit  
Connect-  
able to  
C Series  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
C200HS-CPU01/03/21/23/  
31/33-E  
C120-LK201-EV1  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C200H-LK201-EV1  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HE-Z  
C200HG  
C200HG-Z  
C200HX  
C200HX-Z  
C200HE-CPU11/32/42-E  
C200HE-CPU11/32/42-ZE  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-ZE  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64  
65/85-ZE  
C200HS-CPU21/23/31/33-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HW-COM02/04/ C200HS  
05/06-EV1  
C200HE-CPU32/42-E  
C200HE-CPU32/42-ZE  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-ZE  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64/  
65/85-ZE  
C200HE  
C20HE-CPU42-ZE  
C200HE-Z  
C200HG  
C200HG-CPU43/63-E  
C200HG-CPU43/63-ZE  
C200HX-CPU44/64-E  
C200HX-CPU44/64/65/85-ZE  
C200HG-Z  
C200HX  
C200HX-Z  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C1000HF-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
C500-LK201-EV1  
C500-LK203  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C1000H (F)  
C2000H  
CPM1-10/20/30CDR-@  
+CPM1-CIF01  
CPM1  
CPM1A-10/20/30/40CD@-@  
+CPM1-CIF01  
CPM2A-30/40/60CD@@-@  
+CPM1-CIF01  
CPM2A  
(Peripheral port connection)  
CPM2C-10/20@@@@@@-@(*2)  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CPM2C  
CQM1  
CQM1-CPU41/42/43/44-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU11/21/51/61(*3)  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
CQM1H-SCB41  
CV500-LK201  
CQM1H  
CV Series CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
(*4)  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1  
Series  
(*4)  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
SRM1-C02-V1  
CV500-LK201  
Compo-  
Bus/S  
Master  
Control  
Unit  
SRM1  
*1 This CPU Unit is for a Duplex-CPU Unit System. The CS1W-SCB21/42(-V1) Serial Communications Board  
cannot be used.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
*2 Use a CPM2C-CN111 or CS1W-CN114/118 Connecting Cable, CPM1-CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, or CPM1-  
CIF11 RS-422A Adapter to connect.  
*3 The CQM1H-CPU11 does not have a built-in RS-232C port, so connect to the peripheral port to the PT with  
a CS1W-CN118 Connecting Cable.  
*4 CPU Units of CVM1/CV-series PLCs without the suffix -EV@ cannot be connected.  
Settings at The Host  
When using the host link method, the settings shown below must be made at  
the host (depending on the Unit, some of these settings may not be neces-  
sary, or settings not shown here may be necessary).  
Item  
Switch Setting  
I/O port  
RS-232C  
Set the same speed as for the NT631/NT631C. (*1)  
Communications speed  
Transfer code  
Parity  
ASCII, 7 data bits, 2 stop bits  
Even  
1-to-N(*2)  
Level 1, 2, 3  
00  
1-to-1/1-to-N  
Instruction level  
Unit #  
Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
The 1-to-N setting enables BCC (Block Check Character). It is not actually pos-  
sible to connect more than one NT631/NT631C in a single host link.  
The setting methods for each type of Unit are described in the following.  
Connecting to a C-series  
Host Link Unit  
C200H/C200HS/C200HE/HG/HX (-Z)E Rack-mounting Unit: C200H-LK201-  
V1  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver so that the values or symbols in  
the setting value window agree with the following.  
LK201  
XMT  
RUN  
RCV  
ERROR  
Unit # (SW1, SW2)  
Set these switches to 0.  
SW1  
SW3  
SW2  
0
0
5
Instruction level, parity, and transfer code (SW4)  
Set this switch to 2.  
SW4  
2
Communications speed (SW3)  
Set this switch to 5 to select 9600 bps.  
Set this switch to 6 to select 19200 bps.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Setting the Rear Switches  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP switch)  
Set #3 to ON.  
ON  
1
2
3
4
CTS selector switch  
External  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to 0 V (ON).  
0 V (ON)  
C1000H(F)/C2000H Rack-mounting Unit: 3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
Setting the Front Switches  
Local  
Host  
Mode control (key switch)  
Set this to host link.  
Setting the Rear Switches  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-232C.  
Unit # (DIP SW1)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to OFF (0).  
I/O port  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
SW1  
Synchronization  
Internal  
External  
ON  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to Internal.  
8
Terminator  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OFF  
ON  
Communications speed  
SW2  
(DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
CTS  
Set these switches to 0010 to select  
19,200 bps.  
0 V  
External  
ON  
Set these switches to 1010 to select  
9,600 bps.(0: OFF 1: ON)  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to 0 V (ON).  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
C1000H/C2000H Rack-mounting Unit: C500-LK203  
Setting the Rear Switches  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-232C.  
5 V supply  
ON  
Unit #, parity, and transfer code  
(DIP SW1-1 to SW1-7)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-7 to OFF (0).  
OFF  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
I/O port  
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
SW1  
Synchronization  
ON  
Internal  
External  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to Internal.  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Terminator  
OFF  
ON  
SW2  
Communications speed  
(DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
CTS  
Set these switches to 0010 to select  
19,200 bps.  
0 V  
External  
ON  
Set these switches to 1010 to select  
9,600 bps.(0: OFF 1: ON)  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to 0 V (ON).  
C200H/C1000H/C2000H CPU-mounting Unit: 3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
Setting the Rear Switches  
Unit #, parity, and transfer code  
(DIP SW1-1 to SW1-5)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to OFF (0).  
* Parity is fixed at Even Parity. Transfer code is  
fixed at ASCII 7 data bits and 2 stop bits.  
Communications speed (DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
Set these switches to 0010 to select 19200 bps.  
Set these switches to 1010 to select 9600 bps.  
(0: OFF 1: ON)  
SW1  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
SW2  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
SW3  
CTS selection (DIP SW3-1 and SW3-2)  
Set SW3-1 to ON (1), and SW3-2 to OFF (0).  
(Set this always to 0V.)  
Synchronization (DIP SW3-3 to SW3-6)  
Set SW3-3, SW3-5, and SW3-6 to ON (1), and  
SW3-4 to OFF (0). (Set these to Internal.)  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Connecting to a CVM1/CV-  
series Host Link Unit  
CVM1/CV-series Rack-mounting Unit: CV500-LK201  
A CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit (CV500-LK201) has two connectors (com-  
munications ports 1 and 2). Either of these ports can be used for connection  
to an NT631/NT631C by the RS-232C method. However, since the connec-  
tors at these ports are of different types, a cable that matches the connector  
must be prepared.  
• Communications port 1  
Communications port 1 is a 25-pin connector for RS-232C use only.  
• Communications port 2  
Communications port 2 is a 9-pin connector which allows selection of the  
RS-232C or RS-422A method. When this port is used with the RS-232C  
method, the I/O port selector switch on the front of the PT must be set to  
RS-232C (the upper position).  
CPU Bus Unit Settings  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit, set the following com-  
munications conditions for the CPU Bus Unit settings.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
Set the same speed as set at the NT631/NT631C(*1)  
Communications speed  
Transfer code  
Parity  
ASCII, 7 data bits, 2 stop bits  
Even  
1-to-N(*2)  
1-to-1, 1-to-N  
Instruction level  
Level 1, 2, 3  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
*2 The 1-to-N setting enables BCC (Block Check Character). It is not actually  
possible to connect more than one NT631/NT631C in a single host link.  
Set the CPU Bus Unit settings directly from a Programming Device (e.g. CX-  
Programmer).  
For details on the CPU Bus Unit settings, refer to the SYSMAC CVM1/CV-  
series Host Link Unit Operation Manual (W205-E1-@).  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Setting The Front Switches  
Unit # (SW3, SW4)  
When using communications port 2, set  
these switches to 0.  
Communications port 1  
(RS-232C)  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-232C.  
Communications port 2  
(RS-232C/RS-422A)  
CTS selection (DIP SW2 and SW3)  
Set SW2 or SW3 to ON. (Set this always to 0 V.)  
I/O port selector switch  
RS-232C  
To use communications port 1, set SW2. To  
use communications port 2, set SW3.  
RS-422A  
Communications condition setting (DIP SW1)  
Set this switch to OFF.  
Communications are executed in  
accordance with the CPU Bus Unit system  
settings made at the PLC. The initial values  
for the system settings are as follows.  
- Communications speed: 9600 bps  
- Parity: Even  
- Xon/Xoff control: Not executed  
- Communications method: Full duplex  
- Stop bits: 2 stop bits  
- Data length: 7 bits  
Connecting to a CPU Unit  
CV-series and CVM1/CV-series (-EV@) CPU Units  
CV500-CPU01-EV1/CV1000-CPU01-EV1/CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2/CVM1-CPU11-EV2/CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
PLC Setup  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series CPU Unit, set the following communi-  
cations conditions for the PLC Setup.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
Set the same speed as set at the NT631/NT631C(*1)  
Communications speed  
Stop bit  
Parity  
2 stop bits  
Even  
Data length  
Unit #  
ASCII 7 bits  
00  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
Either set PLC Setup directly from a Programming Device (e.g. CX-Program-  
mer), or transmit the PLC Setup made at a Programming Device to the CPU  
Unit.  
For details on the PLC Setup, refer to the SYSMAC CVM1/CV500/1000/2000  
Operation Manual: Ladder Diagrams (W202-E1-@).  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Setting the Front Switches  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-232C.  
System setting (DIP SW4)  
To effect the existing DIP switch  
settings, set SW4 to ON.  
To effect the existing PLC Setup,  
set SW4 to OFF.  
I/O port selector switch  
RS-232C  
Note  
For CPU Units manufactured before or  
during June 1995 (lot No. @@65), the  
existing DIP switch settings differ from  
the existing PLC Setup as follows.  
RS-422A  
- DIP switch settings:  
2,400 bps, 1 stop bit, even parity, 7 bit  
data length  
- PLC Setup:  
9,600 bps, 2 stop bits, even parity, 7 bit  
data length  
For CPU Units manufactured from July  
1995 onward (lot No. @@75), the values  
specified in the DIP switch settings also  
are 9,600 bps and 2 stop bits.  
C-series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1,  
CPM1H CPU Units, SRM1  
The connection method depends upon the model of PLC being used, as  
shown in the following table.  
PLC model  
Connection method  
C200HS, CQM1  
Connect to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port.  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Connect to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port.  
Connect to one of the RS-232C ports (port A or port B) on a  
Serial Communications Board.  
CQM1H  
Connect to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port.  
Connect to the peripheral port through a CS1W-CN118  
Connecting Cable.  
Connect to the RS-232C port (port 1) on a Serial Communi-  
cations Board.  
CPM1  
Connect to the peripheral port through a CPM1-CIF01 RS-  
232C Adapter.  
CPM2A, SRM1  
Connect to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port.  
Connect to the peripheral port through a CPM1-CIF01 RS-  
232C Adapter.  
CPM2C  
Connect to the CPU Unit’s RS-232C port or the peripheral  
port through a Connecting Cable (CPM2C-CN111, CS1W-  
CN118, or CS1W-CN114).  
(The CPM2C-CN111 splits the Unit’s Communications Port  
into a RS-232C port and a peripheral port. A CPM1-CIF01  
RS-232C Adapter is also required to connect to this periph-  
eral port.)  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
When connecting to a C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM1, CPM2A,  
CPM2C, CQM1, or CQM1H CPU Unit, or SRM1, set the following communi-  
cations conditions for the PLC Setup area.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
Communications mode  
Communications speed  
Host link mode  
Set the same speed as set at the NT631/NT631C(*1)  
Stop bit  
Parity  
2 stop bits  
Even  
Data length  
Unit #  
ASCII 7 bits  
00  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
Set the PLC Setup area settings directly from a Programming Device (e.g.  
CX-Programmer).  
For details on operations relating to the PLC Setup area, refer to the manual  
for the PLC which is used.  
The PLC Setup area word numbers and settings to be made depending on  
the Unit and port to which the connection is made are shown below.  
CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1H, or SRM1: Peripheral port connection  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
DM6650 0001  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6651 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6653 0000  
Unit # 00  
C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H (other  
than the CPU11), or SRM1: Built-in RS-232C port connection  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
DM6645 0001  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6646 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6648 0000  
Unit # 00  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E: Serial Communications Board port A  
CQM1H: Serial Communications Board port 1  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
DM6555 0001  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
DM6556 0303  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6558 0000  
Unit # 00  
When using port B of the Communications Board of C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
DM6550 0001  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6551 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6553 0000  
When using a CPM1  
Unit # 00  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
Host link mode  
DM6650 0001  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6651 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6653 0000  
Connecting to a CPM2C  
Unit # 00  
The CPM2C PLCs do not have the same kind of port connectors found on CS/  
CJ-series PLCs. The CPM2C’s communications port handles both RS-232C  
and peripheral port connections which are divided internally. Therefore, when  
using the CPM2C, it is necessary to select RS-232C or peripheral port con-  
nections, according to the kind of cable and port (on the cable) used, as  
shown in the following table. Refer to the CPM2C Operation Manual for more  
details.  
Port connecting to PT  
PLC Setup  
RS-232C port (D-Sub 9-pin) of CPM2C-CN111 Built-in RS-232C port settings  
Peripheral port of CPM2C-CN111  
Peripheral port settings  
Built-in RS-232C port settings  
Peripheral port settings  
RS-232C port (D-Sub 9-pin) of CS1W-CN118  
Peripheral port of CS1W-CN114  
Peripheral port  
CPM2C-CN111  
CPM2C  
CPM2C  
CPM2C  
CS1W-CN118  
CS1W-CN114  
Peripheral port  
RS-232C port  
(D-Sub 9-pin, female)  
RS-232C port  
(D-Sub 9-pin, female)  
Setting the DIP Switches of a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1 or CQM1H  
When using a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1, or CQM1H the DIP switches on  
the front panel must be set as shown below in order to make the settings in  
the PLC Setup area (data memory) effective.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
CQM1  
CQM1H  
RS-232C port communications condition setting  
Set DIP SW5 to OFF to make the settings made  
in PC Setup effective.  
When using the CQM1H’s built-in peripheral port, turn ON SW7.  
Setting the Switches of a CPM2A  
When using a CPM2A, the switches on the front panel must be set as shown  
below in order to make the PLC Setup settings effective.  
Set the Communications  
switch to OFF (down  
position).  
Setting the Switches of a CPM2C  
When using a CPM2C, the switches on the front panel must be set as shown  
below in order to make the PLC Setup settings effective.  
The settings for SW1 and SW2 depend upon the usage of  
the peripheral port and RS-232C port.  
Connecting PT to peripheral port  
Connecting PT to built-in RS-232C port  
(A device that requires non-standard communications settings  
is connected to the peripheral port.)  
SW1: OFF  
SW2: ON  
Connecting PT to built-in RS-232C port  
(A Programming Console is connected to the peripheral port.)  
SW1: OFF  
SW2: OFF  
Setting the Switches on a RS-232C Adapter  
When using a CPM1-CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, set the mode switch as shown  
in the following diagram.  
CPM1-  
CIF01  
CPM1  
Set the mode setting switch to HOST (upper position).  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
CS/CJ-series CPU Unit: CS1G/H-CPU@@-E(V1), CS1G/H/D-CPU@@H  
CJ1G/M-CPU@@, CJ1G/H-CPU@@H  
Connect to the built-in RS-232C port of the CPU Unit, or the RS-232C port of  
the Communications Board. Note that the connection to a peripheral port  
must be made via an RS-232C adapter (CS1W-CN118) specially designed for  
connecting to a peripheral port.  
PLC Setup  
When connecting to a CS/CJ-series CPU Unit, set the following communica-  
tions conditions for the PLC Setup area. Since the settings shown below are  
the PLC default settings for the CPU Unit, no change to the PLC Setup is nec-  
essary as long as the communications speed is maintained at 9600 bps.  
Item  
Communications speed  
Stop bits  
Setting at Host  
Set the same speed as set at the NT631/NT631C(*1)  
2 stop bits  
Even  
Parity  
Data length  
ASCII 7 bits  
00  
Unit No. for the host link  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
When the communications speed is set to 19200 bps., the PLC Setup of  
the CPU Unit need to be changed.  
Either set the PLC Setup directly from a Programming Device (Programming  
Console), or transmit the PLC Setup made at a Programming Device (CX-  
Programmer) to the CPU Unit.  
For details on the PLC Setup, refer to the SYSMAC CS Series Operation  
Manual (W339) or the SYSMAC CJ Series Operation Manual (W393).  
Using the CPU Unit’s Built-in RS-232C Port  
Word #  
Writing Value  
Settings  
160  
161  
8000  
Host link mode, data length 7 bits,  
2 stop bits, even parity  
0000  
0007  
0000  
Communications speed: 9600 bps.  
Communications speed: 19200 bps.  
Unit #00  
166  
Using the CPU Unit’s Peripheral Port  
Word # Writing Value  
Settings  
144  
8000  
Host link mode, data length 7 bits,  
2 stop bits, even parity  
145  
0000  
0007  
0000  
Communications speed: 9600 bps.  
Communications speed: 19200 bps.  
Unit #00  
150  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the CPU Unit’s DIP switches to 4 or 5 in accordance with the port NT631/  
NT631C is connected to. An example of a CS-series CPU Unit is shown  
below.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
RUN  
ERR/ALM  
INH  
PRPHL/COMM  
SYSMAC CS1G  
PROGRAMMABLE CONTROLLER  
CPU42  
DIP switches (inside the battery storage)  
Peripheral port  
OPEN  
Set SW4 to ON (establishing communications in  
accordance with PC Setup) when connecting the  
NT631/NT631C to a peripheral port.  
Set SW5 to OFF (establishing communications  
in accordance with PC Setup) when connecting  
the NT631/NT631C to a peripheral port.  
This is used mainly for  
connection to the  
MCPWR  
OPEN  
BUSY  
Programming Device.  
(This also supports the  
RS-232C unit connection.)  
RS-232 port  
PERIPHERAL  
This is used mainly for  
connection to the RS-232C  
unit.  
(This also supports the  
CX-Programmer.)  
PORT  
Connecting to CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board equipped with a RS-232C port for CS-series  
CPU Units: CS1W-SCB21(-V1)/41(-V1) (See note.)  
Note Cannot be used with the CS1D-CPU65H/67H.  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Settings are written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console  
or CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area)  
of the CPU Unit. After the settings are written, they become effective by turn-  
ing the power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or  
execution of the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and the set-  
tings are shown.  
Allocation DM area (words)  
Writing Value  
Settings  
Port 1  
Port 2  
DM32000  
DM32010  
8000  
Host link mode, 2 stop bits, even parity, data  
length 7 bits  
DM32001  
DM32011  
0000  
0007  
0000  
0000  
Communications speed 9600 bps.  
Communications speed 19200 bps.  
Transmit delay time 0 ms.  
DM32002  
DM32003  
DM32012  
DM32013  
No CTS control Unit No.0 for host link  
Connecting to a CS/CJ-  
CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Unit:  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
series Serial  
Communications Unit  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)/41(-V1)  
Setting the Front-panel Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit by using the rotary  
switch located on the front panel. Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver  
so that the values or symbols in the setting value window agree with the fol-  
lowing.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
SCU21  
RDY  
ERH  
SD2  
RD2  
RUN  
ERC  
SD1  
RD1  
UNIT  
Set the unit number to 0 through F so that  
it will not overlap with the numbers used in  
other units.  
F
0
No.  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Settings are written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console  
or CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area)  
of the CPU Unit. After the settings are written, they become effective by turn-  
ing the power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or  
execution of the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and the set-  
tings are shown.  
m=DM30000+100×unit # (CH)  
Allocation DM area (CH)  
Port 1 Port 2  
m+10  
Writing Value  
Settings  
m
8000  
Host link mode, 2 stop bits, even parity, data  
length 7 bits  
m+1  
m+11  
0000  
0007  
0000  
0000  
Communications speed 9600 bps.  
Communications speed 19200 bps.  
Transmit delay time 0 ms.  
m+2  
m+3  
m+12  
m+13  
No CTS control Unit No.0 for host link  
When Using the NT Link  
(1:1) Method  
Compatible Host Units  
Some models and series of OMRON PLCs have the NT link (1:1) function  
built in. With CQM1H PLCs, a Serial Communications Board can be added to  
provide 1:1 NT Link communications. Some C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E CPU Units  
can be connected by the NT link (1:1) method by installing a Communications  
Board.  
Check the model and series of the PLC against the type of CPU Unit before  
making the connections.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
The hosts that can be connected to the NT631/NT631C by the NT Link (1:1)  
method using the RS-232C ports of both Units are indicated in the table  
below.  
PLC Series CPU Units with Built-in  
NT Link Function  
CPU Units Connect- Connectable to  
able with Expansion  
Communications  
Board(*1)  
C Series  
C200HS-CPU21-E, -EC  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
C200HE (-ZE)  
C200HG (-ZE)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
X200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
C200HX (-ZE)  
CPM1-10CDR-@ (*2)  
CPM1-20CDR-@ (*2)  
CPM1-30CDR-@ (*2)  
CPM1A-10CD@-@ (*2)  
CPM1A-20CD@-@ (*2)  
CPM1A-30CD@-@ (*2)  
CPM1  
CPM1A-40CD@-@ (*2)  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
CPM2A  
CPM2C  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
(*3)  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU41-EV1  
CQM1-CPU42-EV1  
CQM1-CPU43-EV1  
CQM1-CPU44-EV1  
CQM1-CPU45-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU21  
CQM1  
CQM1H-CPU51 (*4)  
CQM1H-CPU61 (*4)  
CQM1H  
CQM1H-CPU51  
CQM1H-CPU61  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CV500  
CV Series  
(*5)  
CV1000  
CV2000  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
PLC Series CPU Units with Built-in  
CPU Units Connect- Connectable to  
able with Expansion  
NT Link Function  
Communications  
Board(*1)  
CVM1  
Series (*5)  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
CVM1  
CompoBus/ SRM1-C02-V1  
S Master  
SRM1  
Control Unit  
*1 One of the following Communications Boards is required: C200HW-  
COM02/COM04/COM05/COM06-EV1.  
*2 A CPM1-CIF01 Adapter is required.  
*3 Use a CPM2C-CN111 or CS1W-CN114/118 Connecting Cable, CPM1-  
CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, or CPM1-CIF11 RS-422A Adapter to connect.  
*4 A CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is required.  
*5 CPU Units of CVM1/CV-series PLCs without the suffix -EV@ cannot be  
connected.  
Reference:  
CS/CJ-series CPU Units cannot be connected with the 1:1 connection NT link  
method. Use the 1:N connection NT link method (standard or high-speed)  
instead to make the 1:1 connection. For details, refer to Using the NT Link  
(1:N) Method (page 65) or Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method  
(page 70).  
Settings at the Host  
The setting methods for each Unit are as follows.  
Connecting to a C-series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM1, CPM2A,  
CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H or SRM1 PLC  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
Write the PLC Setup area (data memory) settings directly from a Program-  
ming Device (e.g. CX-Programmer) in accordance with the host model and  
port.  
Host Model  
Word #  
Writing Value  
Setting  
RS-232C port of C200HS, C200HX/ DM6645  
HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM2A, CPM2C,  
CQM1, CQM1H, SRM1  
4000  
Use NT link  
(1:1)  
Port A of C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E (*1)  
DM6555  
Port 1 of CQM1H (*2)  
Port B of C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E (*1)  
DM6550  
CPM1  
DM6650  
*1 RS-232C port of the Communications Board  
*2 RS-232C port of the Serial Communications Board  
For details on operations relating to the PLC Setup area, refer to the manual  
for the PLC which is used.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Connecting to a CPM2C  
The CPM2C PLCs do not have the same kind of port connectors found on CS/  
CJ-series PLCs. The CPM2C’s communications port handles both RS-232C  
and peripheral port connections which are divided internally. Therefore, when  
using the CPM2C, it is necessary to select RS-232C or peripheral port con-  
nections, according to the kind of cable and port (on the cable) used, as  
shown in the following table. Refer to the CPM2C Operation Manual for more  
details.  
Port connecting to PT  
PLC Setup  
RS-232C port (D-Sub 9-pin) of CPM2C-CN111 Built-in RS-232C port settings  
Peripheral port of CPM2C-CN111  
Peripheral port settings  
Built-in RS-232C port settings  
Peripheral port settings  
RS-232C port (D-Sub 9-pin) of CS1W-CN118  
Peripheral port of CS1W-CN114  
Peripheral port  
CPM2C-CN111  
CPM2C  
CPM2C  
CPM2C  
CS1W-CN118  
CS1W-CN114  
Peripheral port  
RS-232C port  
(D-Sub 9-pin, female)  
RS-232C port  
(D-Sub 9-pin, female)  
Setting the DIP Switches of a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1, or CQM1H  
When using a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1, or CQM1H, the DIP switches on  
the front panel must be set as shown below in order to make the settings in  
the PLC Setup area (data memory) effective.  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
CQM1  
CQM1H  
RS-232C port communications condition setting  
Set DIP SW5 to OFF to make the settings made  
in PLC Setup effective.  
Setting the Switches of a CPM2A  
When using a CPM2A, the switches on the front panel must be set as shown  
below in order to make the PLC Setup settings effective.  
Set the Communications  
switch to OFF (down  
position).  
Setting the Switches of a CPM2C  
When using a CPM2C, the switches on the front panel must be set as shown  
below in order to make the PLC Setup settings effective.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
The settings for SW1 and SW2 depend upon the usage of the  
peripheral port and RS-232C port.  
Connecting PT to peripheral port  
Connecting PT to built-in RS-232C port  
(A device that requires non-standard communications  
settings is connected to the peripheral port.)  
SW1: OFF  
SW2: ON  
Connecting PT to built-in RS-232C port  
(A Programming Console is connected to the peripheral  
port.)  
SW1: OFF  
SW2: OFF  
Setting the Switches on an RS-232C Adapter  
When using a CPM1-CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, set the mode switch as shown  
in the following diagram.  
CPM1-  
CIF01  
Set the mode setting switch to NT (lower position).  
Connecting to CVM1/CV Series (-EV@)  
Set the DIP switches on the front panel as follows.  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-232C.  
DIP switch setting (SW3)  
6
5
4
3
2
1
Set SW3 to use NT Link  
(ON, right side).  
OFF  
ON  
When using a CVM1/CV-series PLC, CPU Unit execution processing (execu-  
tion control 2) in the PLC Setup must be set to Simultaneous processing.  
Using the NT Link (1:N)  
Method  
Compatible Host Units  
The OMRON PLCs that can be connected using the NT link (1:N) method are  
the CS/CJ-series CPU Units and the C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1H,  
and SRM1 only. With the CS/CJ-series PLCs, it is possible to connect a 1:N  
NT Link using a Serial Communications Board (CS Series only) or a Serial  
Communications Unit.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Check the model and series of the PLC as well as the model of Serial Com-  
munications Board or Unit being used before making the connections.  
The hosts that can be connected to the NT631/NT631C by the NT link (1:N)  
method using the RS-232C ports of both Units are indicated in the table  
below.  
PLC Series CPU Units with Built-in NT Link  
Function  
CPU Units Connectable with  
Communications Board/Unit  
Connectable  
to  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/  
67H(*1)  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*2)  
CJ1G-CPU44/45(*3)  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*3)  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H(*3)  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23(*3)  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE(*4)  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE(*4)  
CQM1H-CPU51(*5)  
CS Series CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/  
67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CJ Series  
C Series  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
C200HE (-Z)E  
C200HG (-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
C200HX (-Z)E  
---  
CQM1H  
SRM1  
CQM1H-CPU61(*5)  
CompoBus/ SRM1-C02-V2  
S Master  
---  
Control Unit  
*1 A CS1W-SCB21(-V1) or CS1W-SCB41(-V1) Serial Communications Board  
or CS1W-SCU21(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is required.  
*2 A CS1W-SCU21(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is required. A CS1W-  
SCB21/41(-V1) Serial Communications Board cannot be used.  
*3 One of the following Communications Units is required:  
CJ1W-SCU21/41(-V1).  
*4 One of the following Communications Boards is required:  
C200HW-COM02/COM04/COM05/COM06-E(V1)  
*5 A CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is required.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Reference:  
Version 1 (-V1) and high-speed versions (H) of the CS-series and CJ-series  
CPU Units support the high-speed 1:N NT Link method in addition to the  
standard 1:N NT Link method. Furthermore, the high-speed 1:N NT Link  
method can be used in earlier versions of CS-series CPU Units by installing  
the latest version of a Serial Communications Board or Unit. For details, refer  
to Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method (page 70).  
Settings at the Host  
The Settings required for each Unit are described below.  
• Connecting a C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1H, or SRM1  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
Write the PLC Setup area (data memory) settings directly from a Program-  
ming Device (e.g. CX-Programmer) in accordance with the host model and  
port.  
Connection to  
Word #  
Writing  
Value  
Setting  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, SRM1  
Built-in RS-232C port  
DM6645 5@00  
Use NT link (1:N)  
@ = highest unit number of  
the connected PTs (1 to 7)  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Communications Board port A*1  
DM6555  
(*3)  
CQM1H port 1*2  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
DM6550  
Communications Board port B*1  
*1 RS-232C port on the Communications Board  
*2 RS-232C port on the Serial Communications Board  
*3 When using a C200HE(-Z)E, the maximum PT unit number is 3.  
Refer to the PLC’s operation manual for details on changing PLC Setup set-  
tings.  
Setting the DIP Switches of a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
When using a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, the DIP switches on the front panel must  
be set as shown below in order to make the settings in the PLC Setup area  
(data memory) effective.  
RS-232C port communications condition setting  
Set DIP SW5 to OFF to make the settings made in  
PLC Setup effective.  
Connecting to CS/CJ-series CPU Units  
CS/CJ-series CPU Unit: CS1G/H-CPU@@-E(V1), CS1G/H/D-CPU@@H,  
CJ1G/M-CPU@@, CJ1G/H-CPU@@H  
Connect the PT to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port. Use a CS1W-CN118  
Connecting Cable, however, if connecting the PT to the peripheral port of the  
CPU Unit.  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
When connecting to a CS/CJ-series CPU Unit, set the following communica-  
tions conditions for the PLC Setup area, in accordance with the communica-  
tions port to be used.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Using the CPU Unit's Built-in RS-232C Port  
Word # Writing Value  
8200  
Settings  
160  
161  
NT link (1:N) mode  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
Communications baud rate (standard)  
166  
000@  
@ = The largest model number of the con-  
nected PT (0 – 7)  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 Hex for the communications baud  
rate. The same baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it  
is between 0000 and 0009 Hex.  
Using the CPU Unit's Peripheral Port  
Word #  
Writing Value  
8200  
Settings  
144  
145  
NT link (1:N) mode  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
Communications baud rate (standard)  
150  
000@  
@ = The largest model number of the con-  
nected PT (0 – 7)  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 Hex for the communications baud  
rate. The same baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it  
is between 0000 and 0009 Hex.  
When connecting PT with its model number 0, 2-5 to the built-in RS-232C  
port, for example, set the value 8200 Hex to 160 CH, and 0005 Hex to 166CH.  
Either set PLC Setup directly from a Programming Device (Programming Con-  
sole), or transmit the PLC Setup made at a Programming Device (CX-Pro-  
grammer) to the CPU Unit.  
For details on the PLC Setup, refer to the SYSMAC CS Series Operation  
Manual (W339) or the SYSMAC CJ Series Operation Manual (W393).  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the CPU Unit’s DIP switch to 4 or 5 in accordance with the port NT631/  
NT631C is connected to. An example of a CS-series CPU Unit is shown  
below.  
RUN  
ERR/ALM  
INH  
PRPHL/COMM  
SYSMAC CS1G  
PROGRAMMABLE CONTROLLER  
CPU42  
DIP switches (inside the battery storage)  
OPEN  
Peripheral port  
Set SW4 to ON (establishing communications in  
This is used mainly for  
connection to the  
MCPWR  
OPEN  
BUSY  
accordance with PLC Setup) when connecting the  
NT631/NT631C to a peripheral port.  
Programming Device.  
(This also supports the  
RS-232C unit connection.)  
Set SW5 to OFF (establishing communications in  
accordance with PLC Setup) when connecting the  
NT631/NT631C to a peripheral port.  
PERIPHERAL  
RS-232 port  
This is used mainly  
for connection to the  
RS-232C unit.  
(This also supports  
the CX-Programmer.)  
PORT  
Connecting to CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board equipped with a RS-232C port for CS1-series  
CPU Units: CS1W-SCB21(-V1)/41(-V1) (See note.)  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Note Cannot be used with the CS1D-CPU65H/67H.  
CPU Unit Allocation DM Area Settings  
Setting is written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console or  
CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area) of  
the CPU Unit. After the setting is written, it becomes effective by turning the  
power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or execu-  
tion of the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and settings  
are shown.  
Allocated DM Area words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 1  
DM32000  
DM32001  
Port 2  
DM32010  
DM32011  
8200  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
1:N NT Link Mode  
Baud rate (standard)  
DM32006  
DM32016  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the  
connected PTs (0 to 7)  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 hex for the baud rate. The same  
baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it is between 0000  
and 0009 hex.  
When connecting PTs with model numbers 3 to 6 to port 1, for example, set  
the value 8200 hex to DM32000, 0000 hex to DM32001, and 0006 hex to  
DM32006.  
Connecting to CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit  
A CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Unit:  
CS1W-SCU21,  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)/41(-V1)  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit by using the rotary  
switch located on the front panel. Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver  
so that the values or symbols in the setting value window agree with the fol-  
lowing.  
SCU21  
RDY  
ERH  
SD2  
RD2  
RUN  
ERC  
SD1  
RD1  
UNIT  
Set the unit number to 0 through F so  
that it will not overlap with the numbers  
used in other units.  
F
0
No.  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Setting is written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console or  
CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area) of  
the CPU Unit. After the setting is written, it becomes effective by turning the  
power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or execu-  
tion of the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and settings  
are shown.  
m=DM30000+100*unit number (CH)  
Allocated DM Area words  
Port 1 Port 2  
m+10  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
m
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
m+1  
m+6  
m+11  
m+16  
Baud rate (standard)  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the  
connected PTs (0 to 7)  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 hex for the baud rate. The same  
baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it is between 0000  
and 0009 hex.  
Using the High-speed NT  
Link (1:N) Method  
Compatible Host Units  
The high-speed 1:N NT Link method can be used with version 1 (-V1) and  
high-speed versions (H) of the CS-series and CJ-series CPU Units. Further-  
more, the high-speed 1:N NT Link method can be used in earlier versions of  
CS-series and CJ-series CPU Units by installing the latest version of a Serial  
Communications Board (CS Series only) or Serial Communications Unit.  
Be sure to check the model number of the PLC and Serial Communications  
Board/Unit before trying to establish the high-speed 1:N NT Link.  
The following table shows which CS-series PLCs can be connected to an  
NT631/NT631C with the high-speed 1:N NT Link.  
PLC Series  
CPU Units with Built-in NT  
Link Function  
CPU Units Connectable with  
Communications Board/Unit  
Connectable to  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-EV1(*1) CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)(*2)  
CS Series  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-  
EV1(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-  
E(V1)(*2)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*2)  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/  
67H(*2)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/  
67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*3)  
CJ1G-CPU44/45(*4)  
CJ Series  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*4)  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H(*4)  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23(*4)  
*1 The high-speed 1:N NT Link is not supported in a direct connection to the  
CPU Unit of a CS1-series PLC without the -V1 suffix.  
*2 A CS1W-SCB21 or CS1W-SCB41(-V1) Serial Communications Board or  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is required.  
*3 A CS1W-SCU21(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is required.  
A CS1W-SCB21/41(-V1) Serial Communications Board cannot be used.  
*4 One of the following Communications Units is required:  
CJ1W-SCU21/41(-V1).  
Settings at the Host  
The Settings required for each Unit are described below.  
• Connecting CS/CJ-series CPU Units  
CS/CJ-series CPU Unit: CS1G/H-CPU@@-EV1, CS1G/H/D-CPU@@H-E,  
CJ1G/M-CPU@@-E, CJ1GH-CPU@@H-E  
Connect the PT to the CPU Unit’s built-in RS-232C port. Use a CS1W-CN118  
Connecting Cable, however, if connecting the PT to the peripheral port of the  
CPU Unit.  
PLC Setup  
When connecting to a CS-series CPU Unit, set the following communications  
conditions for the PLC Setup area, in accordance with the communications  
port to be used.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Using the CPU Unit's Built-in RS-232C Port  
Word # Setting  
Setting Contents  
1:N NT Link Mode  
Baud rate (standard)  
160  
161  
166  
8200  
000A  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the connected  
PTs (0 to 7)  
Using the CPU Unit's Peripheral Port  
Word # Setting  
Setting Contents  
1:N NT Link Mode  
144  
145  
150  
8200  
000A  
000@  
Baud rate (standard)  
@ = The highest unit number of the connected  
PTs (0 to 7)  
When connecting PTs with model numbers 0, 2, 3, 4, and 5 to the built-in RS-  
232C port, for example, set the value 8200 hex to word 160, 000A hex to word  
161, and 0005 hex to word 166.  
Either set PLC Setup directly from a Programming Device (Programming Con-  
sole), or transmit the PLC Setup made at a Programming Device (CX-Pro-  
grammer) to the CPU Unit.  
For details on the PLC Setup, refer to the SYSMAC CS Series Operation  
Manual (W339) or the SYSMAC CJ Series Operation Manual (W393).  
Reference:  
When using the CX-Programmer to set the high-speed 1:N NT Link, set the  
communications baud rate to 115,200 bps.  
Setting The Front Switches  
Set the CPU Unit’s DIP switch to 4 or 5 in accordance with the port NT631/  
NT631C is connected to. An example of a CS-series CPU Unit is shown  
below.  
RUN  
ERR/ALM  
INH  
PRPHL/COMM  
SYSMAC CS1G  
PROGRAMMABLE CONTROLLER  
CPU42  
DIP switches (inside the battery storage)  
OPEN  
Peripheral port  
Set SW4 to ON (establishing communications in  
MCPWR  
OPEN  
BUSY  
This is used mainly for  
connection to the  
Programming Device.  
(This also supports  
connection of RS-232C  
devices.)  
accordance with PLC Setup) when connecting the  
NT631/NT631C to the peripheral port.  
Set SW5 to OFF (establishing communications in  
accordance with PLC Setup) when connecting  
the NT631/NT631C to the RS-232C port.  
PERIPHERAL  
RS-232 port  
This is used mainly for  
connection of RS-232C  
devices.  
(This also supports connection  
of the CX-Programmer.)  
PORT  
Connecting to a CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board equipped with a RS-232C port for CS-series  
CPU Units: CS1W-SCB21(-V1)/41(-V1)  
Note Cannot be used with the CS1D-CPU65H/67H.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Reference:  
CS-series Serial Communications Boards and Units with lot number 991220  
(12/20/99) and later support the high-speed 1:N NT Link. Boards and Units  
with earlier lot numbers cannot be used.  
CPU Unit Allocation DM Area Settings  
Setting is written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console or  
CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area) of  
the CPU Unit. After the setting is written, it becomes effective by turning the  
power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or execu-  
tion of the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and settings  
are shown.  
Allocated DM Area words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 1  
DM32000  
DM32001  
DM32006  
Port 2  
DM32010  
DM32011  
DM32016  
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
000A  
Baud rate (standard)  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the con-  
nected PTs (0 to 7)  
For example, when connecting PTs with model numbers 3, 4, 5, and 6 to port  
1, set the value 8200 hex to DM32000, 000A hex to DM32001, and 0006 hex  
to DM32006.  
Connecting to a CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit  
A CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Unit: CS1W-SCU21(-V1),  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)/41(-V1)  
Reference:  
CS-series Serial Communications Boards and Units with lot number 991220  
(12/20/99) and later support the high-speed 1:N NT Link. Boards and Units  
with earlier lot numbers cannot be used.  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit by using the rotary  
switch located on the front panel. Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver  
so that the values or symbols in the setting value window agree with the fol-  
lowing.  
SCU21  
RDY  
ERH  
SD2  
RD2  
RUN  
ERC  
SD1  
RD1  
Set the unit number to 0 through F so  
that it will not overlap with the numbers  
used in other units.  
UNIT  
F
0
1
No.  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Setting is written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console or  
CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area) of  
the CPU Unit. After the setting is written, it becomes effective by turning the  
power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or execu-  
tion of the STUP command.  
In the following table, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and set-  
tings are shown.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Word m = DM30000 + (100 × unit number)  
Allocated DM Area words  
Port 1 Port 2  
m+10  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
m
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
m+1  
m+6  
m+11  
m+16  
000A  
Baud rate (standard)  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the con-  
nected PTs (0 to 7)  
When Using the Memory  
Link Method  
In the memory link method, the connection can be made to a personal com-  
puter with RS-232 and an FA computer, etc.  
When connecting to the host in the memory link method, it is necessary to  
create a program for the memory link at the host side.  
The following are the communications conditions that can be used in the  
memory link method. For the host (a personal computer, an FA computer,  
etc.), its setting should be compatible to one of the communications condi-  
tions listed in the following table. Set the same communications conditions at  
the NT631/NT631C by the memory switch. (page 160).  
Item  
Input/Output port  
Communications speed  
Data bits length  
Stop bits length  
Parity  
Settings at the host  
RS-232C  
1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 bps.  
7 bits, 8 bits  
1 bits, 2 bits  
None, even, odd  
Flow control  
None, RS/CS, XON/XOFF  
4-1-2 Connecting Directly between RS-232C Ports  
The method for connection between the RS-232C ports of the NT631/  
NT631C and the host is described here.  
Host Link Unit or CPU Unit  
SYSMAC  
NT631/NT631C  
R
E
S
E
T
R
D
TR  
M
R
D
B
S
D
A
CS/CJ-series PLC,  
S
D
B
C
S
A
C
S
B
2
4V  
C-series PLC,  
CVM1/CV-series PLC,  
SRM1  
+D  
C
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
Serial port A or B  
(RS-232C, 9-pin type)  
9-pin connector  
9-pin connector  
or  
25-pin connector  
Cable with RS-232C connectors  
Recommended Connector Cable  
When making the connector cable, as far as possible use the recommended  
connectors, connector hoods, and cables indicated in the table below. Some  
Units come supplied with one connector and one connector hood.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Check the required components and prepare them in advance.  
Name Model Remarks Delivered with  
Connector XM2A-0901  
9-pin  
CS-series CS1G/CS1H/  
CS1D,  
Made by OMRON  
CJ-series CJ1G/CJ1H/  
CJ1M,  
C-series CQM1,  
C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E,  
CVM1/CV-series CPU  
Units  
CV500-LK201  
XM24-2501  
DB-25P  
25-pin  
C500-LK203  
Made by OMRON  
CV500-LK201  
C200H-LK201-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
25-pin  
Made by JAE  
9-pin  
Connector XM2S-0911  
hood  
C-series CQM1,  
C200HS,  
Made by OMRON  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E,  
CVM1/CV-series CPU  
Units  
CV500-LK201  
XM2S-0913  
9-pin  
Made by OMRON  
XM2S-0911-E  
9-pin  
Made by OMRON  
CS-series CS1G/CS1H/  
CS1D,  
CJ-series CJ1G/CJ1H/  
CJ1M  
XM2S-2511  
DB-C2-J9  
25-pin  
Made by OMRON  
C500-LK203  
CV500-LK201  
C200H-LK201-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
25-pin  
Made by JAE  
Cable  
AWG28×5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multi-core shielded cable  
Made by Fujikura, Ltd.  
CO-MA-VV-SB Multi-core shielded cable  
5P×28AWG  
Made by Hitachi Cable,  
Ltd.  
Note  
After connecting a communications cable, always secure it with the screws.  
OMRON Cables with Connectors  
When a connection is made at serial port A in other than the memory link  
method, OMRON cables with connectors shown below are available.  
Model  
XW2Z-200S  
XW2Z-500S  
XW2Z-200T  
XW2Z-500T  
Cable Length  
Connector Specification  
9-pin 25 pin  
2 m  
5 m  
2 m  
5 m  
9-pin 9-pin  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
When a connection is made to a personal computer at serial port A in the  
memory link method, OMRON cable with connectors shown below are avail-  
able.  
Model  
Cable Length  
Connector Specification  
9-pin 25 pin  
9-pin 9 pin  
CV500-CN228 2 m  
XW2Z-S002  
2 m  
Note  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Wiring for a Host Link Unit  
(25-pin) Connection  
Applicable Units: C200H-LK201-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C500-LK203  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
CV500-LK201 (communications port 1)  
Cables with connectors that can be used at serial port A:  
XW2Z-200S (9-pin 25-pin, 2 m)  
XW2Z-500S (9-pin 25-pin, 5 m)  
CVM1/CV-series Host Link Units (CV500-LK201) have two types of connec-  
tor; a 25-pin connector (communications port 1), and a 9-pin connector (com-  
munications port 2). When using communications port 2, refer to Wiring for  
Other Connections (Other Than the Memory Link Method) (page 75).  
Serial Port A, B  
1
14  
NT631/NT631C  
PLC (host link unit)  
6
1
Pin  
Pin  
Abbreviation  
number  
Abbreviation  
number  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
1
FG  
FG  
2
1
SD  
2
3
4
5
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
RD  
RS  
CS  
-
RS-232C  
interface  
3
4
5
RS-232C  
interface  
6
7
8
-
*
SG  
-
6
7
8
9
-
-
SG  
-
(9-pin type)  
9
5
-
-
-
ER  
(25-pin type)  
13  
25  
* For Units that have a CTS setting selector switch, RS and CS do not have  
to be shorted if this switch is set to 0 V.  
Wiring for Other  
Connections  
Applicable Units:  
CV500-LK201 (communications port 2)  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU41-EV1  
CQM1-CPU43-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU11  
CQM1-CPU42-EV1  
CQM1-CPU44-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU21  
CQM1H-CPU51  
CQM1H-CPU61  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
C200HS-CPU21-E, -EC  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
SRM1-C02-V2  
Cables with connectors that can be used at serial port A:  
XW2Z-200T (9-pin 9-pin, 2 m)  
XW2Z-500T (9-pin 9-pin, 5 m)  
CPU Units of CVM1/CV-series PLCs without the suffix -EV@ cannot be con-  
nected by any connection method.  
When connecting to the peripheral port of a CS/CJ-series CPU Unit, a CS1W-  
CN118 Connecting Cable is required in addition to the above cables.  
Serial Port A, B  
6
6
NT631/NT631C  
PLC (Host link unit)  
1
1
Pin  
Pin  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
number  
number  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
Connector  
FG  
FG  
-
hood  
1
2
SD  
2
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
-
3
4
5
RD  
RS  
CS  
-
RS-232C  
interface  
3
4
5
RS-232C  
interface  
6
7
8
9
-
6
7
8
9
-
-
SG  
SG  
(9-pin type)  
9
9
5
5
(9-pin type)  
Wiring for a Memory Link  
Connection  
Cables with connectors that can be used:  
CV500-CN228 (9-pin25-pin, 2 m)  
XW2Z-S002 (9-pin9-pin, 2 m)  
Serial Port A, B  
Prepare the adapter cable while referring to the following diagram.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
Host side  
NT631/NT631C  
Pin  
Abbreviation  
6
Abbreviation  
1
number  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
Connector  
hood  
FG  
1
2
SD  
RD  
RS-232C  
interface  
SD  
RD  
RS  
3
4
RS  
CS  
SG  
RS-232C  
interface  
5
6
CS  
+5V  
7
8
9
SG  
(9-pin type)  
9
5
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the RS-232C Port at the Host  
Section 4-1  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 5  
Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port  
5-1 Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
80  
at the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
86  
90  
5-1-4 Recommended Connectors, Cables, and Crimp Terminals . . . . . . .  
5-1-5 Setting the Terminal Resistance for RS-422A/485 Communications  
5-2 Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
5-2-1 Host Types and Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
5-2-2 Direct Connection between RS-422A Ports at Both Units . . . . . . .  
5-2-3 Direct Connection between RS-485 Ports at Both Units . . . . . . . . .  
5-2-4 1:N Connection among RS-422A Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
5-2-5 1:N Connection among RS-485 Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
5-2-6 Recommended Connectors, Cables and Crimp Terminals. . . . . . . .  
5-2-7 Setting the Terminal Resistance for RS-422A/485 Communications  
5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-422A/485 Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
92  
93  
94  
115  
118  
119  
121  
123  
124  
125  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
5-1 Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
The methods for connecting the RS-422A/485 port of the NT631/NT631C and  
the RS-232C port of the host are described here. There are the following  
methods.  
The following discussion is focused on the connection method to OMRON  
PLCs (By using the memory link method, a connection can be made to any  
arbitrary RS-232 unit). When making a connection to a host other than  
OMRON PLCs, refer to the PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@) or NT31/  
631 Multi Vendor Connection Manual (V060-E1-@).  
• Method in which the RS-422A port of the NT631/NT631C and the RS-  
232C port of the host are connected in a 1:1 connection via an RS-232C/  
RS-422A Adapter (page 82).  
When this method is used, the cable length can be extended up to  
500 m.  
PT  
Host  
RS-232C/RS-422A  
convertor unit  
RS-422A cable  
(max. 500 m)  
RS-232C  
cable  
(max. 2 m)  
• Method in which the RS-485 port of the NT631/NT631C and the RS-232C  
port of the host are connected in a 1:1 connection via an RS-232C/RS-  
422A Adapter (page 82).  
When this method is used, the cable length can be extended up to  
500 m. This connection method can be used only with the NT Link  
(1:N) method of type RS-485.  
RS-232C/RS-422A  
convertor unit  
PT  
Host  
RS-485 cable  
(max. 500 m)  
RS-232C  
cable  
(max. 2 m)  
• Method in which the RS-422A ports of multiple NT631/NT631Cs and the  
RS-232C port of the host are connected in a 1:N connection via an RS-  
232C/RS-422A Adapter (page 86).  
This connection method is used with the RS-422A NT Link (1:N) meth-  
od.  
PT  
Host  
RS-232C/RS422A  
convertor unit  
RS-232C  
RS-422A cable  
(max. total length  
500 m)  
cable  
(max. 2 m)  
• Method in which the RS-485 ports of multiple NT631/NT631Cs and the  
RS-232C port of the host are connected in a 1:N connection via an RS-  
232C/RS-422A Adapter (page 86).  
This connection method is used with the RS-485 NT Link (1:N) method  
(standard or high-speed).  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
RS-232C/RS422A  
convertor unit  
PT  
Host  
RS-232C  
RS-485 cable  
(max. total length  
500 m)  
cable  
(max. 2 m)  
Note  
One end of the wire must always be connected to the host (PLC), and there  
must be no branching. Branching will cause problems such as transmission  
delays and communications failures.  
PLC  
PLC  
Relay terminal block  
PLC  
(At termination)  
NT631  
Relay terminal block  
Max. 2 m  
NT631  
(At  
NT631C  
NT631  
NT631C  
NT631  
NT631  
NT631C  
NT631  
NT631  
(Not at  
(Not at  
(Not at  
termination)  
termination)  
termination)  
termination)  
Example of Good Connection  
Examples of Bad Connections  
Reference:  
CS/CJ-series CPU Units cannot be connected with the 1:1 connection NT  
Link method. Use the 1:N connection NT Link method (standard or high-  
speed) instead to make the 1:1 connection. For details, refer to Using the NT  
Link (1:N) Method (page 65) or Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method  
(page 70).  
5-1-1 The Type of Host and Settings  
The using condition is the same as the connecting PT side RS-232C and the  
host side RS-232C.  
For the available type and settings of the host, refer to the pages listed below.  
Method  
Reference  
Host Link Method (page 48)  
Host link  
NT Link (1:1)  
NT Link (1:N)  
NT Link (1:1) method (page 61)  
Using the NT Link (1:N) Method (page 65)  
High-speed NT Link (1:N) Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method (page 70)  
Memory link Memory Link Method (page 73)  
Settings at the RS-232C/  
RS-422A Adapter (NT-  
AL001)  
When making a connection between RS-232C and RS-422A/485 ports using  
an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter, set the DIP switches on the NT-AL001 as fol-  
lows.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Example: the terminal resistor is active,  
RS-422A, NT Link (1:N).  
ON  
omRon  
NT-AL001  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Built-in terminal resistor setting (DIP SW1-2)  
If at the end of the RS-422A/485 cable, set this switch  
to ON (to activate the built-in terminal resistor).  
If not at the end of the RS-422A/485 cable, set this  
switch to OFF (to inactivate the built-in terminal  
resistor).  
2-wire type/4-wire type selection (DIP SW1-3, SW1-4)  
For RS-422A, set both of these switches to OFF (4-wire type).  
For RS-485, set both of these switches to ON (2-wire type).  
Selection of RS-422A/485 send mode (DIP SW1-5, SW1-6)  
For host link or NT Link (1:1), set both of these switches to  
OFF. (Always send)  
For NT Link (1:N), set SW1-5 to OFF and SW1-6 to ON.  
(Sends when CS is H)  
Note  
Read the manual supplied with the NT-AL001 carefully before using the Unit.  
5-1-2 1:1 Connection between RS-422A/485 at the PT and RS-232C at  
the Host  
The connection method in which the RS-422A/485 port of an NT631/NT631C  
and the RS-232C port of a host are connected via a Adapter is described  
here.  
An RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter (NT-AL001) is used to convert between the  
RS-232C and RS-422A communications methods.  
Host Link Unit or CPU Unit  
NT631/NT631C  
R
E
S
E
T
SYSMAC  
R
D
A
TR  
M
R
D
B
CS/CJ-series PLC  
C-series PLC,  
CVM1/CV-series PLC,  
SRM1  
S
D
A
S
D
B
C
S
A
C
S
B
2
4V  
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+D  
C
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485,  
terminal block)  
RS-232C/RS-422A  
convertor unit  
(NT-AL001)  
9-pin connector or  
25-pin connector  
RS-422A/485 cable  
(max. length: 500 m)  
RS-232C cable  
with connectors  
RS-422A terminal block  
9-pin connector  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Reference:  
When using RS-485 as a port for the NT631/NT631C, only NT Link (1:N)  
method (standard or high-speed) can be used.  
Connecting an NT631/NT631C and NT-AL001 (RS-422A)  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-422A  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT-AL001 side  
Short-circuit  
tool  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
Pin number Abbreviation  
6
5
RDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
8
6
TRM  
RS-422A/  
485  
7
5
4
3
1
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
terminal  
block  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
4
3
2
1
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding wire  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Connecting an NT631/NT631C and NT-AL001 (RS-485)  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-485  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT-AL001 side  
Short-circuit  
tool  
Abbreviation  
Pin number  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
6
RDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
5
4
8
6
4
2
7
5
3
1
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
RS-422A/  
485  
SDA (-)  
terminal  
3
1
block  
Functional  
ground  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding wire  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Reference:  
When using RS-485 as a port for the NT631/NT631C, only NT Link (1:N)  
method (standard or high-speed) can be used.  
Connecting an NT-AL001 and Host  
Host  
NT631/NT631C  
NT-AL001  
RS-232C  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Wiring When Connecting a Host Link Unit (25-pin)  
Applicable Units:  
C200H-LK201-V1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C500-LK203  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
CV500-LK201 (communications port 1)  
CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit (CV500-LK201) has two types of connector: a  
25-pin connector (communications port 1), and a 9-pin connector (communi-  
cations port 2). When using the communications port, refer to Wiring for Con-  
nections other than Memory Link (page 84).  
PLC (host link unit) side  
NT-AL001 side  
Abbreviation Pin number  
Connector  
Abbreviation  
1
FG  
FG  
SD  
Pin number  
hood  
14  
Shielding wire  
6
1
Connector  
hood  
1
FG  
1
2
2
RS-232C  
connector  
SD  
RD  
3
4
5
RD  
RS  
CS  
RS-232C  
connector  
3
4
RS  
CS  
5
6
7
8
6
7
+5V  
SG  
8
9
SG  
(9-pin type)  
9
20  
ER  
5
(25-pin type)  
13  
25  
Wiring for Connections Other Than Memory Link  
Applicable Units:  
CV500-LK201 (communications port 2)  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU41/42/43/44-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU11/21/51/61  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
C200HS-CPU21/23/31/33  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
C200HE-CPU32/42(-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63(-Z)E  
C200HZ-CPU34/44/54/64(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
SRM1-C02-V2  
Usable Cables with Attached Connectors:  
• For host link, 1:1 NT Link, or 1:N NT Link (+5 V power supplied from PLC)  
XW2Z-070T-1(9-pin to 9-pin, 0.7 m)  
XW2Z-200T-1(9-pin to 9-pin, 2 m)  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units whose model names do not have the suffix -EV@  
cannot be connected by any connection method.  
When connecting to the peripheral port of a CS/CJ-series CPU Unit, a CS1W-  
CN118 Connecting Cable is required in addition to the above cables. (Supply  
power to the +5-V output of the NT-AL001 from an external power supply  
when using this method.)  
NT-AL001 side  
PLC side  
6
1
6
1
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation Pin number  
Connector  
Pin number  
Connector  
hood  
FG  
FG  
hood  
1
1
2
SD  
RD  
2
SD  
RD  
RS-232C  
connector  
RS-232C  
connector  
3
4
3
4
RS  
CS  
RS  
CS  
5
6
7
8
5
6
7
8
+5V  
+5V  
9
9
SG  
SG  
Shielding wire  
9
(9-pin type)  
(9-pin type)  
9
5
5
When there is no +5 V output at the PLC side  
When there is +5 V output at the PLC side  
When using host link or NT Link (1:1)  
When using NT Link (1:N)  
• When using the host link or NT Link (1:1) method, short the RS and CS  
terminals at the PLC side with each other (leave the RS and CS terminals  
at the NT-AL001 side open).  
• When using the NT Link (1:N), cross-connect the RS and CS terminals at  
the NT-AL001 and PLC sides.  
If there is +5 V output at the PLC side, no external power supply is re-  
quired for the NT-AL001.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Wiring for a Memory Link Connection  
Prepare the adapter cable while referring to the diagram shown below.  
Host side  
Abbreviation  
NT-AL001 side  
Abbreviation Pin number  
6
1
Connector  
hood  
Connector  
hood  
FG  
1
SD  
RD  
RS-232C  
connector  
SD  
RD  
2
RS-232C  
connector  
RS  
3
4
RS  
CS  
CS  
5
6
+5V  
+5V  
SG  
8
9
SG  
(9-pin type)  
Shielding wire  
9
5
No +5 V output is at the host side  
A +5 V output is present at the host side  
Since it is necessary to input a voltage of +5 V to the number 6 pin of NT-  
AL001, supplying a voltage of 5 V from the host or an external voltage supply  
for NT-AL001 is required.  
5-1-3 1:N Connection between RS-422A/485 at the PT and RS-232C at  
the Host  
The connection method in which the RS-422A/485 ports of multiple NT631/  
NT631Cs are connected to the RS-232C port of one host in a 1:N connection  
is described here.  
An RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter (NT-AL001) is used to convert between the  
RS-232C and RS-422A/485 communications methods.  
Host Link Unit or CPU Unit  
CS/CJ-series PLC,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
RS-232C/RS-422A  
convertor unit  
(NT-AL001)  
9-pin connector  
RS-422A/485 cable  
(max. total length: 500 m)  
RS-232C cable with  
connectors  
NT631/NT631C  
NT631/NT631C  
NT631/NT631C  
RS-422A terminal  
block  
9-pin connector  
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485, terminal block)  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Connecting an NT631/  
NT631C and NT-AL001  
(RS-422A)  
The relay terminal board is not included in the figure below. Insert a relay ter-  
minal board so as to achieve the wiring configuration indicated below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-422A  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT-AL001 side  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
Pin number Abbreviation  
8
RDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
6
5
7
5
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
TRM  
6
4
RS-422A/  
485  
RDB (+)  
4
3
terminal  
SDA (-)  
block  
3
1
Functional  
ground  
SDB (+)  
1
2
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Shielding wire  
Functional  
ground  
Next PT  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Connecting an NT631/  
NT631C and NT-AL001(RS-  
485)  
The relay terminal board is not included in the figure below. Insert a relay ter-  
minal board so as to achieve the wiring configuration indicated below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-485  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT-AL001 side  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
Pin number Abbreviation  
8
RDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
6
5
7
5
3
1
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
6
4
RS-422A/  
RDB (+)  
4
3
485  
terminal  
SDA (-)  
Functional  
ground  
block  
SDB (+)  
1
2
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Shielding wire  
Functional  
ground  
Next PT  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Connection between  
NT631/NT631C Units (RS-  
422A)  
The relay terminal board is not included in the figure below. Insert a relay ter-  
minal board so as to achieve the wiring configuration indicated below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-422A  
:
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Short-circuit tool  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
:
RDA (-)  
TRM  
TRM  
RS-422A/  
RS-422A/  
485  
485  
RDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
terminal  
terminal  
block  
block  
SDA (-)  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding  
wire  
24V  
+DC  
24V  
+DC  
* Short TRM and RDA terminals of the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-  
422A cable (* marked in the above figure) using the short-circuit tool sup-  
plied with the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Connection between  
NT631/NT631C Units (RS-  
485)  
The relay terminal board is not included in the figure below. Insert a relay ter-  
minal board so as to achieve the wiring configuration indicated below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-485  
:
NT631/NT631C side  
NT631/NT631C side  
Short-circuit tool  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
:
RDA (-)  
TRM  
TRM  
RS-422A/  
485  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A/  
RDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
485  
terminal  
block  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding wire  
24V  
+DC  
24V  
+DC  
* Short TRM and RDA terminals of the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-  
485 cable (* marked in the above figure) using the short-circuit tool sup-  
plied with the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Connecting an NT-AL001 and Host  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
NT-AL001  
RS-232C  
Wiring when connecting a CS-series Serial Communications Board, CS/  
CJ-series Serial Communications Unit, CQM1H Serial Communications  
Board, or C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications Board  
Applicable Units:  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)/CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H (See note.)  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
C200HE-CPU32/42(-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65–ZE/85–ZE  
Note A Serial Communications Board cannot be installed.  
Usable Cables with Attached Connectors:  
For host link, 1:1 NT Link, or 1:N NT Link (+5 V power supplied from PLC)  
XW2Z-070T-1(9-pin to 9-pin, 0.7 m)  
XW2Z-200T-1(9-pin to 9-pin, 2 m)  
NT-AL001 side  
PLC side  
6
6
1
1
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation Pin number  
Connector  
Pin number  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
FG  
FG  
hood  
1
1
2
SD  
RD  
2
SD  
RD  
RS-232C  
connector  
RS-232C  
connector  
3
4
3
4
RS  
CS  
RS  
CS  
5
6
7
8
5
6
7
8
+5V  
+5V  
9
9
SG  
SG  
9
(9-pin type)  
(9-pin type)  
9
5
5
Since the CS1G/H, CQM1H, and C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E have a +5 V output,  
no external power supply is required for the NT-AL001.  
5-1-4 Recommended Connectors, Cables, and Crimp Terminals  
Connectors and Cables Recommended for RS-232C  
When making an RS-232C connecting cable, as far as possible use the rec-  
ommended parts indicated in the table below. Some Units come supplied with  
one connector and connector hood.  
Check the required parts and prepare them in advance.  
Name  
Model  
Remarks  
9-pin type  
Delivered with  
Connector XM2A-0901  
CS/CJ-series PLCs,  
C-series CQM1, C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Made by OMRON  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units  
CV500-LK201  
XM2A-2501  
DB-25P  
25-pin type  
C500-LK203  
Made by OMRON  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C200H-LK201-V1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
25-pin type  
Made by JAE  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Name  
Model  
Remarks  
9-pin type  
Delivered with  
Connector XM2S-0911  
hood  
C-series CQM1, C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Made by OMRON  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units  
CV500-LK201  
XM2S-0913  
XM2S-0911-E  
XM2S-2511  
Made by OMRON 9-pin  
Made by OMRON 9-pin CS/CJ-series CPU Units  
25-pin type  
C500-LK203  
Made by OMRON  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C200H-LK201-V1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
DB-C2-J9  
25-pin type  
Made by JAE  
Cable  
AWG28×5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multi-core shielded  
cable  
Made by Fujikura, Ltd.  
CO-MA-VV-SB Multi-core shielded  
5P×28AWG  
cable  
Made by Hitachi, Ltd.  
Cables with Connectors Made by OMRON  
When connecting an NT-AL001 and a PLC, use the OMRON cables with con-  
nectors indicated in the table below.  
Model  
Cable Length  
0.7 m  
Connector Specification  
9-pin 9-pin  
Host link, NT Link (1:1), NT Link (1:N)  
XW2Z-070T-1  
XW2Z-200T-1  
2 m  
+5 V power supplied from PLC  
(Use when the PLC has a +5 V output.)  
Note  
1. The maximum tensile load of the recommended cable is 30 N. Do not ex-  
ceed this load.  
2. After connecting a connecting cable, always tighten the connector screws.  
Recommended Connectors, Cables and Crimp Terminals for RS-422A/  
485  
When making an RS-422A/485 connecting cable, as far as possible use the  
recommended parts indicated in the table below. Some Units come supplied  
with one connector and connector hood.  
Check the required parts and prepare them in advance.  
Name  
Model  
Maker  
25-pin type  
Remarks  
Connector XM2A-2501  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
Made by OMRON  
C500-LK203  
DB-25P F-N  
25-pin type  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
Made by JAE  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
Connector XM2S-2511  
hood  
25-pin type  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
Made by OMRON  
C500-LK203  
DB-C2-J9  
25-pin type  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
Made by JAE  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-232C Port  
Section 5-1  
Name  
Model  
Maker  
Remarks  
Cable  
TKVVBS4P-03 Tachii Electric Wire  
Co., Ltd.  
Crimp ter- 1.25-N3A  
minals (fork type)  
Japan Solderless Recommended cable size:  
Terminal MFG  
AWG22 to 18  
(0.3 to 0.75 mm2)  
Y1.25-3.5L (fork Molex Inc.  
type)  
The terminal screws of the NT631/NT631C are M3.5 specification. When wir-  
ing, use crimp terminals for M3.5 use. Tighten terminal screws with a tighten-  
ing torque of 0.8 Nm.  
Note  
Always use crimp terminals for wiring.  
Examples of applicable terminals  
Fork type  
Round type  
7 mm max.  
7 mm max.  
5-1-5 Setting the Terminal Resistance for RS-422A/485  
Communications  
The serial port B connector of the NT631/NT631C has a terminal resistance  
setting terminal (TRM).  
In RS-422A/485 communications, a terminal resistor must be set at the device  
at the end of the communications cable, but not at any other device.  
The NT631/NT631C has a built-in terminal resistor, and whether or not the  
terminal resistance is applied is set by shorting or opening the terminal resis-  
tance setting terminals (TRM). The terminal resistance is 120 .  
When carrying out RS-422A/485 communications using serial port B, short  
between TRM and RDA terminals at the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-  
422A/485 cable. Leave these terminals open at NT631/NT631C PTs other  
than the one at the end of the cable.  
When not using RS-422A/485 communications, the terminal resistance set-  
ting is ineffective.  
Short-circuit tool  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
TRM-RDA terminals  
Function  
Terminal resistance is applied.  
Shorted  
Short only at the NT631/NT631C connected to the end of an  
RS-422A/485 cable.  
Open  
Terminal resistance is not applied.  
Leave the terminals open when connecting an NT631/  
NT631C anywhere other than at the end of the RS-422A/485  
cable.  
Note  
Before connecting or disconnecting cables between devices, make sure that  
the power supply to all of the connected devices (NT631/NT631C, PLC, etc.)  
is OFF.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Reference:  
• The internal circuit of the NT631/NT631C is shown below.  
RDA  
Terminal resistor (120 )  
TRM  
-
Making a connection here inserts a terminator between  
+ (RDB) and - (RDA).  
+
RDB  
• For details on setting the terminal resistance of NT-AL001, refer to Set-  
tings at the RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter (NT-AL001) (page 81).  
5-2 Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
The methods for connecting the RS-422A/485 port of the NT631/NT631C and  
the RS-422A/485 port of the host are described here. There are the following  
methods.  
The following discussion is focused on the connection method to OMRON  
PLCs (By using the memory link method, a connection can be made to any  
arbitrary RS-422 unit). When making a connection to a host other than  
OMRON PLCs, refer to the PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@) or Multi  
Vendor Connection Manual (V060-E1-@).  
• Method in which the RS-422A ports of the NT631/NT631C and host are  
connected directly by an RS-422A cable (page 115).  
When this method is used, the cable length can be extended up to  
500 m.  
PT  
Host  
RS-422A cable  
(max. 500 m)  
• Method in which the RS-485 ports of the NT631/NT631C and host are  
connected by an RS-485 cable (page 118).  
When this method is used, the cable length can be extended up to  
500 m.  
This connection method can be used only with the NT Link (1:N) meth-  
od (standard or high-speed) of type RS-485.  
PT  
Host  
RS-485 cable  
(max. 500 m)  
• Method in which the RS-422A ports of multiple NT631/NT631Cs and the  
RS-422A port of the host are connected in a 1:N connection (page 119).  
This connection method is used with the RS-422A NT Link (1:N) meth-  
od (standard or high-speed).  
PT  
Host  
RS-422A cable  
(max. total length 500 m)  
• Method in which the RS-485 ports of multiple NT631/NT631Cs and the  
RS-485 port of the host are connected in a 1:N connection (page 121).  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
This connection method is used with the RS-485 NT Link (1:N) method  
(standard or high-speed).  
PT  
Host  
RS-485 cable  
(max. total length 500 m)  
Note  
One end of the wire must always be connected to the host (PLC), and there  
must be no branching. Branching will cause problems such as transmission  
delays and communications failures.  
PLC  
PLC  
Relay terminal block  
PLC  
(At termination)  
NT631  
Relay terminal block  
Max. 2 m  
NT631  
(At  
NT631C  
(Not at  
termination) termination) (Not at  
NT631  
NT631C  
NT631  
NT631  
NT631C  
NT631  
NT631  
(Not at  
termination)  
termination)  
Example of Good Connection  
Examples of Bad Connections  
Reference:  
CS/CJ-series CPU Units cannot be connected with the 1:1 connection NT  
Link method. Use the 1:N connection NT Link method (standard or high-  
speed) instead to make the 1:1 connection. For details, refer to Using the NT  
Link (1:N) Method (page 106) or Using the High-speed NT Link (1:N) Method  
(page 108).  
5-2-1 Host Types and Settings  
The types of host that have an RS-422A port and can be connected to the  
RS-422A/485 port of the NT631/NT631C, and the settings to be made at the  
host, are described here.  
When Using the Host Link  
Method  
Compatible Host Units  
Some models and series of OMRON PLCs have the RS-422A/485 host link  
function built in. With the CS/CJ-series and CQM1H, the host link method can  
be used by installing a Serial Communications Board/Unit. In addition, some  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E CPU Unit can be connected in the host link method by  
installing a Communications Board.  
With the CPM2A and CPM2C, an RS-422A of 1:1 NT Link can be created  
through a CPM1-CIF11 RS-422A Adapter.  
Check the model and series of the PLC and the type of the installed Board or  
Unit before making a connection.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
The hosts featuring the RS-422A/485 host link function and can be connected  
to the RS-422A/485 port of the NT631/NT631C are indicated in the table  
below.  
PLC  
Series  
CPU Unit with built-in Host CPU Units Connectable with  
Host Link Unit or  
Communications Board/  
Unit  
Connectable  
to  
Link  
Host Link Units or  
Expansion Communications  
Board/Units  
CS Series  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1) CS1W-SCB41(-V1)  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-  
E(V1)  
CS1W-SCU31(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/  
67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*1)  
CJ Series  
C Series  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1W-SCU31(-V1)  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
3G2A6-LK202-EV1  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C200HS-CPU01/03/21/23/31/ C200H-LK202-V1  
33-E  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HS-CPU01/21-EC  
C200HE-ZE  
C200HG  
C200HE-CPU11/32/42-E  
C200HE-CPU11/32/42-ZE  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-ZE  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-E  
C200HG-ZE  
C200HX  
C200HX-ZE  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64/65/  
85-ZE  
C200HE-CPU32/42-E  
C200HW-COM03/06-EV1 C200HE  
C200HE-CPU32/42-ZE  
C200HE-ZE  
C200HG  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-ZE  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-E  
C200HG-ZE  
C200HX  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64/65/  
85-ZE  
C200HX-ZE  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
C1000H-CPU01-EV1  
C2000H-CPU01-EV1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C500-LK203  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C1000H  
C2000H  
CPM1  
CPM1-10/20/30CDR-@  
+CPM1-CIF11  
CPM1A-10/20/30/40CD@-@  
+CPM1-CIF11  
CPM2A-30/40/60CD@@-@  
+CPM1-CIF11  
CPM2A  
(Peripheral port connection)  
CPM2C-10/20@@@@@@-@(*2)  
CPM2C  
CQM1H  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
CQM1H-SCB41  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
PLC  
Series  
CPU Unit with built-in Host CPU Units Connectable with  
Host Link Unit or  
Communications Board/  
Unit  
Connectable  
to  
Link  
Host Link Units or  
Expansion Communications  
Board/Units  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
CV500-LK201  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
CV Series  
(*3)  
CVM1  
Series (*3)  
CV500-LK201  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
SRM1  
SRM1-C02-V1+CPM1-CIF11  
SRM1  
*1 This CPU Unit is for a Duplex-CPU Unit System. The CS1W-SCB41(-V1)  
Serial Communications Board cannot be used.  
*2 Use a CPM2C-CN111 or CS1W-CN114/118 Connecting Cable, CPM1-  
CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, or CPM1-CIF11 RS-422A Adapter to connect.  
*3 CPU Units of CVM1/CV-series PLCs without the suffix -EV@ cannot be  
connected.  
The host link method cannot be used when an NT631/NT631C is connected  
using RS-485. To use the host link method, connect by RS-422A.  
Settings at the Host  
When using the RS-422A host link method, the settings shown below must be  
made at the host (depending on the Unit, some of these settings may not be  
necessary, or settings not shown here may be necessary).  
Item  
Setting at Host  
I/O port  
RS-422A  
Set the same speed as for the NT631/NT631C. (*1)  
Communications speed  
Transfer code  
Parity  
ASCII, 7 data bits, 2 stop bits  
Even  
1-to-N(*2)  
Level 1, 2, 3  
00  
1-to-1/1-to-N  
Instruction level  
Unit #  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
Comm. Speed memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-  
7-2 Setting the Host Link Method (page 155).  
*2 The 1-to-N setting enables BCC (Block Check Character). It is not actually  
possible to connect more than one NT631/NT631C in a single host link.  
The setting methods for each type of Unit are described in the following.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Connecting to a C-series  
Host Link Unit  
C200H/C200HS/C200HE(-Z)E/C200HG(-Z)E/C200HX(-Z)E  
Rack-mounting Unit: C200H-LK201-V1  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver so that the values or symbols in  
the setting value window agree with the following:  
LK201  
XMT  
RUN  
RCV  
ERROR  
Unit # (SW1, SW2)  
Set these switches to 0.  
SW1  
SW3  
SW2  
0
0
5
Instruction level, parity, and transfer code (SW4)  
Set this switch to 2.  
SW4  
2
Communications speed (SW3)  
Set this switch to 5 to select 9600 bps.  
Set this switch to 6 to select 19200 bps.  
Setting the Rear Switches  
Terminator setting (selector switch)  
Set this switch to ON.  
Terminator  
ON  
1-to-1 (ON)  
1-to-N (OFF)  
OFF  
1-to-1/1-to-N protocol selection (selector switch)  
Set this switch to 1-to-N (OFF).  
C1000H/C2000H Rack-mounting Unit: 3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
Setting the Front Switches  
Mode  
selector  
Host Local  
Mode selector (key switch)  
Set this to Host link.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Setting the Rear Switches  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-422A.  
I/O port  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
SW1  
Unit # (DIP SW1)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to OFF (0).  
Synchronization  
Internal  
External  
ON  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to Internal.  
8
Terminator  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OFF  
ON  
SW2  
Communications speed  
(DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
CTS  
0 V  
Set these switches to 0010 to select  
19200 bps.  
External  
ON  
Set these switches to 1010 to select  
9600 bps.  
(0: OFF 1: ON)  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to 0 V (ON).  
Terminator setting (selector switch)  
Set this switch to ON.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
C1000H/C2000H Rack-mounting Unit: C500-LK203  
Setting the Rear Switches  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-422A.  
5 V supply  
ON  
OFF  
8
SW1  
7
Unit #, parity, and transfer code  
(DIP SW1-1 to SW1-7)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-7 to OFF (0).  
I/O port  
6
5
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
4
3
2
1
Synchronization  
ON  
Internal  
External  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to Internal.  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Terminator  
OFF  
ON  
SW2  
Communications speed  
(DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
CTS  
0 V  
Set these switches to 0010 to select  
19,200 bps.  
External  
ON  
Set these switches to 1010 to select  
9,600 bps.  
(0: OFF 1: ON)  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to 0 V (ON).  
Terminator setting (selector switch)  
Set this switch to ON.  
C200H/C1000H/C2000H CPU-mounting Unit: 3G2A6-LK202-EV1  
Setting the Rear Switches  
Unit #, parity, and transfer code  
(DIP SW1-1 to SW1-5)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to OFF (0).  
* Parity is fixed at Even Parity. Transfer code  
is fixed at ASCII 7 data bits and 2 stop bits.  
Communications speed (DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
Set these switches to 0010 to select 19200 bps.  
Set these switches to 1010 to select 9600 bps.  
(0: OFF 1: ON)  
SW1  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to OFF (0) (1-to-N).  
SW2  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to ON (1).  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
SW3  
Terminator setting (DIP SW3-1 to SW3-6)  
Set SW3-1, SW3-3, and SW3-5 to ON (1).  
Set SW3-2, SW3-4, and SW3-6 to OFF (0).  
(Set terminator ON.)  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Connecting to a CVM1/CV-  
series Host Link Unit  
CVM1/CV-series Rack-mounting Unit: CV500-LK201  
A CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit (CV500-LK201) has two connectors (com-  
munications ports 1 and 2). To use the RS-422A host link method, set com-  
munications port 2 to RS-422A.  
Communications port 2 is a 9-pin connector which allows selection of the RS-  
232C or RS-422A method. When this port is used with the RS-422A method,  
the I/O port selector switch on the front of the Unit must be set to RS-422A  
(the lower position).  
CPU Bus Unit Settings  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit, set the following com-  
munications conditions for the CPU Bus Unit settings.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
Set the same speed as for the NT631/NT631C. (*1)  
Communications speed  
Transfer code  
Parity  
ASCII, 7 data bits, 2 stop bits  
Even  
1-to-N(*2)  
1-to-1/1-to-N  
Instruction level  
Level 1, 2, 3  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
Comm. Speed memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-  
7-2 Setting the Host Link Method (page 155).  
*2 The 1-to-N setting enables BCC (Block Check Character). It is not actually  
possible to connect more than one NT631/NT631C in a single host link.  
Set the CPU Bus Unit settings directly from a Programming Device (e.g. CX-  
Programmer).  
For details on the CPU Bus Unit settings, refer to the SYSMAC CVM1/CV-  
series Host Link Unit Operation Manual (W205-E1-@).  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Setting the Front Switches  
Unit # (SW3, SW4)  
Set these switches to 0.  
Communications port 1  
(RS-232C)  
Communications port 2  
(RS-232C/RS-422A)  
I/O port selector switch  
RS-232C  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-422A.  
RS-422A  
Communications condition setting (DIP SW1)  
Set this switch to OFF.  
Communications are executed in accordance with the  
CPU Bus Unit system settings made at the PLC. The  
initial values for the system settings are as follows.  
- Communications speed: 9,600 bps  
- Parity: Even  
- Xon/Xoff control: Not executed  
- Communications method: Full duplex  
- Stop bits: 2 stop bits  
- Data length: 7 bits  
Terminator setting (selector switch)  
Set this to ON.  
Connecting to a CPU Unit  
CVM1/CV-series (-EV@) CPU Units  
• CV500-CPU01-EV1/CV1000-CPU01-EV1/CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
• CVM1-CPU01-EV2/CVM1-CPU11-EV2/CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
PLC Setup  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series CPU Unit, set the following communi-  
cations conditions for the PLC Setup.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
Set the same speed as for the NT631/NT631C. (*1)  
Communications speed  
Stop bit  
Parity  
2 stop bits  
Even  
Data length  
Unit #  
ASCII 7 bits  
00  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
Comm. Speed memory switch at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-  
7-2 Setting the Host Link Method (page 155).  
Either set the PLC Setup directly from a Programming Device (e.g. CX-Pro-  
grammer), or transmit the PLC Setup made at a Programming Device to the  
CPU Unit.  
For details on the PLC Setup, refer to the SYSMAC CVM1/CV500/CV1000/  
CV2000 Operation Manual: Ladder Diagrams (W202-E1-@).  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Setting the Front Switches  
Host link communications method  
selection (selector switch)  
Set this to RS-422A.  
Communications type setting (DIP SW3)  
Set SW3 to OFF.  
(for host link communications)  
Host link default value settings  
(DIP SW4)  
To effect the existing DIP switch  
settings, set SW4 to ON.  
I/O port selector switch  
RS-232C  
To effect the values set in the PLC  
Setup, set SW4 to OFF.  
Note  
RS-422A  
For CPU Units manufactured before or  
during June 1995 (lot No. @@65), the  
existing DIP switch settings differ from  
the PLC Setup default values as follows.  
- Existing DIP switch settings:  
2,400 bps, 1 stop bit, even parity, 7 bit  
data length  
- PLC Setup default values:  
9,600 bps, 2 stop bits, even parity, 7  
bit data length  
For CPU Units manufactured from July  
1995 onward (lot No. @@75), the  
stipulated values in the DIP switch  
settings also are 9600 bps and 2 stop bits  
Terminator setting (DIP SW6)  
Set this switch to ON.  
(Set terminator ON.)  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1H, or SRM1  
The connection method depends upon the model of PLC being used, as  
shown in the following table.  
PLC model  
Connection method  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Connect to the RS-422A port (port A) on a Communications  
Board.  
CQM1H  
Connect to the RS-422A port (port 2) on a Serial Communi-  
cations Board.  
CPM1  
Connect to the peripheral port through a CPM1-CIF11 RS-  
422A Adapter.  
CPM2A, SRM1  
CPM2C  
Connect to the peripheral port through a CPM1-CIF11 RS-  
422A Adapter.  
Connect to the peripheral port (on a CPM2C-CN111 or  
CS1W-CN114 Connecting Cable) through a CPM1-CIF11  
RS-422A Adapter.  
(The CPM2C-CN111 splits the Unit’s Communications Port  
into a RS-232C port and a peripheral port.)  
Reference:  
• There are no Communications Boards for the C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E in  
which port B is the RS-422A port.  
• There are no Serial Communications Boards for the CQM1H in which port  
1 is the RS-422A port.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
When connecting to a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E or CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C,  
CQM1H CPU Units or SRM1, set the following communications conditions for  
the PLC Setup area.  
Item  
Setting at Host  
I/O port  
RS-422A  
Communications mode  
Communications speed  
Host link mode  
Set the same speed as for the NT631/NT631C. (*1)  
Stop bit  
Parity  
2 stop bits  
Even  
Data length  
Unit #  
ASCII 7 bits  
00  
*1 Set the host link communications speed at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the  
Comm. Speed at the NT631/NT631C. For details, refer to 6-7-2 Setting the  
Host Link Method (page 155).  
Set the PLC Setup area settings directly from a Programming Device (e.g.  
CX-Programmer).  
For details on operations relating to the PLC Setup area, refer to the manual  
for the PLC which is used.  
The PLC Setup area word numbers and settings to be made depending on  
the Unit to which the connection is made are shown below.  
When using port A of the Communications Board of C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Word #  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
DM6555 0001  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6556 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6558 0000  
Unit # 00  
When using a CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, SRM1  
Word # Setting Setting Contents  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
DM6650 0001  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6651 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6653 0000  
When using a CQM1H  
Unit # 00  
Word #  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Host link mode, no CTS control  
DM6550 0001  
Communications conditions set by the contents of DM  
DM6551 0303  
0304  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 9600 bps  
Data length 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity, communica-  
tions speed: 19200 bps  
DM6553 0000  
Unit # 00  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Connecting to a CPM2C  
The CPM2C PLCs do not have the same kind of port connectors found on CS/  
CJ-series PLCs. The CPM2C’s communications port handles both RS-232C  
and peripheral port connections which are divided internally. Therefore, when  
using the CPM2C, it is necessary to select RS-232C or peripheral port con-  
nections, according to the kind of cable and port (on the cable) used, as  
shown in the following table. Refer to the CPM2C Operation Manual for more  
details.  
Peripheral port  
CPM2C-CN111  
CPM2C  
CPM2C  
CS1W-CN114  
Peripheral port  
RS-232C port  
(D-Sub 9-pin, female)  
Setting Switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications Board  
Set the switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications Board as fol-  
lows.  
Switch 1:  
(4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Switch 2: ON (terminator ON = terminating resistance enabled)  
Setting Switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Set the switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board as follows.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled)  
Serial Communications Board  
(Inner Board slot 1)  
Terminator Switch (TERM)  
Set to ON (right side).  
Wire Selection Switch (WIRE)  
Set to 4 (right side).  
Setting the Switches on an RS-422A Adapter  
CPM1-  
CIF11  
CPM1  
Set the terminator selector switch to ON (upper position).  
Connecting to a CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board with RS-422A/485 port equipped for CS-series  
CPU Unit:  
CS1W-SCB41(-V1) (The port 2 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Serial Communications Board Switch Settings  
Set the switches on the Serial Communications Board as shown below.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE): (4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Settings are written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console  
or CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area)  
of the CPU Unit. After the settings are written, they become effective by turn-  
ing the power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or  
executing the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and the set-  
tings are shown.  
Allocated DM  
Area words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 2  
DM32010  
8000  
Host link mode, 2 stop bits,  
data length 7 bits, even parity,  
Communications speed: 9600 bps  
Communications speed:19200 bps  
Transmit delay time0 ms.  
DM32011  
0000  
0007  
0000  
0000  
DM32012  
DM32013  
No CTS control Unit, No.0 for host link  
Connecting to a CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit  
CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and port 2 are both RS-422A/485 ports.)  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and port 2 are both RS-422A/485 ports.)  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1) (Port 1 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit using the rotary  
switches on the front of the Unit. Set the number or symbol in the setting dis-  
play window in the following way using a flat-blade screwdriver. When using a  
CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit set the switches as shown below.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
DM Area Allocation Settings  
From the Programming Device (i.e., a Programming Console or CX-Program-  
mer), write the settings directly to the CPU Unit's DM Area Setup Area. After  
the settings have been written, they will be enabled when the power supply is  
cycled, the Unit is restarted, the communications port is restarted, or a STUP  
instruction is executed.  
The DM Area words that are allocated and the contents of the settings are  
given in the following table.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
m = DM 30000 + 100 × unit number  
Allocated DM Area  
words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 1  
Port 2  
m+10  
m
8000  
Host link mode, 2 stop bits,  
even parity, data length 7 bits  
m+1  
m+11  
0000  
0007  
0000  
0000  
Communications speed: 9600 bps  
Communications speed: 19200 bps  
Transmit delay time 0 ms  
m+2  
m+3  
m+12  
m+13  
No CTS control Unit, No.0 for host link  
Using the NT Link (1:1)  
Method  
Compatible Host Units  
Some models and series of OMRON PLCs have the RS-422A NT Link (1:1)  
function built in.  
• The C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E CPU Units can be connected by the RS-422A  
NT Link (1:1) method by installing a Communications Board.  
• The CQM1H CPU Units can be connected by the RS-422A NT Link (1:1)  
method by installing a Serial Communications Board.  
Check the model and series of the PLC against the type of CPU Unit before  
making the connections.  
The hosts that can be connected to the RS-422A port of the NT631/NT631C  
by the RS-422A NT Link (1:1) method are indicated in the table below.  
PLC Series  
CPU Units with Built-in RS-422A NT  
Link (1:1) Function  
Model Name  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE(*1)  
C Series  
C200HE(-Z)E  
C200HG(-Z)E  
C200HX(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE(*1)  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
CQM1H  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
CV Series (*3)  
CVM1 Series (*3)  
*1 One of the following Communications Boards is required:  
C200HW-COM03-EV1 or C200HW-COM06-EV1.  
*2 A CQM1H-SCB41-E Serial Communications Board is required.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
*3 CPU Units of CVM1/CV-series PLCs without the suffix -EV@ cannot be  
connected.  
The NT Link (1:1) method cannot be used using RS-485. To use the NT Link  
(1:1) method, connect by RS-422A.  
The 1:1 NT Link connection using RS-422A/485 is not possible with the  
CPM1, CPM2A, or CPM2C.  
Settings at the Host  
The setting methods for each type of Unit are described in the following.  
• Connecting to a CVM1/CV-series (-EV@) CPU Units  
• CV500-CPU01-EV1/CV1000-CPU01-EV1/CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
• CVM1-CPU01-EV2/CVM1-CPU11-EV2/CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
PLC Setup  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series CPU Unit by the NT Link (1:1)  
method, no particular settings are required at the PLC Setup.  
Setting the Front Switches  
Host link communications method selection  
(selector switch)  
Set this to RS-422A.  
I/O port selector switch  
RS-232C  
Communications type setting (DIP SW3)  
Set this switch to ON.  
(for communications by NT Link)  
RS-422A  
Terminator setting (DIP SW6)  
Set this switch to ON.  
(Set terminator ON.)  
• Connecting to a C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
Write the PLC Setup area (data memory) settings directly from a Program-  
ming Device (e.g. CX-Programmer) in accordance with the host model.  
Host Model  
Port A of C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E*1  
Port 2 of CQM1H*2  
Word #  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
DM6555 4000  
DM6550 4000  
Use NT Link (1:1)  
*1 RS-422A port of the Communications Board  
*2 RS-422A port of the Serial Communications Board  
For details on operations relating to the PLC Setup area, refer to the manual  
for the PLC you are using.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Setting the DIP Switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications  
Board  
Set the switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications Board as fol-  
lows.  
Switch 1:  
(4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Switch 2: ON (terminator ON = terminating resistance enabled).  
Setting Switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Set the switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board as follows.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A)  
4
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
Serial Communications Board  
(Inner Board slot 1)  
Terminator Switch (TERM)  
Set to ON (right side).  
Wire Selection Switch (WIRE)  
Set to 4 (right side).  
Using the NT Link (1:N)  
Method  
Compatible Host Units  
The OMRON PLCs that can be connected using the RS-422A/485 NT Link  
(1:N) method are the CS/CJ-series, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, and CQM1H mod-  
els only. A Serial Communications Board/Unit or a Communications Board  
must be installed to make the connection.  
Check the model and series of the PLC against the type of CPU Unit or com-  
munications board before making the connections.  
The hosts that can be connected to the RS-232C port of the NT631/NT631C  
by the RS-422A NT Link (1:N) function via an Adapter are indicated in the  
table below.  
PLC  
Series  
CPU Units with  
Built-in NT Link  
(1:1) Function  
CPU Unit that becomes  
connectable by installing a  
Communications Board/Unit  
Model Name  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H(*1)  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*2)  
CS  
Series  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CJ1G-CPU44/45(*3)  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*3)  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H(*3)  
CJ  
Series  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23(*3)  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
PLC  
Series  
CPU Units with  
Built-in NT Link  
(1:1) Function  
CPU Unit that becomes  
connectable by installing a  
Communications Board/Unit  
Model Name  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E(*4)  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE(*4)  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE(*4)  
CQM1H-CPU51/61(*5)  
C Series  
C200HE (-Z)E  
C200HG (-Z)E  
C200HX (-Z)E  
CQM1H  
*1 A CS1W-SCB41(-V1) Serial Communications Board or CS1W-SCU31-V1  
Serial Communications Unit is required.  
*2 This CPU Unit is for a Duplex-CPU Unit System. The CS1W-SCB41(-V1)  
Serial Communications Board cannot be used. Use the CS1W-SCU31-V1  
Communications Unit.  
*3 A CS1W-SCU31-V1 or CS1W-SCU41(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is  
required.  
*4 A C200HW-COM03-V1 or C200-COM06-V1 Communications Board is  
required.  
*5 A CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is required.  
Settings at the Host  
C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
PLC Setup Area Settings  
Write the communications conditions directly into the PLC Setup area (data  
memory) using a Programming Device (e.g. CX-Programmer).  
Make the setting indicated in the word shown below.  
Connection to  
Port A of a C200HX/  
HG/HE(-Z)E*1  
Word #  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Use NT Link (1:N)  
DM6555 5@00  
@ = highest unit number of the  
connected PTs (1 to 7)*3  
Port 2 of a CQM1H*2  
DM6550 5@00  
*1 The Communications Board’s RS-422A/485 port  
*2 The Serial Communications Board’s RS-422A/485 port  
*3 When using C200HE(-Z)E, the maximum PT unit number is 3.  
For details on setting the PLC Setup area settings, refer to the PLC’s opera-  
tion manual.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Reference:  
• There are no Serial Communications Boards for the C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
in which port B is the RS-422A/485 port.  
• There are no Serial Communications Boards for the CQM1H in which port  
1 is the RS-422A/485 port.  
Setting the DIP Switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications  
Board  
Set the switches on a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E Communications Board as fol-  
lows.  
Switch 1:  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
(2-wire = RS-485)  
4
2
Switch 2: ON (terminator ON = terminating resistance enabled).  
Setting Switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Set the switches on a CQM1H Serial Communications Board as follows.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
(2-wire = RS-485)  
4
2
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
Serial Communications Board  
(Inner Board slot 1)  
Terminator Switch (TERM)  
Set to ON (right side)  
Wire Selection Switch (WIRE)  
When using RS-422A: Set to 4 (right side) for 4-wire type.  
When using RS-485: Set to 2 (left side) for 2-wire type.  
Connecting to CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board with RS-422A/485 port equipped for CS-series  
CPU Unit:  
CS1W-SCB41(-V1) (Port 2 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
Setting the Front Switches  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
(2-wire = RS-485)  
4
2
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
RDY  
COMM1  
COMM2  
Port 1  
RS-232C  
PORT1  
Terminal resistance setting switch (TER)  
Set to ON (Terminal resistance is present.)  
(right side).  
OFF  
2
ON TERM  
4
WIRE  
Two wire type/four wire type changeover switch (WIRE)  
For RS-422A: 4 (4 wire type) (right side)  
For RS-485: 2 (2 wire type) (left side)  
Port 2  
RS-422A/485  
PORT2  
(RS422/  
RS485)  
SCB41  
Allocation DM Area Settings for CPU Unit  
Settings are written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console  
or CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area)  
of the CPU Unit. After settings are written, they become effective by turning  
the power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or exe-  
cuting the STUP command.  
In the following, the channel numbers of the allocation DM area and settings  
are shown.  
Allocated DM  
Area words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 2  
DM32010  
DM32011  
8200  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
1:N NT Link Mode  
Baud rate (standard)  
DM32016  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the connected  
PTs (0 to 7)  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 hex for the baud rate. The same  
baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it is between 0000  
and 0009 hex.  
For example, when connecting PTs with model numbers 3, 4, 5, and 6 to port  
2 in the NT Link (1:N), set a value of 8200 hex for D32010, 0000 hex for  
DM32011, and 0006 hex for D32016.  
Connecting to a CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit  
CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and 2 are both RS-422A/485 ports.)  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and 2 are both RS-422A/485 ports.)  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1) (Port 1 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit using the rotary  
switches on the front of the Unit. Set the number or symbol in the setting dis-  
play window in the following way using a flat-blade screwdriver. When using a  
CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit set the switches as shown below.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
4
2
(2-wire = RS-485)  
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
DM Area Allocation Settings  
From the Programming Device (i.e., a Programming Console or CX-Program-  
mer), write the settings directly to the CPU Unit's DM Area Setup Area. After  
the settings have been written, they will be enabled when the power supply is  
cycled, the Unit is restarted, the communications port is restarted, or a STUP  
instruction is executed.  
The DM Area words that are allocated and the contents of the settings are  
given in the following table.  
m = DM 30000 + 100 × unit number  
Allocated DM Area words  
Port 1 Port 2  
m+10  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
m
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
0000 to 0009 (*1)  
m+1  
m+11  
m+16  
Baud rate (standard)  
m+6  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number  
of the connected PTs (0 to  
7)  
*1 Set any value between 0000 and 0009 hex for the baud rate. The same  
baud rate will be used regardless of the value as long as it is between 0000  
and 0009 hex.  
Using the High-speed NT  
Link (1:N) Method  
Compatible Host Units  
Only OMRON’s CS/CJ-series PLCs support the high-speed 1:N NT Link  
through RS-422A/RS-485. The high-speed 1:N NT Link must be established  
through a Serial Communications Board/Unit. (Even CS/CJ-series Units with-  
out the “-V1” suffix can be connected via a high-speed 1:N NT Link by mount-  
ing a Serial Communications Board/Unit.)  
Be sure to check the model number of the PLC and Board/Unit before trying  
to establish the high-speed 1:N NT Link.  
The following table shows which CS-series PLCs can be connected to an  
NT631/NT631C with the high-speed 1:N NT Link through RS-422A/RS-485.  
PLC  
Series  
CPU Units with  
Built-in NT Link  
(1:1) Function  
CPU Unit that becomes  
connectable by installing a  
Communications Board/Unit  
Model  
Name  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)(*1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*1)  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H(*1)  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H(*2)  
CS  
Series  
CS1G  
CS1H  
CS1D  
CJ1G-CPU44/45(*3)  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H(*3)  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H(*3)  
CJ  
Series  
CJ1G  
CJ1H  
CJ1M  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23(*3)  
*1 A CS1W-SCB41(-V1) Serial Communications Board or CS1W-SCU31-V1  
Serial Communications Unit is required.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
*2 This CPU Unit is for a Duplex-CPU Unit System. The CS1W-SCB41(-V1)  
Serial Communications Board cannot be used. Use the CS1W-SCU31-V1  
Communications Unit.  
*3 A CS1W-SCU31-V1 or CS1W-SCU41(-V1) Serial Communications Unit is  
required.  
Settings at the Host  
Connecting to a CS-series Serial Communications Board  
Serial Communications Board equipped with an RS-422A/485 port for CS-  
series CPU Units:  
CS1W-SCB41(-V1) (Port 2 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
Reference:  
CS-series Serial Communications Boards and Units with lot number 991220  
(12/20/99) and later support the high-speed 1:N NT Link. Boards and Units  
with earlier lot numbers cannot be used.  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the switches on a Serial Communications Board as follows.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
(2-wire = RS-485)  
4
2
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
RDY  
COMM1  
COMM2  
Port 1  
RS-232C  
PORT1  
Terminator Switch (TERM)  
Set to ON (right side).  
OFF  
2
ON TERM  
4
WIRE  
Wire Selection Switch (WIRE)  
RS-422A: Set to 4 (right side) for 4-wire type.  
RS-485: Set to 2 (left side) for 2-wire type.  
PORT2  
(RS422/  
RS485)  
Port 2  
RS-422A/485  
SCB41  
Allocation DM area settings for CPU Unit  
Settings are written from the Programming Device (a Programming Console  
or CX-Programmer) directly into the allocation DM area (system setting area)  
of the CPU Unit. After settings are written, they become effective by turning  
the power ON, restarting the Unit, restarting the communications port, or exe-  
cuting the STUP command.  
In the following table, the relevant word addresses in the allocation DM area  
and settings are shown.  
Allocated DM Area  
words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 2  
DM32010  
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Allocated DM Area  
words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 2  
DM32011  
000A  
000@  
Baud rate (standard)  
DM32016  
@ = The highest unit number of the connected  
PTs (0 to 7)  
*1 For example, when connecting PTs with model numbers 3, 4, 5, and 6 to  
port 2, set the value 8200 hex to DM32010, 000A hex to DM32011, and  
0006 hex to DM32016.  
Connecting to a CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit  
CS/CJ-series Rack-mounting Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and 2 are RS-422A/485 port.)  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1 (Port 1 and 2 are RS-422A/485 port.)  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1) (Port 1 is an RS-422A/485 port.)  
Setting the Front Switches  
Set the unit number of the Serial Communications Unit using the rotary  
switches on the front of the Unit. Set the number or symbol in the setting dis-  
play window in the following way using a flat-blade screwdriver. When using a  
CS/CJ-series Serial Communications Unit set the switches as shown below.  
2-wire or 4-wire selector (WIRE):  
(4-wire = RS-422A), or  
(2-wire = RS-485)  
4
2
Terminating resistance switch (TERM): ON (terminator ON = terminating  
resistance enabled).  
DM Area Allocation Settings  
From the Programming Device (i.e., a Programming Console or CX-Program-  
mer), write the settings directly to the CPU Unit's DM Area Setup Area. After  
the settings have been written, they will be enabled when the power supply is  
cycled, the Unit is restarted, the communications port is restarted, or a STUP  
instruction is executed.  
The DM Area words that are allocated and the contents of the settings are  
given in the following table.  
m = DM 30000 + 100 × unit number  
Allocated DM Area  
words  
Setting  
Setting Contents  
Port 1  
Port 2  
m+10  
m
8200  
1:N NT Link Mode  
m+1  
m+6  
m+11  
m+16  
000A  
Baud rate (standard)  
000@  
@ = The highest unit number of the con-  
nected PTs (0 to 7)  
When using the Memory  
Link Method  
With the memory link method, the connection can be made to a personal  
computer and an FA computer with RS-422A.  
When connecting to the host with the memory link method, it is necessary to  
create a program for the memory link at the host side.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
The following are the communications conditions that can be used with the  
memory link method. For the host (a personal computer, an FA computer,  
etc.), its setting should be compatible to one of the communications condi-  
tions listed in the following table. Set the same communications conditions at  
the NT631/NT631C by the memory switch. (page 160).  
Item  
Input/Output board  
Communications speed  
Data bits length  
Stop bits length  
Parity  
Setting at Host  
RS-422A  
1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 bps.  
7 bits, 8 bits  
1 bit, 2 bits  
None, even, odd  
Flow control  
None, XON/XOFF  
5-2-2 Direct Connection between RS-422A Ports at Both Units  
The connection method in which the RS-422A ports of an NT631/NT631C  
and a host are connected is described here.  
Host Link Unit, CPU Unit,  
Communications Unit/Board  
NT631/NT631C  
SYSMAC  
R
E
S
E
T
R
D
A
CS/CJ-series PLC,  
C-series PLC,  
CVM1/CV series  
PLC, SRM1  
TR  
M
R
D
B
S
D
A
S
D
B
C
S
A
C
S
B
2
4V  
PRINTER PORT  
B
PORT  
A
+D  
C
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485, terminal block)  
9-pin connector or  
25-pin connector  
RS-422A cable with connectors (max. length: 500 m)  
Connecting an NT631/NT631C and Host (RS-422A)  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-422A  
Wiring When Connecting a C-series Host Link Unit or CPM1 (Host Link)  
Applicable Units:  
C200H-LK202-V1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C500-LK203  
3G2A6-LK202-EV1  
6
1
NT631/NT631C side  
PLC side  
Abbreviation  
FG  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Abbreviation Short-circuit tool  
Pin number  
Shielding wire Connector  
RDA (-)  
hood  
1
2
TRM  
RDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A/  
SDA (-)  
485  
3
4
SG  
terminal  
block  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
SDB (+)  
5
6
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
RDA (-)  
FG  
7
8
Functional  
ground  
9
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Wiring When Connecting CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, or SRM1  
Applicable Units:  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
SRM1-C02-V2  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
Connect to the PLC through a CPM1-CIF11 RS-422A Adapter.  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
NT631/NT631C side  
PLC side  
Short-circuit tool  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
Abbreviation  
Shielding wire  
FG  
FG  
SG  
TRM  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SG  
SDB  
RDB (+)  
SDB (+)  
SDA  
RDB  
RS-422A/  
SDA (-)  
485  
SDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
RDA (-)  
terminal  
block  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
RDA  
(9-pin type)  
Functional  
ground  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Wiring When Connecting a CS-series Serial Communications Board, CS/  
CJ-series Serial Communications Unit, C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Communications Board, CQM1H Serial Communications Board, or  
CVM1/CV-series Host Link Unit  
Applicable Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1/CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU66H/67H (See note.)  
C200HE-CPU32/42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE/85-ZE  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
CV500-LK201 (communications port 2)  
Note A Serial Communications Board cannot be installed.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
6
1
PLC side  
Abbreviation  
FG  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Pin number  
Abbreviation  
Short-circuit tool  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
RDA (-)  
1
TRM  
SDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
2
SDB (+)  
RS-422A/  
485  
terminal  
block  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
3
4
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
5
6
RDA (-)  
7
8
RDB (+)  
9
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Wiring When Connecting a CVM1/CV-series CPU Unit  
Applicable Units:  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV@  
CVM1-CPU21-EV@  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV@  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units whose model names do not have the suffix -EV@  
cannot be connected by any connection method.  
6
1
PLC side  
Abbreviation  
FG  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Pin number  
Abbreviation  
Short-circuit tool  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
RDA (-)  
1
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
TRM  
2
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RDB (+)  
RS-422A/  
485  
terminal  
block  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
3
4
PS  
CS  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
5
6
RDA (-)  
7
8
RDB (+)  
9
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Wiring for a Memory Link Connection  
Prepare the adapter cable while referring to the following diagram.  
Host side  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
Short-circuit tool  
Shielding wire Connector  
hood  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
RS  
RS-422A  
connector  
RS-422A/  
RDB (+)  
485  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
interface  
CS  
RDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
5-2-3 Direct Connection between RS-485 Ports at Both Units  
The connection method in which the RS-485 ports of an NT631/NT631C and  
a host are connected is described here.  
NT631/NT631C  
CPU Unit  
CS/CJ-series PLC,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485, terminal block)  
9-pin connector  
RS-485 cable with connectors (max. length: 500 m)  
Reference:  
When RS-485 is used at the PT side, only the NT Link (1:N) method (standard  
or high-speed) can be used.  
Connecting an NT631/NT631C and Host  
Host  
NT631/NT631C  
RS-485  
Wiring When Connecting a CS-series Serial Communications Board, CS/  
CJ-series Serial Communications Unit, C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Communications Board, or CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Applicable Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1/CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU66H/67H (See note.)  
C200HE-CPU32/42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE/85-ZE  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
Note A Serial Communications Board cannot be installed.  
6
1
NT631/NT631C side  
PLC side  
Abbreviation  
FG  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Abbreviation  
Pin number  
Short-circuit tool  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
hood  
RDA (-)  
1
TRM  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
2
RS-422A  
interface  
RS-422A/  
SDA (-)  
485  
3
4
interface  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
PS  
CS  
5
6
RDA (-)  
Functional  
ground  
7
8
RDB (+)  
9
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
5-2-4 1:N Connection among RS-422A Ports  
The connection method in which the RS-422A ports of multiple NT631/  
NT631Cs and one host are connected in a 1:N connection is described here.  
CPU Unit  
CS/CJ-series PLC,  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
9-pin connector  
RS-422A cables  
(max. total length 500 m)  
NT631/NT631C  
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485, terminal block)  
NT631/NT631C  
NT631/NT631C  
Reference:  
• Communications using the RS-422A standard NT link (1:N) method is  
possible only when a Serial Communications Board is installed in a CS-  
series PLC, a Serial Communications Unit is installed in a CS/CJ-series  
PLC, a Communications Board is installed in a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, or a  
CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is installed in a CQM1H.  
• Communications using the RS-422A high-speed NT link (1:N) method is  
possible only when a Serial Communications Board is installed in a CS-  
series PLC or a Serial Communications Unit is installed in a CS/CJ-series  
PLC.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Connecting between  
NT631/NT631C Units  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-422A  
:
NT631/NT631C side  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Short-circuit tool  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
:
RDA (-)  
TRM  
TRM  
RS-422A/  
485  
interface  
RS-422A/  
RDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
SDA (-)  
485  
interface  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding wire  
24V  
+DC  
24V  
+DC  
* Short TRM and RDA terminals of the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-  
422A cable (* marked in the above figure) using the short-circuit tool sup-  
plied with the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Connecting an NT631/NT631C and a Host  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-422A  
Wiring When Connecting a CS-series Serial Communications Board, CS/  
C-series Serial Communications Unit, C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Communications Board, or CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Applicable Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1/CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU66H/67H (See note.)  
C200HE-CPU32/42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-(Z)E  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE/85-ZE  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
Note A Serial Communications Board cannot be installed.  
PLC side  
6
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
1
Abbreviation  
Pin number Abbreviation  
Connector  
FG  
Shielding wire  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
hood  
1
SDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
2
3
SDB (+)  
RS-422A/  
485  
SDA (-)  
RS-422A  
interface  
interface  
SDB (+)  
4
5
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
6
7
RDA (-)  
8
9
RDB (+)  
Next PT  
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
5-2-5 1:N Connection among RS-485 Ports  
The connection method in which the RS-485 ports of multiple NT631/  
NT631Cs and one host are connected in a 1:N connection is described here.  
CPU Unit  
CS/CJ-series or  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
PLC  
9-pin connector  
RS-485 cables  
(max. total length 500 m)  
NT631/NT631C  
Serial port B  
(RS-422A/485, terminal block)  
NT631/NT631C  
NT631/NT631C  
Reference:  
• Communications using the RS-485A standard NT link (1:N) method is  
possible only when a Serial Communications Board is installed in a CS-  
series PLC, a Serial Communications Unit is installed in a CS/CJ-series  
PLC, a Communications Board is installed in a C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, or a  
CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is installed in a CQM1H.  
• Communications using the RS-485A high-speed NT link (1:N) method is  
possible only when a Serial Communications Board is installed in a CS-  
series PLC or a Serial Communications Unit is installed in a CS/CJ-series  
PLC.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Connecting between NT631/NT631C Units  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-485  
NT631/NT631C side  
NT631/NT631C side  
Short-circuit tool  
Abbreviation  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
TRM  
RS-422A/  
485  
RS-422A/  
485  
RDB (+)  
RDB (+)  
terminal  
terminal  
block  
SDA (-) block  
SDA (-)  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
Shielding wire  
24V  
+DC  
24V  
+DC  
* Short TRM and RDA terminals of the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-  
485 cable (* marked in the above figure) using the short-circuit tool sup-  
plied with the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
Connecting an NT631/  
NT631C and a Host  
The relay terminal block is not included in this figure. Insert the relay terminal  
block so as to achieve the wiring configuration shown below.  
NT631/NT631C  
Host  
RS-485  
Wiring When Connecting a CS-series Serial Communications Board, CS/  
CJ-series Serial Communications Unit, C-series C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Communications Board, or CQM1H Serial Communications Board  
Applicable Units:  
CS1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1/CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU66H/67H (See note.)  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
C200HE-CPU32/42-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE/85-ZE  
CQM1H-CPU51/61  
Note A Serial Communications Board cannot be installed.  
6
1
PLC side  
NT631/NT631C side  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RSA  
RSB  
Abbreviation  
RDA (-)  
TRM  
Pin number Abbreviation  
Shielding wire  
Connector  
FG  
hood  
1
SDA (-)  
RDB (+)  
SDB (+)  
2
3
RS-422A/  
485  
SDA (-)  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A  
connector  
4
5
6
SDB (+)  
RSA (-)  
RDA (-)  
RSB (+)  
Functional  
ground  
7
8
9
RDB (+)  
Next PT  
9
5
(9-pin type)  
24V  
+DC  
For details on handling shield wires, refer to 5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-  
422A/485 Cables on page 125.  
5-2-6 Recommended Connectors, Cables and Crimp Terminals  
Connectors and Cables Recommended for RS-422A/485  
When making an RS-422A/485 connecting cable, as far as possible use the  
recommended parts indicated in the table below. When using the memory link  
method, however, use a connector that matches with the RS-422A port at the  
CPU Unit (CP) side. Some Units come supplied with one connector and con-  
nector hood.  
Check the required parts and prepare them in advance.  
Name  
Model  
Maker  
9-pin type  
Remarks  
Connector XM2A-0901  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
CS/CJ-series CPU Units,  
C-series C200HS  
Made by OMRON  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units  
CV500-LK201  
Connector XM2S-0911  
hood  
9-pin type  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
C-series C200HS  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
Made by OMRON  
Delivered with the following  
Units:  
CVM1/CV-series CPU Units  
CV500-LK201  
XM2S-0911-E  
9-pin type  
Delivered with the following  
Units: CS/CJ-series PLCs  
Made by OMRON  
Cable  
TKVVBS4P-03 Tachii Electric Wire  
Co., Ltd.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
Name  
Model  
Maker  
Remarks  
Crimp ter- 1.25-N3A  
minals (fork type) *1  
Japan Solderless Recommended cable size:  
Terminal MFG  
AWG22 to 18  
(0.3 to 0.75 mm2)  
Y1.25-3.5L (fork Molex Inc.  
type) *1  
*1 Crimp terminals of common use for M3 and M3.5  
The terminal screws of the NT631/NT631C are M3.5 specification. When wir-  
ing, use crimp terminals for M3.5 use. Tighten terminal screws with a tighten-  
ing torque of 0.8 Nm.  
The terminal screws of the RS-422A adaptor (CPM1-CIF11) are M3 specifica-  
tion. When wiring, use crimp terminals for M3 use. Tighten terminal screws  
with a tightening torque of 0.5 Nm.  
Note  
1. Make sure to tighten screws at the connectors after cable connection.  
2. Always use crimp terminals for wiring at terminal blocks.  
Examples of Applicable Terminals  
• For M3.5  
Round type  
Round type  
Fork type  
7 mm max.  
7 mm max.  
• For M3  
Fork type  
6.2 mm max.  
6.2 mm max.  
5-2-7 Setting the Terminal Resistance for RS-422A/485  
Communications  
The serial port B connector of the NT631/NT631C has a terminal resistance  
setting terminal (TRM).  
In RS-422A/485 communications, a terminal resistor must be set at the device  
at the end of the communications cable, but not at any other device.  
The NT631/NT631C has a built-in terminal resistor, and whether or not the  
terminal resistance is applied is set by shorting or opening the terminal resis-  
tance setting terminals (TRM). The terminal resistance is 120 .  
When carrying out RS-422A/485 communications using serial port B, short  
between terminals at the NT631/NT631C at the end of the RS-422A/485  
cable. Leave these terminals open at NT631/NT631C PTs other than the one  
at the end of the cable.  
When not using RS-422A/485 communications, the terminal resistance set-  
ting is ineffective.  
Short-circuit tool  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
TRM-RDA  
terminals  
Function  
Terminal resistance is applied.  
Shorted  
Short only at the NT631/NT631C connected to the end of an  
RS-422A/485 cable.  
Open  
Terminal resistance is not applied.  
Leave the terminals open when connecting an NT631/NT631C  
anywhere other than at the end of the RS-422A/485 cable.  
Note  
Before connecting or disconnecting cables between devices, make sure that  
the power supply to all of the connected devices (NT631/NT631C, PLC, etc.)  
is OFF.  
Reference:  
• The internal circuit of the NT631/NT631C is shown below.  
-
RDA  
Terminal resistor (120 )  
TRM  
Making a connection here inserts a terminator between  
+ (RDB) and - (RDA).  
+
RDB  
• For details on setting the terminal resistance of the host, refer to Setting  
methods for each type of the communications.  
5-2-8 Handling the Shield on RS-422A/485 Cables  
Perform the following procedures to connect, process the shield, and connect  
to ground for communications systems using the RS-422A/485. Incorrect con-  
nection may result in communications errors with the host.  
Connecting the Ground Wire  
The PT has a functional ground terminal (FG:  
).  
1,2,3...  
1. Ground according to Figure (a) for normal grounding.  
• Connect the ground terminal (GR) of the devices to the functional ground  
(FG:  
).  
Make sure that each signal line is grounded at only one point and ground  
to 100 max.  
• Short the LG terminal of the PLC to the ground terminal (GR).  
• Use a wire gauge of at least 2mm2 for the ground wire.  
• Refer to the manual for individual Communications Units for details on  
proper wiring procedures.  
2. Do not ground the functional ground (FG:  
) of the PT if it is mounted to  
the same panel as devices that generate noise, such as motors or invert-  
ers, as shown in Figure (b).  
Preparing the Shield of RS-422A/485 Connectors  
Always prepare RS-422A/485 cable shields properly. Otherwise, communica-  
tions errors may occur with the host.  
Ground only one end of the shield when connecting the ground terminal (GR)  
of the devices to the functional ground (FG:  
), and grounding each signal  
line at only one point and to 100 max, as shown in Figure (a).  
Ground both ends of the shield when not grounding the functional ground  
(FG:  
) of the PT, as shown in Figure (b).  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting to the Host’s RS-422A/485 Port  
Section 5-2  
When using a CJ1M-CIF11 alone or combined with an NT-AL001, be sure to  
connect, process the shield, and connect to ground as shown in Figure (b).  
Example of Recommended Wiring  
Signal line  
Signal line  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 6  
System Menu Operation  
This section describes the operation of the System Menu, focusing on the procedure to start up the NT631/NT631C.  
Functions which are convenient when using the NT631/NT631C and those that are useful for system maintenance are  
6-1 System Menu Operation Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-2 Starting the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-2-1 Operation at Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-3 Operation Modes and the System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-3-1 Relationships among Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-3-2 Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-3-3 Operations with the System Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4 Memory Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-1 Clearing Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-2 Initializing Display History Record Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-3 Initializing Alarm History Record Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-4 Initializing the Recipe Tables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-5 Initializing the Memory Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-4-6 Initializing the Memory Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-5 Operations in the System Installer Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-5-1 Setting the Display Language in the System Installer Mode. . . . . .  
6-5-2 Clearing/Installing the System Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-5-3 Changing the System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-5-4 Clearing Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-6 Transmitting the Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
129  
129  
129  
130  
130  
132  
133  
135  
135  
137  
138  
140  
141  
143  
144  
144  
145  
147  
148  
149  
6-7 Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches 152  
6-7-1 About Communications Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-7-2 Setting the Host Link Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-7-3 Setting the NT Link (1:1) Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-7-4 Setting the NT Link (1:N) Method (Standard/High-speed). . . . . . .  
6-7-5 Setting the Memory Link Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-7-6 Setting the Communications Type for Serial Port B . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-8 Starting Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9 Various System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-1 Memory Switch Setting Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-2 Setting the Start-up Wait Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-3 Setting the Key Press Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-4 Setting the Buzzer Sound. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-5 Setting the Printer Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
152  
155  
157  
158  
160  
162  
163  
164  
164  
165  
166  
166  
168  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6-9-6 Setting the Print Method (NT631C Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-7 Setting Screen Saver Movement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-8 Setting the Screen Saver Start-up Time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-9 Setting the History Display Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-10 Setting the Resume Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-11 Setting the Automatic Reset Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-12 Setting the Time-out Interval. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-9-13 Setting the Retry Count. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-10 Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11 System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-1 I/O Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-2 Displaying/Setting the Calendar and Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-3 Checking the PT Setting Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-4 Displaying and Printing the Display History Record . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-5 Displaying and Printing the Alarm History Record . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-6 Checking Screen Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-7 Device Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-11-8 Checking Interfaces. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-12 Programming Console Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-12-1 Usable Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-12-2 Connection Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-12-3 Method of Use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-13 Device Monitor Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-13-1 Compatible Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-13-2 Connection Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-13-3 Method of Use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-14 Version Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
6-14-1 Method of Use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
169  
170  
173  
175  
177  
179  
181  
182  
184  
187  
187  
191  
193  
194  
196  
198  
201  
209  
214  
215  
216  
217  
220  
221  
221  
223  
223  
224  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Menu Operation Flow  
Section 6-1  
6-1 System Menu Operation Flow  
Follow the procedure below when using the NT631/NT631C for the first time  
or changing the system program.  
Create the Screen Data  
Create the data to be displayed on the NT631/NT631C by using the Support  
Tool.  
For details on creating screen data, refer to the NT-series Support Tool Ver.  
4.@ for Windows Operation Manual (V061-E1-@).  
Start Up the NT631/  
NT631C (Display the  
System Menu) (page 129)  
Turn ON the power to the NT631/NT631C.  
If no screen data has been registered, an error message is displayed. In this  
case, press the OK touch switch on the error message screen to display the  
System Menu.  
If screen data has been registered and the RUN mode is established, perform  
the appropriate operations on the touch panel to display the System Menu.  
Initialize the Memory  
(page 135)  
If necessary, initialize the memory of the NT631/NT631C by operation from  
the System Menu.  
Transmit the Screen Data  
(page 149)  
Connect the Support Tool to the NT631/NT631C and transmit the screen data  
from the Support Tool to the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on connecting the Support Tool, refer to 3-2 Connecting to the  
Support Tool (page 35).  
Set the Memory Switches  
(pages 152, 164, 184)  
Select the System Menu and set the operations of the NT631/NT631C — for  
example the conditions for communications with the host — using the mem-  
ory switches.  
Start Operation (page 163)  
Connect the NT631/NT631C to the host and start operation.  
System Maintenance  
(page 187)  
If an error occurs during operation, check the I/Os, settings, etc., by referring  
to this guide.  
6-2 Starting the NT631/NT631C  
After checking that the hardware has been connected correctly, switch on the  
power to the NT631/NT631C to start it up.  
This section describes the operation of the NT631/NT631C when it is started  
up.  
6-2-1 Operation at Startup  
The NT631/NT631C operates as follows when the power is switched ON, or  
when it is reset.  
Initial Processing  
Self diagnosis — including a check on the internal memory of the NT631/  
NT631C and a system program check — and the internal processing required  
for startup, are performed.  
If an error occurs during initial processing, an error screen is displayed.  
If there is an error in the system program, the system program must be re-  
installed. For details on the installation procedure, refer to 6-5 Operations in  
the System Installer Mode.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
Section 6-3  
Memory Unit Check and  
Processing  
Check if a Memory Unit is installed. If a Memory Unit is installed, processing  
(screen data and system program reading/writing) is executed in accordance  
with its DIP switch settings (page 39).  
If there is an error in the screen data, an error screen is displayed. Pressing  
the OK touch switch on the error screen will return the display to that immedi-  
ately before the error occurred. It is also possible to display the System Menu  
from the error screen by pressing two of the four corners of the touch panel  
simultaneously. If there is an error in the system program, the main menu of  
the system installer mode is displayed. If this is the case, reinstall the proper  
system program.  
Initialize the memory or change the settings as required.  
Start of Communications  
with the Host  
Communications with the host start in accordance with the communications  
method set in the system memory of the NT631/NT631C. During the interval  
until communications are established, the system initialization screen (screen  
No. 9000) is displayed.  
For details, refer to 6-8 Starting Operation.  
If the system initialization screen remains on, display the System Menu by  
pressing two of the four corners of the touch panel simultaneously, and check  
the settings for the communications conditions for communications with the  
host.  
Operation Start  
The RUN mode is established, and operation starts in accordance with the  
screen data in the NT631/NT631C.  
operation by displaying the System Menu. For details on displaying the Sys-  
tem Menu, refer to 6-3-3 Operations with the System Menu (page 133).  
6-3 Operation Modes and the System Menu  
The NT631/NT631C operates in four modes: the RUN, Transmit, Mainte-  
nance, and Expansion modes. These modes are selected from the System  
Menu.  
In addition, the NT631/NT631C also features the System Installer mode which  
is used specifically for installing the system program.  
The System Installer mode is selected by operation at the panel when the  
NT631/NT631C power is switched ON.  
6-3-1 Relationships among Modes  
The relationships among the System Menu, each of the operation modes, and  
the System Installer mode, are indicated in the figure below.  
For details on system menu operation, refer to 6-3-3 Operations with the Sys-  
tem Menu (page 133).  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
Section 6-3  
[Transmit Mode]  
[RUN Mode]  
In this mode, screen  
data and other data are  
transmitted between the  
Support Tool and the  
NT631/NT631C.  
This is the mode in which  
the NT631/NT631C  
operates.In this mode the  
NT631/NT631C can be  
controlled from the host,  
and various display and  
I/O operations are  
possible.  
To change system  
settings or screen  
data contents.  
[Maintenance Mode]  
When system  
settings and screen  
data registration have  
been completed.  
In this mode,  
NT631/NT631C  
maintenance operations,  
such as initialization of  
the memory, checking  
settings, and the I/O  
check, are executed.  
To change system  
settings or screen  
data contents.  
SYSTEM MENU  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Power ON  
Maintenance Mode  
[Expansion Mode]  
Expansion Mode  
In this mode, the  
If there is no system  
program, or if the  
settings for data  
Programming Console  
function is used, or check  
the version of system  
program.  
control are changed...  
[System Installer Mode]  
In this mode, the system program of the  
NT631/NT631C is installed, display of  
the System Menu is enabled or disabled,  
and screen data changes are enabled  
and disabled, among other operations.  
Items in the System Menu  
The items displayed in the system menu and their functions are as follows.  
Menu Item  
Function  
Quit  
Clear the System Menu screen and return to the RUN mode  
screen.  
Transmit Mode  
Display the Transmit Mode screen to allow transmission for  
screen data between the Support Tool and the NT631/NT631C.  
For details on transmission of screen data, refer to 6-6 Transmit-  
ting the Screen Data.  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
Section 6-3  
Menu Item  
Function  
Maintenance Mode Display the Maintenance Mode menu to allow system mainte-  
nance of the NT631/NT631C, and various NT631/NT631C set-  
tings.  
Expansion Mode  
Display the Expansion Mode menu to allow selection of the  
expansion functions supported by the NT631/NT631C. The fol-  
lowing expansion functions are supported:  
• Version Display  
Displays the version of system program, the date it was cre-  
ated, and the PT model. For details, refer to 6-14 Version Dis-  
play.  
• Programming Console Function  
Allows the NT31/NT31C to be used as a Programming Con-  
sole for a CS/CJ-series PLC, CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1,  
CQM1H, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z), or SRM1.  
For details, refer to 6-12 Programming Console Function.  
• Device Monitor Function  
Allows the NT31/NT31C to change the PLC’s operating mode  
and display/change the contents of words in a CS/CJ-series  
PLC, CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z), or SRM1. For details, refer to 6-13 Device Monitor  
Function in this manual or 2-16 Device Monitor Function in the  
Reference Manual.  
Functions of the System  
Installer Mode  
The following functions can be executed in the System Installer mode.  
• Setting the display language  
• Clearing and installing system programs  
• Disabling/enabling display of the System Menu.  
• Disabling/enabling writing to the screen data memory  
• Clearing screen data  
For details on these functions, refer to 6-5 Operations in the System Installer  
Mode.  
6-3-2 Menu Tree  
The System Menu allows the various functions of the NT631/NT631C to be  
executed by using touch switches displayed on the touch panel. The menu  
tree, starting from the System Menu, is shown below.  
For details on System Menu operations, refer to 6-3-3 Operations with the  
System Menu (page 133).  
The menu tree may differ according to the system program installed in the  
NT631/NT631C. The menu tree for the system program that is installed in the  
NT631/NT631C on shipment is shown below.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
Section 6-3  
SYSTEM INSTALLER MODE  
Exit System Installer  
Download System Program (page 145)  
Change System Settings (page 147)  
Erase Screen Data (page 148)  
MEMORY  
MEMORY INIT. MENU  
Quit  
SWITCH MENU  
Transmit Mode (page 149)  
Maintenance Mode  
Expansion Mode  
Start-up Wait Time (page 165)  
Key Press Sound (page 166)  
Buzzer Sound (page 166)  
Quit  
Screen Data (page 135)  
Display History (page 137)  
Alarm History (page 138)  
Recipe Table (page 140)  
Memory Table (page 141)  
Memory Switch (page 143)  
Printer Controller (page 168)  
Print Method (page 169)  
MAINTENANCE  
MODE MENU  
Screen Saver Movement (page 170)  
Screen Saver Start up Time (page 173)  
Hist. Disp. Method (page 175)  
Resume Function (page 177)  
Comm. Auto-return (page 179)  
Time-out Interval (page 181)  
Retry Counts (page 182)  
Quit  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switch  
I/O Settings  
Calendar Check (page 191)  
PT Settings (page 193)  
Display History  
Alarm History  
Comm. A Method (page 152)  
Comm. B Select (page 162)  
Comm. B Method (page 152)  
Screen Data Disp. (page 198)  
I/O Check  
I/O CHECK MENU  
Quit  
Contrast Adjust (page 187)  
Brightness Adjust (page 191)  
Quit  
I/F Check  
Device Check  
DISPLAY HISTORY MENU  
EXPANSION  
Quit  
MODE MENU  
Sort by Occurrence (page 194)  
Sort by Frequency (page 194)  
Quit  
Quit  
Programming Console Function (page 214)  
Version Display (page 223)  
Device Monitor Function (page 220)  
Tool Comm. (page 209)  
Comm. Port A (page 210)  
Comm. Port B (page 210)  
Printer (page 213)  
ALARM HISTORY MENU  
Quit  
Sort by Occurrence (page 196)  
Sort by Frequency (page 196)  
Quit  
Buzzer Check (page 202)  
LED Check (page 203)  
LCD Check (page 204)  
Backlight Check (page 204)  
Screen Memory (page 205)  
Touch Switch (page 207)  
Battery (page 208)  
6-3-3 Operations with the System Menu  
This section describes how to use the menus, including how to call the Sys-  
tem Menu, how to call the System Installer mode, and how to select menu  
items.  
Calling the System Menu  
Reference:  
The System Menu can be displayed by either of the following two methods.  
Touching the corners of the touch panel  
• Pressing a touch switch that displays the System Menu  
• If display of the System Menu is disabled by the setting made in the Sys-  
tem Installer mode, the System Menu cannot be displayed (this does not  
apply if an error has occurred).  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
Section 6-3  
• At the same as the System Menu is displayed, the operation of the  
NT631/NT631C stops and the RUN LED goes OFF.  
Touching The Corners of The Touch Panel  
When two of the four corners of the touch panel (see the figure below) are  
touched simultaneously, the System Menu is displayed.  
RUN mode  
POWER  
[SYSTEM MENU]  
RUN  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Press any two of the four  
Maintenance Mode  
corners at the same time.  
Expansion Mode  
Note that the touch switches used to call the System Menu are not displayed  
at corners on the screen. If a touch switch displayed in a corner is pressed  
first, the touch switch will function and the System Menu will not be displayed.  
Especially, when the touch switch has switch screen function, as a result of  
screen switch over, it means the corner is not pressed even if it is kept press-  
ing. To successfully call the System Menu, first press a corner where no touch  
switch is displayed, and then press any other corner regardless of the pres-  
ence of a touch switch.  
Reference:  
With the NT631/NT631C, the System Menu can be displayed even if the  
screen has touch switches registered at all four corners.  
Pressing a Touch Switch That Displays The System Menu  
There is a control key that has the function of displaying the System Menu.  
By registering the touch switch for System Menu display ([MENU]) on a  
screen when creating it, the System Menu can be displayed just by pressing  
this switch.  
Calling the System  
Installer Mode  
If the NT631/NT631C has no system program installed, or if the system pro-  
gram is destroyed, the System Installer mode is automatically established  
when the power is switched ON.  
To establish the System Installer mode in order to install a system program or  
make settings for data management, either turn the power ON, or reset the  
NT631/NT631C, while pressing the touch switch at the top left corner of the  
touch panel (size: 7.2 mm × 7.2 mm).  
Switch the power to the NT631/NT631C ON while pressing this touch switch.  
POWER  
RUN  
Selecting Menu Items  
The menu items in the System Menu are displayed on the NT631/NT631C  
screen as touch switches. Menu items can be selected simply by pressing  
them.  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
Example:  
Displaying the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen by pressing Mainte-  
nance Mode in the System Menu.  
Ver 4.12  
Press Maintenance Mode.  
Switching from the  
System Menu to the RUN  
Mode  
Return to the RUN mode by selecting Quit in the System Menu and other  
menus.  
Reference:  
Unlike previous PT models, the NT631/NT631C does not return to the RUN  
mode automatically if no operations are performed.  
6-4 Memory Initialization  
The NT631/NT631C has the following initialization functions. Use them as  
necessary.  
• Clearing screen data  
page 135  
page 141  
page 143  
page 137  
page 138  
page 140  
• Initializing memory tables  
• Initializing memory switches  
• Initializing display history record data  
• Initializing alarm history record data  
• Initializing recipe tables  
Reference:  
If writing to the screen data memory has been disabled by the System Setting  
setting in the System Installer mode, memory initialization is not possible.  
6-4-1 Clearing Screen Data  
Use this function if the screen data has been corrupted and the NT631/  
NT631C cannot be started up correctly.  
This operation clears (initializes) only the screen data and contents of the cal-  
culation tables. The memory switch settings and display history/alarm history  
record data are retained.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
Reference:  
• When this function is used, all of the screen data contents registered in  
the NT631/NT631C up to that point are cleared. Check that the created  
screens are backed up at the Support Tool before using it.  
• The screen data can be cleared in the System Installer mode too  
(page 148).  
• The following types of data can be initialized individually.  
Contents of numeral/character string memory tables (page 141)  
Memory switch settings (page 143)  
Display history record data (page 137)  
Alarm history record data (page 138)  
Clear the screen data by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Screen Data.  
Select Yes.  
The screen data is cleared. During  
clearance, the message Erasing Now...  
is displayed.  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
If No is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without clearing the screen data.  
On completion of screen data clearance, the NT631/NT631C returns to the  
MEMORY INIT. MENU screen.  
After the screen data has been cleared, if an attempt is made to set the  
NT631/NT631C to the RUN mode before screen data has been transmitted  
from the Support Tool or Memory Unit, an error message will be displayed and  
the RUN mode will not be established.  
6-4-2 Initializing Display History Record Data  
The display history record function keeps a record of the order of display of  
the screens displayed during operation, and the number of times each screen  
is displayed. These records are kept only for screens for which the History  
attribute has been set.  
The maximum number of records is 1024 for sort by occurrence (order of dis-  
play occurrence) and 255 for sort by frequency (order of the number of times  
each screen has been displayed).  
Use the display history record initialization function to clear the history record  
data to 0, for example when the screen data has been changed, etc. Also, if  
Alarm (Use Ring Buffer) under History Setting of System in PT Configuration  
(Tools) has not been checked, no more records will be stored after the maxi-  
mum number of records has been kept, and therefore the records must be  
periodically initialized. If Alarm (Use Ring Buffer) is checked, when the maxi-  
mum number of records is reached the oldest record is deleted and the new-  
est data is recorded.  
Reference:  
The NT631/NT631C also allows the display history record data to be  
initialized by controlling the PT status control area from the host. For details,  
refer to 2-2-1 PT Status Control Area in the Reference Manual.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
Initialize the display history record data by following the menu operation from  
the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Display History.  
Select Yes.  
The display history record data is  
initialized. During initialization, the message  
Initializing is displayed.  
If No is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without initializing the display history record data.  
On completion of display history record data initialization, the message Fin-  
ished is displayed and the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT.  
MENU screen.  
6-4-3 Initializing Alarm History Record Data  
The alarm history record function continually checks the status of host bits  
that have been designated in advance with a bit memory table, and records  
the time when any of the bits is set to 1 (comes ON), and the number of times  
that each bit comes ON.  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
The maximum number of records is 256 for sort by occurrence (order of error  
occurrence) and 255 for sort by frequency (order of the number of times each  
error has occurred).  
Use the alarm history record initialization function to reset the alarm history  
record data to 0, for example when the screen data has been changed, etc.  
Also, if Screen (Use Ring Buffer) under History Setting in the PT Environment  
Settings – System Settings has not been checked, no more records will be  
stored after the maximum number of records has been kept, and therefore the  
records must be periodically initialized. If Screen (Use Ring Buffer) is  
checked, when the maximum number of records is reached the oldest record  
is deleted and the newest data is recorded.  
Reference:  
The NT631/NT631C also allows the alarm history record data to be initialized  
by controlling the PT status control area from the host. For details, refer to 2-  
2-1 PT Status Control Area in the Reference Manual.  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
Initialize the alarm history record data by following the menu operation from  
the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Alarm History.  
Select Yes.  
The alarm history record data is initialized.  
During initialization, the message  
Initializing is displayed.  
If No is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without initializing the alarm history record data.  
On completion of alarm history record data initialization, the message Fin-  
ished is displayed and the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT.  
MENU screen.  
6-4-4 Initializing the Recipe Tables  
You can initialize the recipe tables (i.e., all the recipe data) edited in the  
NT631/NT631C. Here, “initializing” the recipe tables means to restore the bat-  
tery backup memory (“recipe data memory”) to the values in flash memory at  
that time. If, after downloading from the Support Tool, you do not upload the  
data even once, initialization will restore the initial values set using the Sup-  
port Tool. The values will not be cleared.  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
Initialize the recipe tables by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Recipe Table.  
Select Yes.  
The recipe tables are initialized.  
During initialization, the message  
Initializing is displayed.  
If No is selected, the NT31/NT31C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without initializing the recipe tables.  
On completion of memory table initialization, the message Finished is dis-  
played and the NT31/NT31C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU screen.  
6-4-5 Initializing the Memory Tables  
It is possible to initialize the numeral memory tables and character string  
memory tables in the NT631/NT631C.  
When these tables are initialized, the values are returned to those set by the  
Support Tool (they are not cleared).  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
When the memory tables are initialized, they are returned to their initial values  
regardless of the setting made for the resume function (page 177).  
If ON is set for the Resume Function memory switch, the initial values set with  
the Support Tool will not be recorded in the memory tables unless they are ini-  
tialized.  
Reference:  
• If OFF is set for the Resume Function memory switch, the memory tables  
can be initialized just by switching the NT631/NT631C power off and back  
on again, or by resetting the NT631/NT631C (page 177).  
• The bit memory table merely reflects the statuses of bits at the host and  
therefore cannot be initialized.  
Initialize the memory tables by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Memory Table.  
Select Yes.  
The memory tables are initialized.  
During initialization, the message  
Initializing is displayed.  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Initialization  
Section 6-4  
If No is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without initializing the memory tables.  
On completion of memory table initialization, the message Finished is dis-  
played and the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU screen.  
6-4-6 Initializing the Memory Switches  
Initialization returns all the memory switches of the NT631/NT631C to their  
status on shipment.  
Initialize the memory switches by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Init..  
Select Memory Switch.  
Select Yes.  
The memory tables are initialized.  
During initialization, the message  
Initializing is displayed.  
If No is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU  
screen without initializing the memory switches.  
On completion of memory switch initialization, the message Finished is dis-  
played and the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEMORY INIT. MENU screen.  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operations in the System Installer Mode  
Section 6-5  
After initialization, the memory switch statuses are as follows.  
Memory Switch Status  
Start-up Wait Time  
00  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
ON  
OFF  
Printer Controller  
Print Method  
ESC/P  
Tone (NT631C only)  
Screen Saver Movement  
Screen Saver Start up Time  
Hist. Disp. Method  
Resume Function  
Comm. Auto-return  
Time-out Interval  
Retry Counts  
Display erased  
010  
From New Data  
OFF  
OFF  
01  
005  
Host Link (communications speed = 9600 bps)*  
Comm. A Method  
Comm. B Select  
Comm. B Method  
RS-232C  
None  
* The communications conditions for a bar code reader are initialized as fol-  
lows:  
Data bits: 7 bits; stop bit: 1 bit; parity: none; flow control: RS/CS.  
6-5 Operations in the System Installer Mode  
The following functions can be executed in the System Installer mode:  
• Setting the display language (see below)  
• Clearing/installing the system program (page 145)  
• Disabling/enabling display of the System Menu (changing the system set-  
tings) (page 147)  
• Disabling/enabling writing to the screen data memory (changing the sys-  
tem settings) (page 147)  
• Clearing screen data (page 148)  
For details on calling the System Installer mode, refer to Calling the System  
Installer Mode (page 134).  
The version code displayed beside the System Installer title on the screen  
indicates the version of the System Installer Mode. For details, refer to 3-5  
Using a Memory Unit.  
6-5-1 Setting the Display Language in the System Installer Mode  
The first setting made in the System Installer mode is to select whether the  
display language is to be English or Japanese.  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Operations in the System Installer Mode  
Section 6-5  
Select English or Japanese.  
From here on, this manual assumes that  
English has been selected here.  
The System Installer mode menu is  
displayed.  
If there is no system program or the  
system program has been corrupted,  
the message System Program not  
exist or incorrect. is displayed at the  
bottom of the screen.  
6-5-2 Clearing/Installing the System Program  
Use this function when the system program of the NT631/NT631C has been  
corrupted, or when installing a new system program.  
Reference:  
• In order to install a system program, the system installer must also be  
installed at the Support Tool. The system installer is an accessory with the  
Support Tool (NT-ZJCAT1-EV4). When installing the Support Tool in a  
personal computer, install the system installer also. For details on the  
method for installing the system installer at the Support Tool side, and the  
operating procedure, refer to the NT-series Support Tool Ver. 4.@ for Win-  
dows Operation Manual (V061-E1-@).  
• When the system program is cleared by mistake, it becomes impossible  
to use the NT631/NT631C at all. Check that the system installer is  
installed at the Support Tool side before deleting the program. However,  
note that the registered screen data and memory switch settings are  
retained.  
• It becomes possible to install the system program inside the Memory Unit  
automatically by installing the Memory Unit at startup (Refer to 3-5 Using  
a Memory Unit).  
Clear/install the system program by following the menu operation from the  
System Installer mode menu shown below.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the System Installer Mode  
Section 6-5  
Clearing the System Program  
Select Download System Program.  
Select Yes.  
The system program is cleared. During  
clearance, the message Erasing ... is  
displayed.  
• If Return to Menu is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the System  
Installer mode menu without clearing the system program.  
• If clearance fails, a screen asking whether you wish to try again is dis-  
played.  
On completion of system program clearance, the NT631/NT631C enters the  
standby status for downloading of the system program.  
Downloading the System  
Program  
On normal completion of system program clearance, the standby status for  
system program downloading is automatically established.  
When the NT631/NT631C enters this  
status, transmit the system program from  
the system installer at the personal  
computer.  
During downloading, the progress of  
transmission is indicated on the screen.  
Select Run System.  
If Abort is selected during standby for downloading or during downloading, a  
screen asking whether you wish to download again is displayed.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operations in the System Installer Mode  
Section 6-5  
When the system program is started, the NT631/NT631C starts up normally.  
If no screen data has been registered, an error message will be displayed  
indicating that screen data hasn’t been registered. Transfer the screen data  
and proceed.  
Reference:  
If the new system program is not downloaded successfully after deleting a  
system program, it is not possible to use the NT631/NT631C at all. After  
deleting the system program, be sure to download a new one.  
6-5-3 Changing the System Settings  
The NT631/NT631C allows the following settings to be made to prevent the  
screen data and memory switch settings from being changed or deleted by  
operating errors.  
Disabling/enabling System Menu Display  
When System Menu display is disabled by this setting, the System Menu can-  
not be displayed by touch panel operations or by using the touch switches.  
However, if a error occurs, the System Menu can be displayed from the error  
message screen.  
Disabling/enabling Writing to The Screen Data Memory  
When writing to the screen data memory is disabled by this setting, it is  
impossible to use the following System Menu functions.  
• Switching to the Transmit mode  
• Displaying the memory switch setting screens  
• Checking the screen data memory  
• Displaying the initialization menu  
• Displaying the calendar/time setting screen (the calendar/time display  
screen can be displayed)  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Operations in the System Installer Mode  
Section 6-5  
Change the system settings by following the menu operation from the System  
Installer mode menu shown below.  
Select Change System Settings.  
Select Display System Menu or Screen  
Memory Protect.  
Each time either of these items is  
selected, the setting switches from  
Disabled to Enabled or vice versa.  
Select OK.  
The settings are written to the  
NT631/NT631C while the screen is  
displayed.  
• If Cancel is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the System Installer  
mode menu without changing the settings. The settings remain as they  
were before the operation was started.  
• If writing of the settings fails, a screen asking whether you wish to try  
again is displayed.  
After the settings have been written, the System Installer mode menu screen  
is redisplayed.  
6-5-4 Clearing Screen Data  
If the screen data has been corrupted and the NT631/NT631C cannot be  
started normally, use this function to clear the screen data.  
Note that only the screen data is cleared (initialized), and the memory switch  
settings and the display history/alarm history record data are retained.  
Reference:  
• When this function is used, all of the screen data contents registered in  
the NT631/NT631C up to that point are cleared. Check that the created  
screens are backed up at the Support Tool before using it.  
• The screen data can also be cleared from the System Menu (page 135).  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Transmitting the Screen Data  
Section 6-6  
• If the screen data is cleared in the System Installer mode, the message  
Screen Data Corrupted may be displayed on switching to the RUN mode.  
If this happens, initialize the screen data again from the MEMORY INIT.  
MENU screen.  
Clear the screen data by following the menu operation from the System  
Installer mode menu shown below.  
Select Erase Screen Data.  
Select Yes.  
The screen data is cleared. During  
clearance, the message Erasing ... is  
displayed.  
• If Return to Menu is selected, the NT631/NT631C returns to the MEM-  
ORY INIT. MENU screen without clearing the screen data.  
• If screen data clearance fails, a screen asking if you wish to try again is  
displayed.  
On completion of screen data clearance, the NT631/NT631C returns to the  
System Installer mode menu screen.  
After the screen data has been cleared, if an attempt is made to set the  
NT631/NT631C to the RUN mode before screen data has been transmitted  
from the Support Tool or Memory Unit, an error message will be displayed and  
the RUN mode will not be established.  
6-6 Transmitting the Screen Data  
The screen data is created with the Support Tool and then transmitted to the  
NT631/NT631C. This section explains how to transmit the screen data.  
For details on how to create the screen data and the operation of the Support  
Tool, refer to the Reference Manual and the NT-series Support Tool Ver. 4.@  
for Windows Operation Manual (V061-E1-@).  
Reference:  
• The screen data can be transmitted also from the Memory Unit installed  
in the NT631/NT631C. For details on this method, refer to 3-5 Using a  
Memory Unit.  
• The screen data can be transmitted at a faster rate by setting High for  
Baud Rate on the Comms. Setting... window of the Support Tool.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Transmitting the Screen Data  
Section 6-6  
• If writing to the screen data memory is disabled by the setting made for  
System Setting in the System Installer mode, screen data transmission is  
not possible.  
Screen Data Composition  
and Transmission Units  
The screen data comprises the following types of data.  
• User screen data (screen units)  
• System memory (memory switch) settings  
• Direct connection information  
• Numeral memory table data  
• Character string memory table data  
• Bit memory table data  
• Mathematical table data  
• Mark information  
• Image/library data  
• Recipe table data  
It is possible to transmit the screen data (data for all the screens) in file units,  
or to transmit individual data or the data of individual screens in data units. (It  
is not possible to transmit table data in data units.)  
When data is transmitted in file units, all of the screen data in the NT631/  
NT631C is cleared and then the new data is transmitted.  
When data is transmitted in data units, first the previous data is invalidated,  
then the new data is registered as valid data. Since the previous data is not  
cleared, free memory area in the NT631/NT631C will be insufficient when  
transmissions in data units are repeated. If this happens, write the screen  
data again by data transmission in file units.  
Transmitting Screen Data  
from the Support Tool  
To transmit screen data from the Support Tool to the NT631/NT631C, follow  
the procedure below.  
Operation  
1,2,3...  
1. Connect the NT631/NT631C to a personal computer in which the Support  
Tool has been installed and turn the power to the NT631/NT631C ON.  
2. Turn ON the power to the personal computer and start up the Support Tool.  
3. Establish the Transmit mode by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below at the NT631/NT631C.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Transmitting the Screen Data  
Section 6-6  
Ver 4.12  
Select Transmit Mode.  
Select Tool Transmit.  
4. Open the screen data to be transmitted at the Support Tool, then select  
Download (NTST PT) in the Support Tool’s Connect menu and specify the  
data to be transmitted.  
5. During screen data transmission, the transmission status is displayed.  
6. On completion of screen data transmission, press the Quit touch switch.  
The NT631/NT631C returns to the Transmit mode.  
If the screen data cannot be successfully transmitted from the Support Tool,  
use the communications check functions of the NT631/NT631C to check if  
communications between the NT631/NT631C is normal or not (page 209).  
Precautions to Be  
If any of the following, or a system error, occurs during transmission of screen  
data, the transmitted screen data will not be registered correctly in the NT631/  
NT631C. If this happens, the NT631/NT631C may not enter the RUN mode  
when started up, or there may be unpredictable malfunctions such as failure  
to display screens during operation. In this case, the screen data must be  
retransmitted in file units to register it correctly.  
Observed When  
Transmitting Screen Data  
• The power to the NT631/NT631C is interrupted or the NT631/NT631C is  
reset.  
• The power to the personal computer on which the Support Tool is running  
is interrupted or the computer is reset.  
• The cable connecting the NT631/NT631C to the personal computer on  
which the Support Tool is running is disconnected or has a broken wire.  
• The Quit touch switch on the NT631/NT631C screen is pressed to end  
screen data transmission.  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
• Screen data transmission is stopped by operation at the Support Tool.  
Note  
When transferring the data in units of screens, if there are changes in memory  
table and/or direct access, transfer such data along with the screen data.  
6-7 Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by  
Using Memory Switches  
The NT631/NT631C can be connected to the host by the following 7 types of  
communications methods can be used to communicate with a host.  
• Host link  
• Memory link method  
• NT Link (1:1)  
• Mitsubishi A-computer link method  
• Mitsubishi FX method  
• NT Link (1:N)  
• High-speed NT Link (1:N)  
The NT631/NT631C has the following two ports, either of which can be used  
for communications with the host, depending on the requirements.  
• Serial port A (exclusively for RS-232C, 9-pin connector)  
• Serial port B (RS-232C/RS-422A (selectable), 25-pin connector)  
The method for setting the communications method for communications with  
For details on setting the communications conditions for a bar code reader,  
refer to 6-10 Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function.  
Reference:  
• Apart from the host, it is also possible to connect the Support Tool or a  
bar code reader to serial port A. When a bar code reader is connected at  
serial port A, the host must be connected at serial port B. When serial  
port A is being used for communications with the host, the host must be  
disconnected so that the Support Tool can be connected.  
• There are four memory switch setting screens. The conditions for commu-  
nications with the host are set on the fourth screen (the screen on which  
4/4 is displayed). For details on setting memory switches other than those  
for setting the conditions for communications with the host, refer to 6-9  
Various System Settings.  
• When using the Mitsubishi A-computer link method and Mitsubishi FX  
method, a system program for multi-venders is required. Install the sys-  
tem program to the NT631/631C by the system installer (refer to  
page 145). For details, refer to PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@).  
• When using PLCs manufactured by Allen-Bradley, GE Fanuc, or Siemens,  
refer to NT31/631 Multi Vendor Connection Manual (V060-E1-@).  
6-7-1 About Communications Conditions  
Items Set for  
Communications  
Conditions  
The following settings are made for the communications conditions for com-  
munications between the NT631/NT631C and the host.  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
Port Communications Method/Communications Type Settings  
Function Setting Options  
Comm. A Method Set the communications method used at serial port A system program for OMRON  
Setting Item  
Page  
A. Depending on the communications method, fur- model.  
ther communications condition settings may be nec- None/Host Link/NT Link (1:1)/  
160  
162  
essary.  
NT Link (1:N) (standard or high-  
speed)/Bar-Code Reader  
Memory link  
Comm. B Select Set whether serial port B is to be used for RS-232C RS-232C/RS-422A  
or RS-422A communications.  
Comm. B Method Set the communications method used at serial port A system program for OMRON  
B. Depending on the communications method, fur-  
model.  
158  
160  
ther communications condition settings may be nec- None/Host Link/NT Link (1:1)/  
essary.  
NT Link (1:N) (standard or high-  
speed)  
Memory link  
Communications Condition Settings for The Host Link Method  
Setting Item  
Function  
Setting  
Options  
Page  
Comm. Speed  
(for host link only)  
Sets the communications speed  
for communications with the host. 19200 bps  
9600 bps/  
155  
Communications Condition Settings for The NT Link (1:1) Method  
No further communications conditions need to be set.  
Communications Conditions Settings for The NT Link (1:N) Method  
Setting Item  
Function  
Setting  
Options  
Page  
Unit No.  
Set the unit number of the NT631/ 0 to 7  
NT631C.  
158  
(for NT Link (1:N)  
only)  
Comm. Speed  
Sets the communications speed  
for communications with the host. high-speed  
Standard or  
Setting The Conditions for Communications with The Memory Link  
Method  
Setting Item  
Function  
Setting  
Options  
Page  
Data bits  
Set the data bits length.  
Set the stop bits length.  
Set the parity.  
7, 8 bits  
160  
Stop bits  
Parity  
1, 2 bits  
None, even,  
odd  
Comm. Speed  
Set the communications speed for 1200, 2400,  
communications with the host.  
4800, 9600,  
19200, 38400  
bps  
Flow control  
Response  
Set the flow control and its  
method.  
None,RS/CS,  
XON/XOFF  
Set whether the response is car- Yes, No  
ried out for normal process of  
communications command or not.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
Possible Combinations of  
Communications Method  
Settings  
The combinations of communications methods that can be set with the  
NT631/NT631C are indicated in the table below. Combinations other than  
these listed below cannot be set (when using a system for multi-venders, refer  
to the PLC Connection Manual (V042-E1-@) or NT31/631 Multi Vendor Con-  
nection Manual (V060-E1-@)).  
Serial port B  
Serial port A  
None  
Host Link  
NT Link  
(1:1)  
NT Link  
(1:N)  
Bar-code  
reader  
Memory  
Link  
None  
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
Host Link  
×
×
×
×
NT Link (1:1)  
NT Link (1:N)  
Memory Link  
: Possible combination  
×: Impossible combination  
Combinations other than those indicated above cannot be set.  
Reference:  
When using serial port B for communications with the host, and serial port A  
for the transmission of screen data from the Support Tool, set the settings of  
serial port A to None.  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
6-7-2 Setting the Host Link Method  
Set the communications conditions for the host link method at serial port A or  
serial port B by following the operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Display the fourth memory switch  
screen by pressing the [] (next screen)  
or [] (previous screen) touch switch.  
Press the touch switch corresponding to  
the port at which the host link method is  
to be set (Comm. A Method or Comm. B  
Method) to display the setting option Host  
Link.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
Press the Set touch switch to the right of  
the port at which the setting has been  
made.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
Press the Comm. Speed touch  
switch to display the communications  
speed to be set.  
The setting option changes each  
time the touch switch is pressed.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
Press Quit.  
The communications speed is set.  
To quit the communications speed setting screen without setting the com-  
munications speed, press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the memory switch setting screen (4/4) and the previous com-  
munications speed remains in effect.  
On completion of communications speed setting, the NT631/NT631C returns  
to the memory switch setting screen (4/4).  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
6-7-3 Setting the NT Link (1:1) Method  
Set the communications conditions for the NT Link (1:1) method at serial port  
A or serial port B by following the operation from the System Menu shown  
below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Display the fourth memory switch  
screen by pressing the [] (next screen)  
or [] (previous screen) touch switch.  
Press the touch switch corresponding to the  
port at which the NT Link (1:1) method is to  
be set (Comm. A Method or Comm. B  
Method) to display the setting option NT  
Link (1:1).  
The setting option changes each time the touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
6-7-4 Setting the NT Link (1:N) Method (Standard/High-speed)  
Set the communications conditions for the NT Link (1:N) method at serial port  
A or serial port B by following the operation from the System Menu shown  
below.  
The communications speed determines whether the 1:N NT Link is standard  
or high-speed.  
Standard: Standard 1:N NT Link  
High-speed:High-speed 1:N NT Link  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Display the fourth memory switch  
screen by pressing the [] (next screen)  
or [] (previous screen) touch switch.  
Press the touch switch corresponding to the  
port at which the NT Link (1:N) method  
(standard or high-speed) is to be set  
(Comm. A Method or Comm. B Method) to  
display the setting option NT Link (1:N).  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
Press the Set touch switch to the right of the  
port at which the setting has been made.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
Press the Unit No. touch switch to display  
the unit number to be set. Press the Comm.  
Speed touch switch to display the  
communications speed, standard or 115.2-  
kbps high-speed. (The Comm. Speed  
setting determines which method of 1:N  
NT Link is used.)  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed. In this example,  
serial port A is used for a standard 1:N NT  
Link.  
Press Quit.  
The unit number is set.  
To quit the unit number/communications speed setting screen without  
confirming the unit number/communications speed settings, press the  
Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the memory switch  
setting screen (4/4) with the previous settings still in effect.  
Reference:  
• Unit numbers are numbers assigned to each PT when multiple PTs are  
connected to one host, so that the host can identify the individual PTs.  
The units numbers that can be set differ according to the host model, as  
follows.  
• C200HE(-ZE):  
Unit numbers 0 to 3 (maximum of 4 PTs per host port)  
• C200HG(-ZE), C200HX(-ZE):  
Unit numbers 0 to 7 (maximum of 8 PTs per host port)  
When making the settings, make sure there is no duplication of unit numbers  
among PTs.  
On completion of unit number setting, the NT631/NT631C returns to the  
memory switch setting screen (4/4).  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
6-7-5 Setting the Memory Link Method  
Set the communications conditions for the host link method at serial port A or  
serial port B by following the operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Check the communications settings of the host to be used.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Display the fourth memory switch  
screen by pressing the [] (next screen)  
or [] (previous screen) touch switch.  
Press the touch switch corresponding to the  
port at which the memory link method is to  
be set (Comm. A Method or Comm. B  
Method) to display the setting option  
Memory Link.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
Press the Set touch switch to the right of the  
port at which the setting has been made.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
Display the data bits to be set (7 bits or 8 bits)  
by pressing the Data Bit Length touch switch.  
Display the stop bits to be set (1 bit or 2 bits)  
by pressing the Stop Bit Length touch switch.  
Display the parity to be set (None, even, odd)  
by pressing the Parity Bit touch switch.  
Display the communications speed to be set  
(1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 bps.)  
by pressing the Comm. Speed touch switch.  
Display the condition of the flow control to be  
set (None, RS/CS, XON/XOFF) by pressing  
Flow Control touch switch.  
If the RS-422A is selected for serial port B  
setting, RS/CS is not displayed.  
Display presence or absence of the response  
by pressing the Response touch switch.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
In this example, serial port A is used.  
Press the Quit touch switch.  
To quit the communications speed setting screen without setting the com-  
munications speed, press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the memory switch setting screen (4/4) and the previous com-  
munications speed remains in effect.  
On completion of communications speed setting, the NT631/NT631C returns  
to the memory switch setting screen (4/4).  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Conditions for Communications with Host by Using Memory Switches  
Section 6-7  
6-7-6 Setting the Communications Type for Serial Port B  
Set the communications type (RS-232C or RS-422A) for serial port B by fol-  
lowing the operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Display the fourth memory switch  
screen by pressing the [] (next screen)  
or [] (previous screen) touch switch.  
Press the Comm. B Select touch switch to  
display the communications type to be  
set.The setting option changes each time  
the touch switch is pressed.  
Reference:  
If serial port B is used for RS-485 communications, RS-422A must be set as  
its communications type.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Starting Operation  
Section 6-8  
6-8 Starting Operation  
After completing screen data transmission and setting the communications  
conditions, connect the NT631/NT631C to the host and start operation.  
Note  
Check the operation of all screen data and host programs carefully before  
using them. If incorrect, the system may operate unpredictably.  
Switching to the RUN  
Mode and Starting  
Operation  
Press the Quit touch switch on the System Menu screen or other screen. The  
NT631/NT631C switches to the RUN mode and starts operation.  
The operation at the start is as follows.  
Display of The System Initialization Screen  
When establishing the communications with a host, the System initializing  
character string is displayed on the screen. If the communications with the  
host cannot be established, the System initializing screen remains up. If this is  
the case, check the settings at the host and the PT side, the cables and wir-  
ing.  
In addition, creating screen number 9000 enables the display of a screen  
other than the System initialization screen.  
Transmission of The Contents of Memory Tables  
If the Resume Function memory switch is set to ON, or if the initial values of  
the memory tables are used, the contents of the numeral/character-string  
memory tables are copied to the allocated words at the host.  
Display of The Startup Screen  
The startup screen is displayed on reading the contents (screen number of  
the screen to be displayed) of the first word of the PT status control area.  
If the contents are not correct for a screen number, or there is no data regis-  
tered for the set screen number, an error message is displayed.  
Confirming the  
Execute the host program and confirm that the following operations are per-  
formed normally.  
Communications between  
the NT631/NT631C and the  
Host  
• Confirm that the NT631/NT631C screens switch in accordance with the  
host program.  
If the screens do not switch correctly, check the connection between  
tings are correct. For details, refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the  
Host from the RS-232C Port, or SECTION 5 Connecting to the Host  
from the RS-422A/485 Port.  
• Confirm that the operation results of touch switch and numeric value/char-  
acter string input at the NT631/NT631C are sent to the host correctly by  
displaying the contents of the host words and bits using a Programming  
Device (e.g. CX-Programmer).  
If the results of operations at the NT631/NT631C are not sent to the  
host correctly, check the setting of the display elements. For details on  
setting display elements, refer to the description of each display ele-  
ment in the Reference Manual.  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9 Various System Settings  
The NT631/NT631C allows a variety of functions which are convenient during  
operation to be set with memory switches. This section describes the memory  
switch settings relating to the operation environment.  
Since the memory switch settings are backed up to the flash memory by the  
battery in the NT631/NT631C, they are not cleared when the power is  
switched OFF.  
6-9-1 Memory Switch Setting Screens  
There are four memory switch setting screens. The required screen can be  
displayed by using the [ ] (next screen) and [ ] (previous screen) touch  
switches.  
The four memory switch setting screens are shown below.  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
Memory Switch Settings  
A list of the memory switch settings is presented below.  
• Start-up Wait Time  
• Key Press Sound  
• Buzzer Sound  
page 165  
page 166  
page 166  
page 168  
page 169  
page 170  
page 173  
page 175  
page 177  
page 179  
page 181  
page 182  
page 152  
• Printer Controller  
• Print Method  
• Screen Saver Movement  
• Screen Saver Start up Time  
• Hist. Disp. Method  
• Resume Function  
• Comm. Auto-return  
• Time-out Interval  
• Retry Counts  
• Comm. A Method  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
(For the bar code reader, refer to page 184.)  
• Comm. B Select  
• Comm. B Method  
page 162  
page 152  
For details on each setting, refer to the pages indicated.  
6-9-2 Setting the Start-up Wait Time  
The Start-up Wait Time is the time lapse until the NT631/NT631C switches to  
the RUN mode after its power has been switched ON or after it has been  
reset. Set this item if it takes some time for the host to start operation. Nothing  
is displayed during the Start-up Wait Time.  
The setting range is 0 to 10 seconds. The default (factory) setting is 00sec.  
Set the system start-up wait time by following the menu operation from the  
System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press Start-up Wait Time to display the  
required time lapse.  
The setting option changes each time  
the touch switch is pressed, according  
to the following sequence.  
01 02 03 .... 09 10 00 01 ....  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-3 Setting the Key Press Sound  
It is possible to set whether or not the key sound is sounded when a touch  
switch on the NT631/NT631C screen is pressed.  
• ON: When a touch switch is pressed, the key sound sounds for 0.2 sec-  
onds.  
• OFF: The key sound does not sound when touch switches are pressed.  
The default (factory) setting is ON.  
Set the key press sound by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press Key Press Sound to display ON or  
OFF.  
The setting option changes each time  
the touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
6-9-4 Setting the Buzzer Sound  
The NT631/NT631C has a function for sounding a buzzer in response to an  
instruction from the host, or when an error occurs. It is possible to set whether  
or not the buzzer actually sounds with the memory switches.  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
• ON:  
The buzzer sounds in response to instructions and when an error occurs.  
• OFF:  
The buzzer does not sound in response to instructions or when errors  
occur.  
• ERROR ON:  
The buzzer sounds only when an error occurs.  
The default (factory) setting is OFF.  
Reference:  
• There are other instructions and settings relating to the buzzer, but this  
memory switch setting has the highest priority.  
• For details on the buzzer, refer to 2-15-5 Buzzer Function in the Refer-  
ence Manual.  
Set the buzzer sound by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press Buzzer Sound to display ON,  
OFF, or ERROR ON.  
The setting option changes each  
time the touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-5 Setting the Printer Controller  
The NT631/NT631C has a function for printing out data at a printer connected  
to it in response to an instruction from the host or operation at the NT631/  
NT631C. Three types of printer can be connected to the NT631/NT631C:  
select the type used with this memory switch setting.  
• ESC/P:  
Printers that conform to Epson’s ESC/P 24-J83C (color) printer control  
specifications or printers that conform to Epson’s ESC/P 24-J82 (mono-  
chrome) control specifications.  
• PC-PR201H:  
Printers that can emulate the PC-PR201H, made by NEC Corp.  
• PCL 5:  
Printers that conform to the PCL 5 printer control specifications.  
Note that the NT631 can only be used with the monochrome Tone setting and  
does not support color printing.  
For the NT631, the Print Method is fixed as Tone.  
The default (factory) setting is ESC/P.  
Reference:  
• In addition to this setting, NT631C has the Print Method setting  
(page 169).  
• For details on the print function, refer to 2-15-7 Print Function in the Ref-  
erence Manual.  
Set the printer controller setting by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press Printer Controller to display the  
required printer type.  
The setting option changes each time  
the touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
6-9-6 Setting the Print Method (NT631C Only)  
The NT631/NT631C has a function for printing out data at a printer connected  
to it in response to an instruction from the host or operation at the NT631/  
NT631C.  
When using the NT631C, the currently displayed screen image or other data  
can be printed out in color. You can select whether screen data is actually  
printed out in color, or in monochrome tones that represent colors, with this  
memory switch setting.  
When PCL 5 is set for Printer Controller, the setting is fixed as Tone.  
• Color: Color images are printed in color.  
Tone: Color images are printed in monochrome tones.  
The default (factory) setting is Tone.  
Reference:  
• In addition to this setting, NT631C has the Printer Controller setting  
(page 168).  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
• For details on the print function, refer to 2-15-7 Print Function in the Ref-  
erence Manual.  
Set the print method setting by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press Print Method to display the required  
printing method.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
6-9-7 Setting Screen Saver Movement  
The NT631/NT631C has a function to prevent the formation of an afterimage  
by turning off the screen display if no operation is performed for a certain  
period of time, and then displaying character strings at random positions and  
in random colors (the colors only change for the NT631C).  
The Screen Saver Movement setting determines whether or not these charac-  
ter strings are displayed while the screen display is off.  
If Display is selected, the character string stored in character string memory  
table No. 0 is displayed.  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
If Display erase is selected, the character string is not displayed, and the  
backlight is also turned off while the screen display is off.  
The default (factory) setting is Display erased.  
The screen saver can be canceled, and former screen redisplayed, by any of  
the following operations.  
Touching any part of the touch panel  
• Screen switching due to PT status control area operations  
• Screen switching due to bit memory table operations  
• Execution of any of the following PT status control bit operations:  
• Changing the backlight mode  
• Screen printing (change from OFF to ON)  
• Screen display (change from OFF to ON)  
Reference:  
• The time before the screen is turned OFF is set by the Screen Saver Start  
up Time setting. For details, refer to 6-9-8 Setting the Screen Saver Start-  
up Time (page 173).  
• Even if its operation has been set with the Screen Saver Movement set-  
ting, the screen saver function will not be executed if 000 is set for Screen  
Saver Start up Time.  
• Screen saver function is enabled only through RUN mode of NT631/  
NT631C. In System Menu or System Installer mode, this function is not  
started.  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the screen saver operation by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the second memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Screen Saver Movement to display  
Display or Display erased.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-8 Setting the Screen Saver Start-up Time  
The NT631/NT631C has a function to maximize the service life of the back-  
light and prevent the formation of an afterimage by turning off the screen dis-  
play and the backlight if no operation is performed for a certain period of time.  
The Screen Saver Start up Time setting determines the time interval before  
the screen saver function operates.  
The setting range is 0 to 255 minutes. The default (factory) setting is 10 min-  
utes. If 000 is set, the screen saver function does not operate.  
The screen saver can be canceled, and previous screen redisplayed, by any  
of the following operations.  
Touching any part of the touch panel  
• Screen switching due to PT status control area operations  
• Screen switching due to bit memory table operations  
• Execution of any of the following PT status control bit operations:  
• Changing the backlight mode  
• Screen printing (change from OFF to ON)  
• Screen display (change from OFF to ON)  
Reference:  
• It is possible to display the character string stored in character string  
memory table No. 0 at random positions and in random colors while the  
screen display is off. For details, refer to 6-9-7 Setting Screen Saver  
Movement (page 170). Note however that, when this feature is used, the  
• For details on the screen saver function, refer to 6-9-7 Setting Screen  
Saver Movement (page 170).  
• Screen saver function is enabled only through RUN mode of NT631/  
NT631C. In System Menu or System Installer mode, this function is not  
started.  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the screen saver start-up time by following the menu operation from the  
System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the second memory  
switch setting screen.  
Set a time in the input field to the right of  
Screen Saver Start up Time.  
Each of the digits can be incremented or  
decremented by pressing the associated +  
and - keys.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-9 Setting the History Display Method  
The NT631/NT631C features the display history record function, which  
records the time at which screens are displayed during operation and the  
number of times they are displayed, and the alarm history record function,  
which continually monitors bit statuses at the host and records the time when  
bits come ON and the number of times they come ON.  
The Hist. Disp. Method setting determines whether — when these record data  
are displayed in sort by occurrence — the records are displayed in a progres-  
sion from newest to oldest or from oldest to newest.  
• From Old Data:  
The records are displayed in sequence from the oldest to newest.  
• From New Data:  
The records are displayed in sequence from the newest to oldest.  
The default (factory) setting is From New Data.  
Reference:  
• When the voltage of the NT631/NT631C’s built-in battery becomes low,  
the history record contents cannot be retained.  
• For details on the display history record function and the alarm history  
record function, refer to 2-15-1 Display History Record Function and 2-15-  
2 Alarm History Record Function in the Reference Manual.  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the history display method by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the second memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Hist. Disp. Method to display the  
required display order.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-10 Setting the Resume Function  
The NT631/NT631C has a function to keep the contents of the memory tables  
even when the power to the NT631/NT631C is OFF and write back them to  
the host when the power is turned ON.  
If the resume function is OFF, the memory tables are initialized to these initial  
values on switching to the RUN mode. If the resume function is ON, these are  
not initialized and are kept the battery-backed up contents.  
When the memory table is initialized, its contents are reset to the initial state  
that is set by the Support Tool.  
When the system is started up the next time, the screen is displayed using the  
previous contents of the memory table.  
• ON:  
The resume function is used.  
• OFF: The resume function is not used.  
The default (factory) setting is OFF.  
Reference:  
• When the voltage of the NT631/NT631C’s built-in battery becomes low,  
the memory table contents cannot be retained even if ON is set for the  
resume function.  
• For details on the resume record function, refer to 2-15-3 Resume Func-  
tion in the Reference Manual.  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the resume function by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the second memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Resume Function to display the  
required setting.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-11 Setting the Automatic Reset Function  
The NT631/NT631C has a function for ignoring communications errors and  
automatically returning to the RUN mode when they occur.  
The Comm. Auto-return setting determines whether the automatic reset func-  
tion is effective or not.  
• ON:  
When a communications error occurs, the NT631/NT631C automatically  
returns to the RUN mode without displaying an error screen (the System  
Initializing screen may be displayed).  
• OFF:  
When a communications error occurs, an error screen is displayed and  
operation stops. Pressing OK on the error screen returns the NT631/  
NT631C to the RUN mode.  
The default (factory) setting is OFF.  
Reference:  
• If a communications error occurs when OFF is set for Comm. Auto-return,  
the NT631/NT631C makes the number of attempts at communications  
with the host specified by the setting for the Retry Counts touch switch  
(page 182). If communications cannot be re-established in any of these  
• For details on communications errors, refer to 7-2-5 Communications  
Errors and Their Remedies (page 233).  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the automatic reset function by following the menu operation from the  
System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the third memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Comm. Auto-return to display the  
required setting.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
6-9-12 Setting the Time-out Interval  
The NT631/NT631C goes into the time-out error status if no response is  
received from the host within a fixed time. The Time-out Interval setting speci-  
fies the time lapse at which time-out is judged to have occurred.  
The setting range is 1 to 10 seconds. The default (factory) setting is 1 second.  
Reference:  
Whether or not an error screen is displayed when a time-out error occurs is  
determined by the setting for the Comm. Auto-return memory switch.  
Set the time-out interval by following the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the third memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Time-out Interval to display the  
required time lapse.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed, according to the  
following sequence.  
01 02 03 .... 09 10 01 ....  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
6-9-13 Setting the Retry Count  
The NT631/NT631C does not immediately display an error screen when a  
communications error occurs, but tries to re-establish communications. The  
Retry Counts setting specifies the number of attempts to be made to re-estab-  
lish communications. If communications cannot be recovered within this num-  
ber of attempts, the following happens depending on the setting made for the  
Comm. Auto-return memory switch (page 179).  
Comm. Auto-return ON:  
Operation in the RUN mode is continued without displaying an error screen.  
Regardless of the setting made for Retry Counts, attempts to re-establish  
communications are repeated until normal communications are achieved.  
Comm. Auto-return OFF:  
The RUN mode is ended and an error screen is displayed. On pressing the  
OK touch switch on the error screen, the screen displayed immediately before  
is redisplayed and attempts are made to re-establish communications.  
The System Menu can be displayed from the error screen by pressing any two  
of the four corners of the touch panel simultaneously.  
The setting range is 0 to 255 times. The default (factory) setting is 5 times.  
Reference:  
For details on communications errors, refer to 7-2-5 Communications Errors  
and Their Remedies (page 233).  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Various System Settings  
Section 6-9  
Set the retry count by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the third memory  
switch setting screen.  
Set a number of times in the input field to  
the right of Retry Counts.  
Each of the digits can be incremented or  
decremented by pressing the associated +  
and - keys.  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function  
Section 6-10  
6-10 Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function  
The NT631/NT631C has a bar code reader input function which allows a bar  
code reader to be connected and bar code data to read as character strings  
into character string input fields.  
This section describes the communications conditions for the bar code reader  
and the setting method for confirming the input data.  
Reference:  
• For details on bar code reader types and connection methods, refer to 3-4  
Connecting a Bar Code Reader in this manual and for details on how to  
use a bar code reader refer to 3-7 Input of Numeric Values and Character  
Strings in the Reference Manual.  
• The bar code reader is connected to serial port A. This means that serial  
port B must be used for communications with the host.  
Communications Condition Settings for Bar Code Readers  
Setting Item  
Data bit length  
Stop bit length  
Parity bit  
Function  
Sets the bit length for the data bits.  
Sets the stop bit length for the data.  
Sets the parity bit for the data.  
Setting Options  
7* or 8 bits  
Page  
1 or 2* bits  
186  
None, odd, even*  
Communications Sets the communications speed for the bar code reader  
speed  
4800, 9600*, or 19200 bps 186  
Input method  
Sets the method for confirming data when it is input to a  
character string input field.  
Manual*, Auto  
186  
Manual: The data is confirmed with a touch switch. The data  
can be corrected and character strings can be added.  
Auto: The data is automatically confirmed when it is input.  
* Default (factory) setting  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function  
Section 6-10  
Setting the  
Set the bar code reader communications conditions and method of confirma-  
tion at input by following the menu operation from the System Menu shown  
below.  
Communications  
Conditions and Setting  
Method  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Memory Switch.  
Press [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) to display the fourth memory  
switch setting screen.  
Press Comm. A Method to select Bar-Code  
Reader.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Bar Code Reader Input Function  
Section 6-10  
Press the Set touch switch to the right of  
Comm. A Method.  
Display the required setting for each item  
by pressing the touch switches.  
The setting option changes each time the  
touch switch is pressed.  
Press Quit.  
• Pressing Abort on the communications condition/confirmation method  
setting screen causes the NT631/NT631C to return to the memory switch  
setting screen (4/4) without executing setting (with the previous settings  
still effective).  
On completion of communications condition/confirmation method setting, the  
NT631/NT631C returns to the memory switch setting screen (4/4).  
To set other memory switches, select the relevant screen using the [ ] (next  
screen) or [ ] (previous screen) touch switch, then make the setting.  
To confirm the settings and quit the memory switch setting screen, press  
the Quit touch switch. The settings made last will be set and the NT631/  
NT631C will return to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
To quit the memory switch setting screen without confirming the settings,  
press the Abort touch switch. The NT631/NT631C will return to the MAIN-  
TENANCE MODE MENU screen with the previous settings still in effect.  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
6-11 System Maintenance  
The NT631/NT631C has the following maintenance and check functions.  
Item  
I/O Settings  
Function  
Page  
Adjustment of display panel contrast and brightness of the backlight.  
Display and setting of the time data of the NT631/NT631C clock function.  
Calendar Check  
PT Settings  
191  
Direct connection setting of the screen data in the NT631/NT631C and display of the 193  
setting statuses of the serial ports.  
Display history record Display and printing of display history record data.  
201  
209  
Alarm history record  
Screen data check  
Display and printing of alarm history record data.  
Display of each screen stored in the NT631/NT631C.  
I/O  
Device check Checking of the I/O functions of the NT631/NT631C.  
check  
I/F check  
Checking of the communications functions of the NT631/NT631C.  
This section describes how to use these functions.  
6-11-1 I/O Settings  
This function is used to adjust the contrast of the display panel and the bright-  
ness of the backlight.  
With the NT631/631C, you can adjust the contrast and brightness settings  
using either of the following two methods.  
Setting from the System Menu  
Adjusting the contrast: Select System Menu/Maintenance Mode/I/O Settings/  
Contrast Adjust.  
Adjusting the brightness: Select System Menu/Maintenance Mode/I/O Set-  
tings/Brightness Adjust.  
Setting Using Special Screen During PT Operation  
You can set the brightness and contrast by displaying the screen with the fol-  
lowing number, using a touch switch with a switch screen function, or by spec-  
ifying the display screen in the PT status control area.  
Screen number 9030: Brightness and contrast adjustment screen.  
Contrast Adjustment (for  
NT631C-ST141@-EV1  
only)  
The NT631C-ST141@-EV1 allows the contrast to be adjusted in 100 steps.  
The CONTRAST ADJUST screen enables you to make the adjustment while  
actually checking the contrast on the screen. Once the contrast has been set,  
it remains in effect even if the power is turned OFF or the NT631/NT631C is  
reset (and even if the voltage of the built-in battery becomes low).  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Setting from the System Menu  
Adjust the contrast of the display panel by following the menu operation from  
the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Settings.  
Select Contrast Adjust.  
Adjust the contrast with the touch switches  
in the left half of the screen.  
[
[
[
[
]: Increase 10 steps  
]: Increase 1 step  
]: Decrease 1 step  
]: Decrease 10 steps  
Press Quit.  
The contrast is set and the NT631/NT631C  
returns to the I/O SETTINGS MENU screen.  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Setting Using Brightness and Contrast Adjustment Screen  
Display screen number 9030 using either a touch switch with switch screen  
function, or by specifying the display screen in the PT status control area.  
Adjust the contrast with the touch switches in  
the right half of the screen.  
[
[
[
[
]: Increase 10 steps  
]: Increase 1 step  
]: Decrease 1 step  
]: Decrease 10 steps  
Press Quit.  
The contrast is set, and the NT631/NT631C  
returns to the previous screen.  
Backlight Brightness  
Adjustment (for NT631C-  
ST141@-EV@ only)  
The NT631C-ST141@-EV@ allows the brightness of the backlight to be  
adjusted in 3 steps. The BRIGHTNESS ADJUST screen enables you to make  
the adjustment while actually checking the brightness on the screen.  
Reference:  
In the NT631C-ST153@-EV3, adjustment is not possible even though this  
screen is displayed.  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Adjust the backlight brightness by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Settings.  
Select Brightness Adjust.  
Adjust the contrast with the High, Middle, and  
Low touch switches in the left half of the  
screen.  
Press Quit.  
The contrast is set and the NT631/NT631C  
returns to the I/O SETTINGS MENU screen.  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Setting Using Brightness and Contrast Adjustment Screen  
Display screen number 9030 using either a touch switch with switch screen  
function, or by specifying the display screen in the PT status control area.  
Adjust the brightness with the touch switches  
(High, Middle, Low) in the left half of the  
screen.  
Press Quit.  
The brightness is set, and the  
NT631/NT631C returns to the previous  
screen.  
6-11-2 Displaying/Setting the Calendar and Clock  
The NT631/NT631C has a clock function for setting and displaying the date  
and time.  
This section describes how to display and set the clock data by menu opera-  
tion from the System Menu.  
Reference:  
• The clock function does not strictly check the date and day of the week  
settings. When setting the clock data, be sure to set the correct date and  
day of the week. If a mistake is made — for example entering a value in  
the range 13 to 19 when entering the month — the buzzer sounds three  
times.  
Make sure that the data is correct when the month changes.  
• Numeral memory tables 247 to 255 are reserved for the clock function.  
Clock data can be displayed and set during operation of the NT631/  
NT631C by using these numeral memory tables.  
• For details on the clock function, refer to 3-10 Display and Setting of Cal-  
endar Clock in the Reference Manual.  
• No clock data is set on shipment from the factory.  
• The clock data is backed up by the built-in battery of the NT631/NT631C.  
If the battery voltage becomes low, the clock data cannot be retained  
when the power to the NT631/NT631C is turned OFF or the NT631/  
NT631C is reset and the clock function will not operate correctly.  
• When writing to the screen data memory is disabled by the setting made  
for System Setting in the System Installer mode, it is not possible to set  
the date and time.  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Display/set clock data by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Calendar Check.  
Press Set.  
If you are just checking the display, press  
Quit at this point; the NT631/NT631C will  
return to the MAINTENANCE MODE  
MENU screen.  
Set the date.  
Each of the digits of the year, month, date,  
hour, minute, and second settings, and the  
day of the week setting, are touch switches:  
press these touch switches to change the  
corresponding settings.  
Press Quit.  
The clock data is set and the NT631/NT631C  
returns to the date and time display.  
Pressing Abort causes the NT631/NT631C to return to the date and time dis-  
play without executing setting (with the previous settings still effective).  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
6-11-3 Checking the PT Setting Status  
The direct connection settings of the NT631/NT631C screen data, and the  
settings for serial port A and serial port B, can be checked.  
Screen Configuration and  
Display Contents  
There are the following three PT setting status screens.  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
[ ] (next screen)  
[ ] (previous screen)  
Display Contents of The First Screen  
Item  
Meaning  
Screen Data Type  
PT Control Area  
The host type set for the screen data  
Word at the host to which the PT status control area is allo-  
cated  
PT Notification Area Word at the host to which the PT status notify area is allo-  
cated  
Window Control Area Word at the host to which the window control area is allocated  
Numeric Expression Default for the method of interpretation of the contents of host  
words to which numeral memory tables are allocated (numeric  
value storage method).  
Expansion I/F  
Compatibility  
Type of Unit installed at the expansion interface connector  
Sets whether or not to use NT30/620 compatible mode for  
screen data. (Sets whether to operate as a normal NT31/631  
or emulate many key NT30/620 characteristics.)  
Display Contents of The Second Screen  
Item  
Meaning  
Comm. Port A  
Comm. Method  
Comm. Setting  
Communications type set for serial port A (fixed as RS-232C)  
Communications method set for serial port A  
Communications conditions set for serial port A (display con-  
tents differ according to the communications method)  
Display Contents of The Third Screen  
Item  
Meaning  
Comm. Port B  
Communications type set for serial port B (RS-232C/RS-  
422A)  
Comm. Method  
Comm. Setting  
Communications method set for serial port B  
Communications settings set for serial port B (display con-  
tents differ according to the communications method)  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Display Method  
Display the PT setting statuses by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select PT Settings.  
Switch the screen as required by pressing  
the [] (next screen) or [] (previous  
screen) touch switch.  
Press Quit.  
The NT631/NT631C returns to the  
MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
6-11-4 Displaying and Printing the Display History Record  
The display history record function is a function that records the order of dis-  
play of each screen during operation, and the number of times each screen is  
displayed. Only the screens for which the display history screen attribute has  
been set in advance are processed by this function.  
The record data can be displayed, and printed out at a printer connected to  
the NT631/NT631C by operation from the System Menu.  
This section explains how to display and print out the display history record  
data recorded in the NT631/NT631C.  
Note that there are two display methods sort by occurrence (display time  
order) and sort by frequency (order of number of times displayed).  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Reference:  
• With the NT631/NT631C, the record data can also be displayed by calling  
screen No. 9001 (sort by occurrence) or screen No. 9002 (sort by fre-  
quency) during the RUN mode.  
• For details on the display history record function, refer to 2-15-1 Display  
History Record Function in the Reference Manual.  
The order of display for sort by occurrence display (from oldest record or  
from newest record) is set with the Hist. Disp. Method memory switch  
(page 175).  
• The printing method and other information must be set in advance with  
the Printer Controller (page 168) and Print Method (page 169) memory  
switches.  
Display and print the display history record data by following the menu opera-  
tion from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Display History.  
Select Sort by Occurrence or Sort by  
Frequency.  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
If necessary, select the next or previous  
screen by pressing [] (next screen) or  
[] (previous screen).  
The example screen to the left shows a  
display for the sort by occurrence  
method (from oldest record).  
If required, press Prt. to print the display  
history record data.  
Press Quit.  
The NT631/NT631C returns to the DISPLAY  
HISTORY MENU screen.  
Example Print-out  
All of the recorded data is printed out in the same order as on the currently  
displayed screen.  
Example:  
Sort by occurrence, from oldest record  
No. Scrn YY/MM/DD HH:MM Comment  
01/01  
1
2
3
4
1
2
8
98/01/12  
98/01/12  
98/01/13  
10:21  
11:53  
09:35  
14:22  
Coolant Error  
Motor Error  
Compressor Error  
Emergency Stop  
2000 98/01/13  
6-11-5 Displaying and Printing the Alarm History Record  
The alarm history record function is a function that continually monitors, dur-  
ing operation, the status of bits at the host designated in advance with a bit  
memory table, and records the time when these bits come ON, and the num-  
ber of times they come ON.  
The record data can be displayed, and printed out at a printer connected to  
the NT631/NT631C by operation from the System Menu.  
This section explains how to display and print out the alarm history record  
data recorded in the NT631/NT631C.  
Note that there are two display methods sort by occurrence (ON time order)  
and sort by frequency (order of number of times the bits have come ON).  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Reference:  
• With the NT631/NT631C, the record data can also be displayed by regis-  
tering an alarm history display element on the screen.  
• For details on the alarm history record function, refer to 3-8 Using the  
Alarm List/History Function of NT31, NT31C, NT631,and NT631C Refer-  
ence Manual (V064).  
The order of display for sort by occurrence display (from oldest record or  
from newest record) is set with the Hist. Disp. Method memory switch  
(page 175).  
• The printing method and other information must be set in advance with  
the Printer Controller (page 168) and Print Method (page 169) memory  
switches.  
Display and print the alarm history record data by following the menu opera-  
tion from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Alarm History.  
Select Sort by Occurrence or Sort by  
Frequency.  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
If necessary, select the next or previous  
screen by pressing [] (next screen) or  
[] (previous screen).  
The example screen to the left shows a  
display for the sort by occurrence  
method (from oldest record).  
If required, press Prt. to print the display  
history record data.  
Press Quit.  
The NT631/NT631C returns to the  
ALARM HISTORY MENU screen.  
Example Print-out  
All of the recorded data is printed out in the same order as on the currently  
displayed screen.  
Example:  
Sort by occurrence method, from oldest record  
No. Comment  
YY/MM/DD HH:MM 01/01  
1
2
3
Remote I/O Error  
98/02/06  
98/02/07  
98/02/17  
16:02  
09:21  
15:44  
PIC Unit Error  
Cycle Time Over  
6-11-6 Checking Screen Data  
The NT631/NT631C allows the registered screens (Nos. 1 to 3999) to be dis-  
played and checked by operation from the System Menu.  
Reference:  
• Window screens cannot be displayed by operation from the System  
Menu.  
• Only the user screens (Nos. 1 to 3999) can be displayed. Screens for sys-  
tem use cannot be displayed.  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Specifying The Display Method  
Specify the display method for the screens as indicated in the table below.  
Setting Item  
Function  
Setting  
Options  
Display of Lamp/  
Touch SW No.  
Allows designation of whether the bit number of the lamp bit set for a lamp or touch  
switch is displayed or not.  
ON, OFF*  
The display format is as follows L@❍❍❍❍❍❍ (@: area type, ❍❍❍❍❍❍: bit num-  
ber).  
Display of Memory Allows designation of whether the table numbers of numeral and character string  
ON, OFF*  
Table No.  
memory tables are displayed or not.  
The display format for numeral memory tables is N❍❍❍ and the display format for  
character string memory tables is S❍❍❍.  
This function is valid for the following display elements.  
- Numeral displays  
- Character string displays  
- Bar graphs  
- Numeral setting input fields (including thumbwheel type)  
- Character string input fields  
Display of image/  
Library No.  
Allows designation of whether image/library code numbers are displayed or not.  
ON, OFF*  
Display of Broken  
Line Frame  
Allows designation of whether or not broken line frames are displayed around the dis- ON, OFF*  
play elements for showing the positions registered.  
* Default (factory) setting  
Reference:  
Each setting of the screen data check is effective only on this menu. Exiting  
from this screen data check menu resets the settings to the default (all the  
settings are set to OFF).  
Operations On The SCREEN DATA CHECK Screen  
The function shown below can be set on the SCREEN DATA CHECK screen.  
Use this function as required when displaying complex screens on which mul-  
tiple display elements have been registered overlapping each other.  
a) Equivalent to 2 touch switches (14.4 mm)  
NT631 : 14.4 mm  
NT631C : 13.2 mm  
c)  
b) Equivalent to 2 touch switches (14.4 mm)  
NT631 : 14.4 mm  
NT631C : 13.2 mm  
a. Display the previous display element on the upper most portion of the  
screen in the order in which the display elements were registered (ex-  
cluding fixed display elements).  
b. Display the next display element on the upper most portion of the  
screen in the order in which the display elements were registered (ex-  
cluding fixed display elements).  
c. Return to the screen on which screens are specified.  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Displaying the SCREEN  
DATA CHECK Screen  
Display the SCREEN DATA CHECK screen by following the menu operation  
from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select Screen Data Disp.  
Specify the screen to be displayed in the  
input field in the middle of the screen.  
Each of the digits can be incremented  
or decremented by pressing the  
associated + and - keys.  
Press Set.  
Press the touch switches to specify the  
display method in each case.  
The setting option changes each time a  
touch switch is pressed.  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Press Quit to return to the screen number  
selection screen.  
Press Disp.  
Touching the top or bottom of the screen  
changes the way the display elements  
overlap each other in the order in which they  
are registered.  
In this example, the bottom portion of the  
touch switch, which is under the lamp, will be  
displayed over the lamp.  
When you have finished checking the screen,  
press the central part of the screen to return  
to the screen number selection screen.  
If you wish to continue by checking another screen, repeat the operation,  
starting by specifying the screen number.  
To end the operation, press Quit on the screen number selection screen. The  
NT631/NT631C returns to the MAINTENANCE MODE MENU screen.  
6-11-7 Device Check  
The NT631/NT631C provides checks on the functions of the following items.  
• Buzzer  
page 202  
page 203  
page 204  
page 204  
page 205  
page 207  
page 208  
• LED  
• LCD  
• Backlight  
• Screen data memory  
Touch switches  
• Battery voltage  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Checking the Buzzer  
Check if the buzzer sounds correctly.  
Reference:  
The buzzer will sound in this check regardless of the setting made with the  
Buzzer Sound memory switch.  
Check the buzzer by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select Buzzer Check.  
• If the buzzer functions correctly, it will sound continuously. At this time, the  
Buzzer Check touch switch will be displayed in reverse video.  
To stop the buzzer while it is sounding, press the Buzzer Check touch  
switch again.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Checking the RUN LED  
Check if the RUN LED functions normally.  
Check the RUN LED by following the menu operation from the System Menu  
shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select LED Check.  
• If the RUN LED is functioning normally, it will operate as follows. At this  
time the LED Check touch switch will be displayed in reverse video.  
Lit in green - OFF - lit in red - OFF - lit in green...  
To end the LED check, press the LED Check touch switch on the DEVICE  
CHECK MENU screen again.  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Checking the LCD (Screen  
Display)  
Check if the LCD display (or EL display for NT631) functions normally by fol-  
lowing the menu operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select LCD Check.  
• The check screen displays all the dots on the screen: either press any-  
where on the touch panel or wait for three seconds and all the dots will be  
cleared.  
With the NT631C, the display and clearance of all the dots on the  
screen is repeated for each color in turn (red green blue magenta cyan  
yellow white black).  
On completion of the display and clearance of all dots, the NT631/  
NT631C returns to the DEVICE CHECK MENU screen.  
Touch the touch panel to discontinue the LCD check. Even if 3 seconds  
have not passed, the check will proceed to the next color.  
Checking the Backlight  
(for NT631C only)  
Check if the backlight functions normally with the NT631C by following the  
menu operation from the System Menu shown below. This function is not  
available with the NT631.  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select Backlight Check.  
• If the backlight is normal, it flashes. At this time, the Backlight Check  
touch switch is displayed in reverse video.  
To end the backlight check, press the Backlight Check touch switch again.  
Screen Data Memory  
Check  
Check if the screen data memory is functioning normally.  
Reference:  
• In the screen data memory check, a write test is performed on the screen  
data memory. Since all the screen data in the NT631/NT631C is lost in  
this check, confirm that this data is backed up at the Support Tool or  
Memory Unit before executing it.  
• If writing to the screen data memory is disabled by the setting for System  
Settings in the System Installer mode, it is not possible to execute a  
screen data check.  
• Once a screen data check has been started, it cannot be stopped.  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Check the screen data memory by following the menu operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select Screen Memory.  
Press Execute.  
• During the check, the message Checking Now... is displayed.  
• On normal completion of the check, the message Memory Check OK is  
displayed.  
• If an error is discovered in the check, the message Memory Check NG is  
displayed.  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
After confirming the result of the check, press Quit. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the DEVICE CHECK MENU screen.  
Checking Touch Switches  
Check whether or not the touch switches function normally by following the  
menu operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select Touch Switch.  
Press the touch switches displayed on  
the screen. A touch switch is normal if it  
is displayed in reverse video while  
pressed.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
To end the check, press the touch switch at the top right corner (NT631: dis-  
played in reverse video; NT631C: displayed in yellow). The NT631/NT631C  
will return to the DEVICE CHECK MENU.  
Reference:  
• The host is not notified of the operation of touch switches pressed during  
the I/O check.  
• The check cannot be performed until the touch switch at the top right cor-  
ner is displayed in reverse video (for NT631) or displayed in yellow  
(NT631C). Start the check after the status of the touch switch at the top  
right corner has changed.  
Checking the Battery  
Voltage  
Check the voltage of the NT631/NT631C’s built-in battery by following the  
menu operation from the System Menu shown below.  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Ver 4.12  
Select I/O Check.  
Select Device Check.  
Select Battery.  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
The voltage is within the normal range. or  
The voltage is lowered. is displayed.  
After confirming the result of the check, press Quit. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the DEVICE CHECK MENU screen.  
When The voltage is lowered is displayed, replace the built-in battery immedi-  
ately. For details on the replacement method, refer to 7-3-1 Replacing the Bat-  
tery (page 241).  
6-11-8 Checking Interfaces  
The NT631/NT631C allows the following communications functions to be  
checked.  
• Communications with the Support Tool page 209  
• Communications at serial ports  
• Communications with printers  
page 210  
page 213  
Checking  
Communications with the  
Support Tool  
Check communications with the Support Tool by following the menu operation  
from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select I/F Check.  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Select Tool Comm..  
The check on communications with the  
Support Tool starts.  
If communications with the Support Tool is normal, data transmitted from the  
Support Tool is displayed as hexadecimal data when received by the NT631/  
NT631C.  
After confirming the result of the test, press Quit. The NT631/NT631C returns  
to the I/F CHECK MENU screen.  
Checking  
Communications at Serial  
Ports  
Check communications at the serial ports (A, B).  
Check Screen  
The check screen and check method differ according to the communications  
method set for the port to be checked.  
For Host Link  
Example: Serial port A while using the host link  
Press Execute to start the check. The data for checking communications is  
sent to the host, and is displayed as the Sending Data in hexadecimal.  
• If communications with the host are normal, the reply from the host is dis-  
played at Received Data in hexadecimal.  
• If a communications error occurs while checking the communications con-  
ditions with the host, a communications error screen is displayed. Since  
this indicates that there is a communications fault, check the communica-  
tions cables and settings.  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
For NT Link (1:1, 1:N Standard, or 1:N High-speed)  
Example: Serial port B while using the NT Link (1:N)  
Press Execute to start the check. The data for checking communications is  
sent to the host, and is displayed as ∗∗ symbols at Sending Data.  
• If communications with the host are normal, the reply from the host is dis-  
played at Received Data as ∗∗ symbols.  
• If a communications error occurs while checking the communications con-  
ditions with the host, a communications error screen is displayed. Since  
this indicates that there is a communications fault, check the communica-  
tions cables and settings.  
For Memory Link  
Example: Serial port A while using the memory link  
The check is started as soon as the check screen is displayed. Send the com-  
mand from the host.  
• If communications with the host are normal, the data received from the  
host is displayed in hexadecimal text code at Received Data.  
• If nothing is displayed at Received Data when the command is sent from  
the host, there is a communications fault: check the communications  
cables and settings.  
For a Bar Code Reader  
The check starts when the check screen is displayed. Read data with the bar  
code reader in this status.  
• If communications with the bar code reader are normal, the read charac-  
ter strings are displayed in hexadecimal text code at Received Data.  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
• If nothing is displayed at Received Data when data is read with the bar  
code reader, there is a communications fault: check the communications  
cables and settings.  
Check Method  
Check communications with the serial ports by following the menu operation  
from the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select I/F Check.  
Select Comm. Port A or Comm. Port B.  
The check screen is displayed (Check  
screen, page 210).  
After confirming the result of the check, press Quit. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the I/F CHECK MENU screen.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Maintenance  
Section 6-11  
Checking  
Communications with a  
Printer  
Check communications with a printer by following the menu operation from  
the System Menu shown below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Maintenance Mode.  
Select I/O Check.  
Select I/F Check.  
Select Printer.  
Confirm that a printer is connected to the  
NT631/NT631C, then press Execute:  
Printer Interface Check will be printed out  
at the printer.  
• While data is being sent to the printer, the message Checking Now... is  
displayed.  
• When the sending of data to the printer is completed, Finished Normal by  
Printer Interface Check is displayed.  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
• If data does not reach the printer within 60 seconds after sending starts,  
the message ‘Finished Printer output failed’ is displayed.  
After confirming the result of the check, press Quit. The NT631/NT631C  
returns to the I/F CHECK MENU screen.  
6-12 Programming Console Function  
The NT631/NT631C has been equipped with the Programming Console func-  
tion, which allows it to be used like a C200H-PRO27-E Programming Console  
for CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CS/CJ-  
series PLC, or SRM1 PLCs.  
Except for recording (saving) ladder programs on cassette tape and replaying  
(reading) them, almost all the functions of a Programming Console can be  
executed.  
Note  
When the programmable controller functions are used, carefully check that  
the system is safe before carrying out the following operations.  
• Changing monitor data  
• Switching the operating mode  
• Forced set or reset  
• Changing a present value or set value  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
6-12-1 Usable Systems  
The Programming Console function can be used with an NT631/NT631C con-  
nected to a PLC when using the communications method indicated below.  
Communica-  
tions Method  
Applicable PLCs  
Connected Port  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E(*1)  
NT Link (1:1)  
CPU Unit’s built-in  
RS-232C port  
C200HG-CPU43/63-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU44/64-(Z)E(*1)  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE(*1)  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE(*1)  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@(*1)  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@(*1)  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@(*1)  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@(*2)  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@(*2)  
CQM1-CPU4@-EV1(*1)  
CQM1H-CPU21/51/61(*1)  
SRM1-C02-V2  
Peripheral port (*3)  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
NT Link (1:N)  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-EV1  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-EV1  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU66H/67H  
CPU Unit’s built-in  
RS-232C port  
Peripheral port (*4)  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
*1 The peripheral port Programming Console always has priority. If a Pro-  
gramming Console is connected later, the Programming Console function  
of the NT631/NT631C is invalidated and operation from the NT631/  
NT631C becomes impossible.  
*2 The CPM2C-CN111 Connecting Cable splits the PLC’s Communications  
Port into a RS-232C port and a peripheral port.  
*3 An RS-232C cable cannot be connected to the peripheral port. An RS-  
232C adapter (CPM1-CIF01) is required.  
*4 The RS-232C cable cannot be directly connected to the peripheral port. An  
RS-232C converting cable (CS1W-CN118) is required.  
Reference:  
Note that the Programming Console function cannot be used with CPM1,  
CQM1, and C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E PLCs of the following lot numbers.  
CPM1: @@@5, @@*6  
where * is a number in the range 1 to 9 or the letter X or Y.  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
CQM1: @@@3, @@@4, @@@5, @@*6  
where * is a number in the range 1 to 9 or the letter X or Y.  
C200HX/HG/HE: @@@5 @@*6  
where * is a number in the range 1 to 9 or the letter X or Y.  
6-12-2 Connection Method  
CQM1, CQM1H, C200HX/  
HG/HE(-Z)E, or SRM1  
SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SECTION 5  
Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on connecting  
to the PLC.  
* When using the Programming Console function with a CQM1H, turn ON pin  
7 of the DIP switch on the front of the CQM1H’s CPU Unit.  
CPM1 or CPM2A  
The connection method is the same as for the NT Link (1:1). With a CPM1,  
Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SEC-  
TION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on con-  
necting to the PLC.  
CPM2C  
The connection method is the same as for the NT Link (1:1). Connect to the  
PLC’s communications connector with a CPM2C-CN111 or CS1W-CN114/  
Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SEC-  
TION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on con-  
necting to the PLC.  
* When using the Programming Console function with a CPM2C, turn ON pin  
2 of the DIP switch on the front of the CPM2C’s CPU Unit.  
CS/CJ-series PLC  
or high-speed). Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-  
232C Port or SECTION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port  
for details on connecting to the PLC. The standard or high-speed 1:N NT Link  
can be used.  
The Programming Console function can be used only when the PT’s unit num-  
ber is set to 0. Only one Unit using the Programming Console function can be  
connected to each of the PLC’s ports (built-in RS-232C port and peripheral  
port).  
Make sure that the PT’s highest unit number is set to 0 in the CS/CJ-series  
PLC setup.  
With the CS/CJ-series PLC, the Programming Console function can not be  
used simultaneously at both the built-in RS-232C port and peripheral port.  
Furthermore, the Programming Console function can not be started at the  
RS-232C port while a Programming Console is connected to the peripheral  
port.  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
6-12-3 Method of Use  
The Programming Console screen is displayed by operating the system menu  
as described below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Expansion Mode.  
Select Programming Console.  
The Programming Console screen is  
displayed.  
Press the Programming Console sheet  
keys (touch switches) for the operation.  
Press the Quit touch switch to exit the  
screen.  
An error is displayed if a wrong  
communications protocol is selected  
or a Programming Console is  
connected to the peripheral port.(*1)  
*1 With the CS1G/CS1H, the Programming Console function can not be used  
simultaneously at both the built-in RS-232C port and peripheral port.  
Reference:  
If an error screen is displayed, the System Menu can be displayed from the  
error screen by pressing two of the four corners of the touch panel  
simultaneously. Pressing the OK touch switch on the error screen will return  
the display to that immediately before the error occurred, but only if the cause  
of the error is removed. If this does not happen, press two of the four corners  
of the touch panel to display the System Menu.  
Key Operations  
Mode Selection Keys, Mode Lock Key  
The display element on the Programming Console screen shown below com-  
prises the mode selection keys, which change the operation mode of the PLC,  
and the mode lock key, which prevents unintended mode changes.  
Mode selection keys  
Mode lock key  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
The RUN, MONITOR, and PROGRAM mode selection key elements are  
touch switches and pressing them causes the PLC operation mode to change  
(unlike an actual Programming Console, it is possible to switch directly  
between the RUN mode and the PROGRAM mode.)  
When the Programming Console function is started, the PLC operation status  
is read and reflected at the PLC.  
The mode lock key element is also a touch switch, and it alternates between  
the lock ON (with no key displayed) and lock OFF (with key displayed) states  
when pressed. During the lock ON state, mode selection key operations are  
ineffective. The mode displays change as indicated in the figures below during  
the lock ON status and during the lock OFF status.  
When the Programming Console function starts, the lock ON status is estab-  
lished.  
If the RUN, MONITOR, or PROGRAM mode selection key is pressed in the  
lock OFF status, the mode changes and the lock ON status is established.  
During Lock OFF  
RUN mode  
MONITOR mode  
PROGRAM mode  
During Lock ON  
RUN mode  
MONITOR mode  
PROGRAM mode  
Programming Console Keyboard  
The Programming Console keyboard used on the screen when the Program-  
ming Console function is used is comprised entirely of touch switches (shown  
by the dashed line frames in the figure below). On pressing a touch switch, a  
key operation is executed. However, since there is a discrepancy between the  
size of the displayed keys and the size of the touch switches, take care to  
press as close to the center of the key as possible by referring to the figure  
below.  
In addition, if the connected host is the CS1G/CS1H, the Programming Con-  
sole key sheet for the CS-series is automatically displayed.  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming Console Function  
Section 6-12  
Standard Programming Console Key Sheet  
Programming Console Key Sheet for CS1 Series  
Differences with Respect  
to Programming Consoles  
• Programs cannot be stored (recorded) or read (replayed). If it is neces-  
sary to store or read a program, use a Programming Device.  
• It is not possible to adjust the volume of the key press sound. Whether or  
not the key press sound sounds is determined by the setting for the Key  
Press Sound memory switch of the NT631/NT631C. It sounds when the  
setting is ON and does not when the setting is OFF (page 166).  
• If an error occurs when using the Programming Console function, an error  
screen is displayed. Whether or not the buzzer sounds at this time is  
determined by the setting for the Buzzer Sound memory switch of the  
NT631/NT631C (page 166).  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Device Monitor Function  
Section 6-13  
Reference:  
A communications error will occur if you use the Programming Console  
function to change the communications settings (in the PLC Setup) that  
govern the port to which the NT631/NT631C is connected. In this case, the  
Programming Console function will be unusable.  
6-13 Device Monitor Function  
The NT31/NT31C has been equipped with the Device Monitor function which  
can be used to change the PLC’s operating mode, read/change words in the  
PLC’s data areas, and display the PLC’s error log of a CS/CJ-series PLC,  
CPM1, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, or SRM1.  
The Device Monitor can perform the following operations:  
• Changing the PLC’s operating mode  
• Displaying/changing the contents of words, displaying/changing the status  
of bits, force-setting/force-resetting the status of bits (Registration Moni-  
tor)  
• Listing the contents of a range of words (Continuous Monitor)  
• Displaying the error log and clearing errors (Error Log)  
This section provides an overview of the Device Monitor function and explains  
how to connect to the PLC. For more details, refer to 2-16 Device Monitor  
Function in the Reference Manual.  
!Caution Be sure that it is safe to proceed before using the Device Monitor function to  
perform one of the following operations from the PT.  
Changing monitored data  
Switching the PLC’s operating mode  
Force setting or force resetting bits  
Changing PVs or SVs  
Reference:  
• The Device Monitor function can be used with Ver. 3.0 and higher ver-  
sions of the PT system program only.  
• The Device Monitor functions are almost identical to the functions of the  
Data Access Console (DAC).  
• The Device Monitor function cannot be used with host link or memory link  
communications.  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Device Monitor Function  
Section 6-13  
6-13-1 Compatible Systems  
The following table shows the combinations of communications methods and  
PLCs that can support the PT’s Device Monitor function.  
Communications  
method  
PLC model  
1:1 NT Link  
C200HS-CPU21/23/31/33  
C200HE-CPU32/42 (-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63 (-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64 (-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
CPM1-10CDR-@*1  
CPM1-20CDR-@*1  
CPM1A-10CD@-@*1  
CPM1A-20CD@-@*1  
CPM1A-30CD@-@*1  
CPM1A-40CD@-@*1  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@*2  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@*2  
CQM1-CPU4@-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU21/51/61  
SRM1-C02-V2  
1:N NT Link  
C200HE-CPU32/42 (-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33/43/53/63 (-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34/44/54/64 (-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
CQM1H-CPU21/51/61  
SRM1-C02-V2  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
*1 A CPM1-CIF01 RS-232C Adapter is required.  
*2 Use a Conversion Cable (CPM2C-CN111 or CS1W-CN114/118), CPM1-  
CIF01 RS-232C Adapter, or CPM1-CIF11 RS-422A Adapter to connect to  
the PLC.  
6-13-2 Connection Method  
CQM1H or C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z)E  
exactly the same as for the 1:1 NT Link or 1:N NT Link. Refer to SECTION 4  
Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SECTION 5 Connecting to  
the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on connecting to the PLC.  
CQM1 or C200HS  
for the 1:1 NT Link. Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-  
232C Port or SECTION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port  
for details on connecting to the PLC.  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Device Monitor Function  
Section 6-13  
CPM1, CPM2A, or SRM1  
The 1:1 NT Link can be used in all CPU Units and the 1:N NT Link can also be  
used in -V2 and higher versions of the SRM1. The connection method is  
exactly the same as for the 1:1 NT Link or 1:N NT Link. With a CPM1, connect  
Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SEC-  
TION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on con-  
necting to the PLC.  
CPM2C  
The 1:1 NT Link can be used. The connection method is the same as for the  
NT Link (1:1). Connect to the PLC’s communications connector with a  
Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SEC-  
TION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on con-  
necting to the PLC.  
CS/CJ-series PLC  
Refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port or SEC-  
TION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port for details on con-  
necting to the PLC.  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Version Display  
Section 6-14  
6-13-3 Method of Use  
The Device Monitor screen is displayed by operating the system menu as  
described below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Expansion Mode.  
Select Device Monitor.  
An error message will be displayed if  
the wrong communications protocol is  
selected.  
The Device Monitor screen is displayed.  
Reference:  
If an error screen is displayed, the System Menu can be displayed from the  
error screen by pressing two of the four corners of the touch panel  
simultaneously. Pressing the OK touch switch on the error screen will return  
the display to that immediately before the error occurred, but only if the cause  
of the error is removed. If this does not happen, press two of the four corners  
of the touch panel to display the System Menu.  
For more details on operations of the Device Monitor function, refer to 2-16  
Device Monitor Function in the Reference Manual.  
6-14 Version Display  
Use the Version Display function to check the version of the NT631/NT631C’s  
system program. The Version Display screen shows the model, creation date,  
and version of the system program installed in the NT631/NT631C.  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Version Display  
Section 6-14  
6-14-1 Method of Use  
The Version Display screen is displayed by operating the system menu as  
described below.  
Ver 4.12  
Select Expansion Mode.  
Select Version Display.  
The system program's version information  
will be displayed as described below. Press  
the Quit touch switch to exit the Version  
Display screen and return to the Expansion  
Mode screen.  
PT Model:  
PT model number  
System program: System program name  
Version  
System program version  
Date program was created.  
Date  
This screen is an example. Actual screens  
will show the information specific to the PT  
and system program being used.  
After checking the version information, press the Quit touch switch to exit the  
Version Display screen and return to the Expansion Mode screen.  
Reference:  
• The PT model always shows the model number of the ivory model of the  
PT. The B suffix will not be displayed, even for black models.  
• The system program’s version number is also displayed in the upper-right  
corner of the System Menu.  
• The creation date does not always match the file date of the system pro-  
gram installed with the System Installer.  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SECTION 7  
Troubleshooting and Maintenance  
This section describes the action to take when NT631/NT631C errors occur, and how to carry out maintenance and  
7-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-2 Responding to Displayed Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-2-1 Errors Occurring at Start of Operation and Their Remedies . . . . . .  
7-2-2 Errors Occurring during Operation and Their Remedies. . . . . . . . .  
7-2-3 Errors Occurring on Screen Data Initialization and Transmission .  
7-2-4 Errors in the System Installer Mode and Their Remedies . . . . . . . .  
7-2-5 Communications Errors and Their Remedies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-3 Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-3-1 Replacing the Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
7-4 Inspection and Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
226  
229  
229  
231  
232  
232  
233  
235  
241  
242  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Section 7-1  
7-1 Troubleshooting  
When a fault relating to the operation of the NT631/NT631C occurs, find the  
symptoms in the table below and respond by following the corresponding  
Remedy indicated in the table.  
Note  
1. Confirm system safety before turning the power ON/OFF or resetting.  
2. Do not disassemble the PT for repair or modification.  
NT631/NT631C  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
Power LED fails to come  
ON  
Power is not being supplied.  
Check the connections and make sure that power is  
supplied correctly. (3-1-3 Power Supply Connection,  
page 33)  
Power supply fuse has blown.  
Contact your OMRON service center.  
Nothing is displayed on the Screen No. 0 has been read at the  
screen. host side.  
This is not an error. Change the screen number from  
screen number 0. (Setting the screen number to 0  
turns the screen off.)  
The system startup waiting time has This is not an error. The display will appear after the  
not elapsed yet.  
Cannot communicate with The Transmit mode has not been  
Display the System Menu and select the Transmit  
the Support Tool  
established.  
Not connected to the Support Tool.  
Check the installation of the connector cable. (3-2  
Connecting to the Support Tool)  
The PT model setting and direct con- Using the PT Configuration settings of the Support  
nection setting at the Support Tool do Tool, set the PT model and direct connection settings  
not match the NT631/NT631C.  
that match the NT631/NT631C.  
Cannot communicate with Memory switch settings do not match. Check the communications setting in the Memory  
the host  
NT631/NT631C. (6-7 Setting Conditions for Commu-  
nications with Host by Using Memory Switches)  
Cannot switch from the  
system initializing screen.  
Communications error  
message is displayed  
when communicating to  
the host.  
rectly connected.  
4 Connecting to the Host from the RS-232C Port, and  
SECTION 5 Connecting to the Host from the RS-  
422A/485 Port)  
In an RS-422A/485 connection, the  
terminator setting is incorrect.  
the Host from the RS-232C Port, and SECTION 5  
In an NT link (1:N) connection, there Make the settings again so that there is no duplica-  
is duplication in the unit numbers.  
tion. (6-7-4 Setting the NT Link (1:N) Method (Stan-  
dard/High-speed), page 158)  
The power to the NT631/NT631C, NT- Check the power supply.  
AL001 or host is OFF.  
The buzzer has sounded  
and the RUN LED is OFF.  
Malfunction due to external noise  
Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
The NT631/NT631 has developed  
trouble.  
Contact your OMRON service center.  
The touch panel does not Malfunction due to external noise  
respond.  
Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
The touch panel is broken.  
Test the touch panel with I/O Check in the MAINTE-  
NANCE MODE menu. If there is an error, contact  
your OMRON service center.  
The PLC mode has  
changed to the monitor  
mode.  
The NT631/NT631C changes the  
mode when Host Link communica-  
tions are used.  
This is an NT631/NT631C specification. When using  
a PLC that can also be connected using the NT link  
method, use an NT link connection (there is no mode  
change with the NT link method).  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
Section 7-1  
NT631/NT631C  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
The graph display does not One of the percentage display set-  
Set the 100%, 0%, and 100% values in the following  
relationship:  
100% value < 0% value < 100% value  
change.  
tings — 100%, 0%, or 100% — is  
incorrect.  
The trend graph display  
does not agree with the  
actual time axis.  
The cycle for graph display update  
processing is longer than the set  
sampling cycle.  
Delete other elements on the same screen as the  
trend graph that are allocated to the host and have a  
high update frequency. Or lengthen the sampling  
cycle.  
The Programming Console The communications settings are  
Set the communications method as follows when  
using the Programming Console function.  
function cannot be used.  
incorrect.  
• With C-series PLC: 1:1 NT Link  
• With CS/CJ-series PLC:  
1:N NT Link (standard or high-speed)  
A Programming Console is con-  
nected.  
It is not possible to use a Programming Console and  
the Programming Console function at the same time.  
Disconnect the Programming Console.  
The PLC does not support the Pro-  
gramming Console function.  
Not all PLCs support the Programming Console func-  
tion. Check the model of PLC you are using. (6-12  
Programming Console Function)  
The system program for other ven-  
The Programming Console function can be used only  
dor’s PLCs has been installed. (PLC when the system program for OMRON PLCs is  
models other than OMRON.) installed. Install the correct system program.  
The Device Monitor func- The communications settings are not Set the communications method as follows when  
tion cannot be used.  
correct.  
using the Device Monitor function.  
• With C-series PLCs: 1:1 NT Link or 1:N NT Link  
• With CS/CJ-series PLCs:  
1:N NT Link (standard or high-speed)  
The PLC does not support the Device Not all PLCs support the Device Monitor function.  
Monitor function.  
Check the model of PLC you are using. Refer to 6-13  
Device Monitor Function for details.  
The system program installed in the  
PT is for a PLC maker other than  
OMRON.  
The Device Monitor function can be used only when  
the PT is connected to a PT with the system program  
for OMRON PLCs installed. Install a system program  
that supports the Device Monitor function.  
The memory table display Since the memory table is allocated  
contents differ from the ini- to the host memory, the display is  
When the contents of the memory table are set as a  
fixed value, do not allocate the memory table to the  
tial value set at the Sup-  
port Tool.  
updated in accordance with the con- host.  
tents of the host memory.  
The battery voltage has dropped and Replace the battery and execute memory table initial-  
the data in the memory table has  
been destroyed.  
ization. (7-3-1 Replacing the Battery, page 241, and  
Since ON is set for the resume func- Execute memory table initialization. (6-4-5 Initializing  
tion, the initial values of the screen  
data memory are not written to the  
memory tables.  
the Memory Tables, page 141)  
the NT631/NT631C with the resume function OFF.  
(6-9-10 Setting the Resume Function, page 177)  
The numeral memory table is speci- Calculations are executed continuously while the PT  
fied as the destination for a mathe-  
matical table’s results.  
is operating and the calculation results are automati-  
cally written to the memory table. Specify another  
numeral memory table or a word in the host.  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Section 7-1  
NT631/NT631C  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
Updating of numeric val-  
ues and text is delayed.  
Malfunction due to external noise  
Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
There are too many numeral/text dis- Reduce the number of numeral/text displays on the  
plays on the displayed screen.  
screen for which updating is delayed.  
The cycle time is extended due to  
heavy processing at the host.  
Shorten the host cycle time.  
In an RS-422A/485 connection, there Wire correctly by referring to SECTION 5 Connecting  
is illegal branching or an erroneous  
terminator setting.  
to the Host from the RS-422A/485 Port.  
Some of the elements  
arranged on a normal  
screen are not displayed.  
The quantity of read data exceeds the Check the maximum number of elements by referring  
stipulated restriction.  
to Display Restrictions in Appendix A of the Refer-  
ence Manual, creating the screen data again, and  
transmitting all of the screen data in a batch to the  
NT631/NT631C.  
The total of the element coefficients  
for the displayed screen is greater  
than 1024.  
On an overlapping screen, Since the data is transmitted from the Check the maximum number of elements by referring  
some of the set elements host in screen units, the number of  
are not displayed. elements on the overlapping screen  
to Display Restrictions in Appendix A of the Refer-  
ence Manual, creating the screen data again, and  
has exceeded the maximum permis- then sending all the screen data in a batch to the  
sible without being checked by the  
Support Tool.  
NT631/NT631C.  
The System Menu cannot Display System Menu under Change In the System Installer mode, set Display System  
be called up.  
System Settings in the System  
Installer mode is set to Disabled.  
Menu to Enabled (page 147).  
The following System  
Menu operations are not  
possible.  
Screen Memory Protect under  
Change System Setting in the Sys-  
tem Installer mode is set to Disabled.  
In the System Installer mode, set Screen Memory  
Protect to Enabled (page 147).  
- Establishing the Transmit  
mode  
Screen Memory Protect has been set Do not turn the PT power OFF during deletion of  
to Disabled because the PT power screen data.  
supply was turned OFF during dele- In the System Installer mode, first change the setting  
- Displaying the memory  
switch setting screens  
tion of screen data.  
for Screen Memory Protect to Enabled, then repeat  
the screen data delete operation (page 148)  
- Screen data memory  
check  
- Displaying the initializa-  
tion menu  
- Displaying the calendar/  
time setting screen  
Cannot input numeric val- The upper/lower (max./min.) limit  
Check the screen data’s upper/lower (max./min.) limit  
check setting for numeric value input, and correct it if  
necessary. Refer to 2-12 Inputting Numeric Values in  
the Reference Manual for details.  
ues  
check for numeric value input is in  
effect.  
The display is too faint.  
The contrast is too high.  
Reduce the contrast (page 187).  
Cannot input numeric val- Bit 5 of the PT status control area  
Set bit 5 to 0 (OFF). Refer to 2-2-1 PT Status Control  
ues/character strings.  
(numeral/character string input) is set Area (Host PT) in the Reference Manual for  
to 1 (ON).  
details.  
The interlock function is set for the  
Inputs are prohibited in input fields when the corre-  
input field and the controlling interlock sponding interlock bit is OFF. Check the status of the  
bit is OFF. corresponding interlock bit and turn it ON.  
Window screen does not  
open  
Bit 6 of the PT status control area (PT Set bit 6 to 0 (OFF). Refer to 2-2-1 PT Status Control  
window opening) is set to 1 (ON).  
Area (Host PT) in the Reference Manual for  
details.  
Cannot switch screens  
with touch switches  
Bit 4 of the PT status control area (PT Set bit 4 to 0 (OFF). Refer to 2-2-1 PT Status Control  
screen switching) is set to 1 (ON).  
Area (Host PT) in the Reference Manual for  
details.  
Touch switch does not  
work. (Buzzer sounds.)  
The interlock function is set for the  
touch switch and the controlling inter- interlock bit is OFF. Check the status of the corre-  
lock bit is OFF. sponding interlock bit and turn it ON.  
Touch switches are disabled when the corresponding  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
NT631/NT631C  
Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
The display is dim.  
Insufficient contrast or brightness  
Increase the contrast/brightness (pages 187 and  
189).  
Backlight defective, or its life has  
expired  
Replace the backlight (page 235).  
The display is too faint.  
The contrast is too high.  
Reduce the contrast (page 187).  
The digits in numeral dis- The number of digits of a numeric  
• Confirm the values of the PLC words allocated to  
the numeral memory table.  
• Allocate one PLC word to each numeral memory  
table.  
play come out as *.  
value in a numeral memory table  
exceeds the set number.  
7-2 Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
When the NT631/NT631C displays an error message, find the corresponding  
symptoms in the appropriate table below and respond by following the Rem-  
edy indicated in the table.  
For details of the error messages displayed when using Memory Unit and cor-  
rective action to take for them, refer to 3-5 Using a Memory Unit.  
7-2-1 Errors Occurring at Start of Operation and Their Remedies  
The table below shows the errors that can occur when the power to the  
NT631/NT631C is turned ON and when operation starts, and their remedies.  
Message  
[No Comm. Protocol]  
Cause  
Remedy  
No communications protocol has Using the memory switches, set the com-  
been set.  
Conditions for Communications with Host  
by Using Memory Switches)  
Set the comm. Protocol by MAINTE-  
NANCE MODE.  
Communications protocol and  
screen data type are mismatched  
[Screen Data Error]  
- The power was switched OFF  
during screen data initialization, ation at the System Menu, then re-transmit  
checking, or transmission.  
Screen Data corrupted.  
the screen data. (6-4-1 Clearing Screen  
Data, page 135)  
Initialize Screen Memory, and download  
Screen Data again.  
- Transmission of screen data  
was interrupted.  
If the problem persists, contact your  
OMRON service center.  
- Illegal data has been written to  
the screen data memory.  
[No Screen Data]  
No screen data is registered.  
Transmit screen data from the Support  
Tool.  
No Screen Data is saved in Screen Mem-  
ory.  
Download Screen Data using by the Sup-  
port Tool.  
Then set the PT to the TRANSMIT  
MODE, and download Screen Data  
again.  
[No Direct Connection Info.]  
Allocated words have not been set Allocate words for the PT status control  
for the PT status control area and area and PT status notify area with the  
No Direct Connection Information is set  
in Screen Data.  
PT status notify area.  
Support Tool and then transmit the direct  
connection information to the NT631/  
NT631C.  
Set Direct Connecting Information in  
Screen Data using by the Support Tool.  
Then set the PT to the TRANSMIT  
MODE and download Screen Data again.  
[Incorrect Screen Data]  
The type of registered screen data Initialize the screen data memory, then  
does not match that at the NT631/ transmit the correct screen data. (6-4-1  
Screen Data in Screen Memory do not  
match with the System Program.  
NT631C.  
Clearing Screen Data, page 135)  
Initialize Screen Memory, and download  
Screen Data again.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
[No Starting Screen]  
No data is registered for either the Either specify a screen number for which  
screen number set in the PT sta- data is registered at the PT status control  
Specified Starting Screen is not saved.  
tus control area or the Initial  
area, or set the screen as the Initial  
Fix Screen Data using by the Support  
Tool.  
Screen set with the Support Tool. Screen in the System settings under PT  
Or the screen number which does Configuration at the Support Tool.  
not exist are registered.  
Then set the PT to the TRANSMIT  
MODE and download Screen Data again.  
[Touch Panel is disconnected]  
The touch panel cable (film cable) If this message appears after the backlight  
inside the NT631/NT631C is dis- is replaced, reinstall the touch panel prop-  
connected.  
erly referring to Replacing the Backlight  
(page 236). If the message keeps appear-  
ing, contact your OMRON service center.  
[Memory Switch Corrupted]  
The memory switches have been Set the memory switches again using the  
initialized due to discovery of an  
error in the memory switch set-  
tings.  
under PT Configuration at the Support  
Tool. (SECTION 6 System Menu Opera-  
tion)  
Because Memory Switch setting was  
last. Initialized Memory Switch setting.  
Press Confirm to return to the SYSTEM  
MENU.  
If the problem recurs, contact your  
OMRON service center.  
[Calendar Data Error]  
There is an error in the date/time Check the battery voltage by checking the  
values due, for example, to low  
battery voltage.  
color of the RUN LED and with the battery  
check in the System Menu; if the voltage is  
(Checking the Battery Voltage, page 208,  
and 7-3-1 Replacing the Battery,  
page 241)  
Calendar Data is incorrect.  
Set to the MAINTENANCE MODE and  
set Calendar Data.  
If the battery voltage is confirmed to be  
from the System Menu. (6-11-2 Display-  
ing/Setting the Calendar and Clock,  
page 191)  
[Backup Data Error]  
Initialization has been executed  
because of an error in the backup color of the RUN LED and with the battery  
data area.  
Check the battery voltage by checking the  
Memory table and History data was ini-  
tialized by backup failure.  
check in the System Menu; if the voltage is  
(Checking the Battery Voltage, page 208,  
and 7-3-1 Replacing the Battery,  
page 241)  
It can be caused by lowered voltage of  
the battery.  
The re-transmit the memory table data  
from the Support Tool.  
If the voltage is normal and the problem  
[With memory switch setting screen]  
Invalid Comm. Method  
Protocol settings for serial port A Refer to Possible Combinations of Com-  
and serial port B are mismatched. munications Method Settings on page 154  
and set the protocol of serial port A and  
serial port B so that their settings are  
matched.  
* Set serial port A to None when connect-  
ing the Support Tool and the host at the  
same time.  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
7-2-2 Errors Occurring during Operation and Their Remedies  
The table below shows the errors that can occur during operation of the  
NT631/NT631C and their remedies.  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
[Address Setting Error]  
The host side allocated words and Set correct words and bits after checking the area  
bits set with the Support Tool are used at the host side by referring to PLC Memory  
Addressing Error exists in the  
Screen.  
incorrect.  
Map in Appendix D of the Reference Manual or  
the Operating Manual for the PLC being used.  
Correct address setting by the  
Support Tool.  
[Memory Table No. Error]  
The memory table number set  
with the Support Tool is outside  
the range for the number of mem- the Support Tool, or set the memory table number  
ory tables set in the system mem- again within the established range.  
ory.  
Either increase the number of memory tables in  
the System settings under PT Configuration at  
Memory table No. is out of limit.  
Correct the table No. by the Sup-  
port Tool.  
[Programming Console Error]  
The communications settings are Set the communications method/communica-  
incorrect.  
tions port as follows when using the Programming  
Console function.  
Setting of Programming Console  
Function is inadequate. It can be  
caused by:  
• With C-series PLCs: 1:1 NT Link  
• With CS/CJ-series PLCs:  
1:N NT Link (standard or high-speed)  
• This PLC does not support Pro-  
gramming Console Function.  
• Protocol mismatch. Set the PLC  
to NT Link.  
• “PROGRAMMINGCONSOLEis  
connected to PLC.  
The PLC used does not support  
the Programming Console func-  
tion.  
function. Check the model of the PLC you are  
using. (6-12 Programming Console Function)  
A Programming Console is con-  
nected.  
It is not possible to use a Programming Console  
and the Programming Console function at the  
same time. Disconnect the Programming Con-  
sole.  
[Programming Console Error]  
The connecting cable is defective. Check the cable connection and perform a con-  
ductivity test. If there is a fault, replace the cable.  
Programming Console Function  
does not RUN. It can be caused  
by:  
Malfunction due to external noise Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding,  
page 34.  
• Connecting cable is faulty.  
A Programming Console is con-  
nected.  
It is not possible to use a Programming Console  
and the Programming Console function at the  
same time. Disconnect the Programming Con-  
sole.  
• “PROGRAMMINGCONSOLEis  
connected to PLC.  
• Protocol mismatch between the  
PT and PLC. Set the PLC to NT  
Link.  
The communications conditions at Set the communications conditions at the PLC to  
the PLC have been changed in  
accordance with the NT631/  
NT631C Programming Console  
function.  
match the conditions set in the System Menu.  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
7-2-3 Errors Occurring on Screen Data Initialization and Transmission  
The table below shows the errors that can occur when the NT631/NT631C  
data is initialized, and during data setting and transmission, and their reme-  
dies.  
Message  
[Flash Memory Error]  
Flash Memory I/O Error.  
Cause  
Remedy  
There is a hardware fault, or the  
flash memory (memory for storing clearing the screen data or transmitting screen  
screen data) has reached the end data several times, contact your OMRON service  
If the same message is displayed even after  
If this happens frequently, Flash  
Memory may be broken.  
of its service life.  
center.  
Press Reset Switch to restart.  
[Calendar Data Error]  
Hardware fault, or system pro-  
gram error  
Set the calendar clock again from the System  
in the System Installer mode, then re-install the  
program. (6-5-2 Clearing/Installing the System  
Program, page 145)  
Calendar Data is incorrect.  
Set to the MAINTENANCE MODE  
and set Calendar Data.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your  
OMRON service center.  
[Tool Transmit Error]  
The connecting cable is defective. Check the cable connection and perform a con-  
ductivity test. If there is a fault, replace the cable.  
(Appendix F Making the Cable for Connecting a  
PLC)  
∗∗∗∗ Error detected while down-  
loading by the following case:  
• faulty connecting cable.  
• corrupted data by noise.  
Malfunction due to external noise Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding,  
page 34.  
[Tool Transmit Error]  
Malfunction due to external noise Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding,  
page 34.  
Check Sum Error occurs while  
downloading by the following  
case:  
• corrupted data by noise.  
[Tool Transmit Error]  
The connecting cable is defective. Check the cable connection and perform a con-  
ductivity test. If there is a fault, replace the cable.  
Time-out Error occurs while down-  
loading by the following case:  
• faulty connecting cable.  
[Tool Transmit Error]  
The receive buffer has overflowed. Retransmit the data from the Support Tool.  
Reception was failed by Buffer  
Over Flow Error.  
7-2-4 Errors in the System Installer Mode and Their Remedies  
This section describes the errors that may occur in the System Installer mode  
of the NT631/NT631C, and the remedies for these errors.  
Message  
Cause  
System Program not exist or  
incorrect.  
- The system program has not  
been installed.  
Select Download System Program and download  
the system program (6-5-2 Clearing/Installing the  
System Program, page 145)  
- The system program has been  
deleted due to a hardware fault, If this does not solve the problem, contact your  
or because the flash memory  
(memory for storing the system  
program) has reached its life.  
OMRON service center.  
Unable to erase System Program. Hardware fault, or flash memory  
(memory for storing the system  
If the same message is displayed on repeating  
selection of Download System Program and  
times, contact your OMRON service center (6-5-2  
Clearing/Installing the System Program,  
page 145)  
program) has reached its life.  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
Unable to download System Pro- - A communications error  
gram.  
occurred during downloading of the system program again (6-5-2 Clearing/Install-  
the system program.  
- Illegal data has been written  
into the screen data memory.  
Also refer to 7-2-3 Errors Occurring on Screen  
Data Initialization and Transmission (page 232),  
and take the corrective action described for tool  
transmission errors.  
- Hardware fault, or flash memory  
(memory for storing the system  
program) has reached its life.  
If this does not solve the problem, contact your  
OMRON service center.  
Unable to write System Settings. Hardware fault, or flash memory  
(memory for storing the system  
If the same message is displayed on repeating  
writing of system settings several times, contact  
your OMRON service center.  
program) has reached its life.  
If writing is normally terminated after the error  
message was once displayed, the Memory  
Switch setting for system program may have been  
altered. In such a case, check and reset the set-  
ting in the Memory Switch menu of the Mainte-  
nance mode.  
Unable to erase Screen Data.  
Hardware fault, or flash memory  
(memory for storing the system  
program) has reached its life.  
If the same message is displayed on repeating  
screen data deletion several times, contact your  
OMRON service center.  
7-2-5 Communications Errors and Their Remedies  
This section describes the errors relating to communications that can occur  
during operation, and their remedies.  
Operation When a  
Communications Error  
Occurs  
When a communications error occurs, the error message is displayed at the  
NT631/NT631C, and the buzzer sounds, provided the setting made for Buzzer  
Sound in the System Menu is other than OFF. An error message is displayed  
provided the setting for the Comm. Auto-Return memory switch is not ON  
(note that some error messages are displayed even if the setting is ON).  
Operation When  
Communications Errors  
Occur  
When an error message is displayed, after removing the cause of the error,  
press the OK touch switch displayed on the screen. The NT631/NT631C will  
return to the screen that was displayed before the error occurred, and opera-  
tion will restart.  
Display of  
Communications Errors  
For communications errors, the name of the port at which the error occurred,  
the error classification (send or receive error), the details of the error, the  
probable cause, and the remedy, are displayed as shown below.  
Example:  
Parity error at serial port A  
Receive Errors  
The following errors can occur when receiving data.  
• Parity error  
• Framing error  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
Section 7-2  
• Overrun error  
• FCS (sum value) error  
• Time out error  
• Data over flow error  
• PLC unit No. error (Host Link only)  
• NAK received (in the case of the Host Link, the end code is also dis-  
played)  
• Undefined command error  
Send Errors  
The following errors can occur when receiving data.  
• Time out error  
• Data over flow error  
Probable Causes and  
Remedies  
The remedies to take in accordance with the displayed cause are indicated in  
the table below.  
Error Details  
Parity Error  
Displayed Probable Cause  
Remedy  
Communications parameters/  
conditions set incorrectly.  
Check if the settings at the host for parity bit, frame  
length, communications speed, stop bit length and  
flow control agree with those at the NT631/NT631C.  
Framing Error  
Over-run Error  
The connecting cables are not con-  
nected correctly.  
Check the communications cable connection and  
refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the  
RS-232C Port, and SECTION 5 Connecting to the  
Host from the RS-422A/485 Port.  
Noise caused data corruption during Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
communications. conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
Noise caused data corruption during Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
FCS (Check Sum) Error  
Time-out Error  
communications.  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
The PLC is transmitting incorrect  
data.  
Check the operation at the host side.  
The connecting cables are not con-  
nected correctly. (Send/Receive)  
Check the communications cable connection and  
refer to SECTION 4 Connecting to the Host from the  
RS-232C Port, and SECTION 5 Connecting to the  
Host from the RS-422A/485 Port.  
The communications service of the  
host is stopped. (Send/Receive)  
Check that the host is capable of communicating with  
the NT631/NT631C (confirm that the communica-  
tions settings of the host and NT631/NT631C match).  
Time-out Interval is too short. (Send) Set a longer value for Time-out Interval at the host  
side.  
Time-out Interval is too short.  
(Receive)  
Set a longer value for Time-out Interval in the System  
Menu. (6-9-12 Setting the Time-out Interval,  
page 181) It may also be possible to solve the prob-  
lem by shortening the host cycle time.  
PLC Unit No. Error  
The unit # does not match that set on Re-set the unit number at the host side to 0.  
the PLC.  
Noise caused data corruption during Carry out grounding work in accordance with the  
communications.  
conditions by referring to 3-1-4 Grounding, page 34.  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
Error Details  
NAK received  
Displayed Probable Cause  
Remedy  
——  
Check the settings for allocated words and bits.  
If noise is a possible factor, distance the cable from  
sources of noise and insert a noise filter in the power  
supply line.  
If using the equipment in a location subject to a lot of  
noise, use a cable with a high degree of protection  
against noise for the transmission route. Also make  
the cable as short as possible.  
Undefined Command Error The host is not supported.  
Instruction level 3 is not effective.  
Check the PLC model used for the host.  
Check that the instruction level setting for the host is  
level 1, 2, 3.  
Data Over Flow Error  
Communications command from the Set flow control method in the host.  
host is too long.  
Increase transmission interval.  
(With memory link)  
Command transmission to the host is Check the communications cable.  
not possible.  
Check the control method at the PT and the host.  
Increase the communications on speed when it to  
slow.  
7-3 Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Carry out maintenance work in order to ensure that the NT631/NT631C is  
always used in its optimum condition.  
WARNING  
Do not attempt to take the unit apart and do not touch any  
internal parts while the power is being supplied. Doing either  
of these may result in electrical shock.  
Spare PT  
It is advisable to have a spare NT631/NT631C available to minimize system  
downtime in the event of an NT631/NT631C failure or if the screen display  
becomes difficult to read due to deterioration of the display unit.  
Backlight (for NT631C-  
ST141@-EV2/ST151@-EV2  
only)  
When the backlight in the display is getting dim and the screen cannot be read  
easily, replace the backlight. The backlight can be replaced at the rear of the  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2/ST151@-EV2 while it is mounted in an operation  
panel. The backlight for NT631C-ST152@-EV2 and NT631C-ST153@-V3  
cannot be replaced by the user. Contact your OMRON service center when  
the backlight needs to be replaced.  
Replaceable Backlight Model  
NT631C-CFL01 (for NT631C-ST151@-EV2)  
The backlight for the NT631C-ST152@-EV2/ST153@-EV3 cannot be re-  
placed by the user. Contact your OMRON service center when the battery  
needs to be replaced.  
NT631C-CFL02 (for NT631C-ST141@-EV2)  
Guide to Backlight Replacement  
Use the following as a guide to backlight replacement.  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2: Approx. 25,000 hours  
NT631C-ST151@-EV2: Approx. 30,000 hours  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
The life of the backlight varies, particularly in accordance with the temperature  
in the environment in which it is used. It should be replaced when it becomes  
dim and the screen becomes hard to read.  
The life expectancy of the backlight for the NT631C-ST152@-EV2/ST153@-  
EV3 at high brightness is 50,000 hours. The backlight cannot be replaced by  
the user, however. Contact your OMRON service center when the backlight  
needs to be replaced.  
Notes on Replacing the  
Backlight  
Pay attention to the following points when replacing the backlight.  
• Carry out the replacement work in a location where there is no danger  
that dust or foreign bodies will enter the Unit, and where no water will drip  
onto it.  
Do not touch the printed circuit boards of the NT631C-ST141@-EV2/  
ST151@-EV2 with your bare hands.  
Also, discharge the static electricity from your body before starting the  
work.  
• Do not carry the Backlight Unit by holding only its cable, or pull on the  
cable. Do not subject the backlight to excessive force or shock.  
• Do not disassemble the product to repair or modify it.  
Replacing the Backlight  
Use the following procedure to replace the backlight.  
WARNING  
Switch OFF the NT631C-ST141@-EV2/ST151@-EV2 power  
before replacing the backlight. Otherwise you could sustain  
an electric shock.  
Replace the backlight by following the procedure given below:  
NT631C-CFL01 (for NT631C-ST151@-EV2)  
Procedure  
1,2,3...  
1. Turn the power supply to the PT OFF.  
Be sure to do so to avoid an electric shock.  
2. Disconnect the terminal block wiring, the communications cable, and the  
printer cable. If a Memory Unit or Interface Unit is mounted, remove that  
Unit also.  
3. Loosen four screws at corners on the rear face of the NT631C, and remove  
the rear case.  
Be careful not to lose these screws.  
From this step on, exert added care not to touch any electronic parts or  
printed circuit boards inside the Unit. Otherwise the PT may sustain static  
damage.  
4. Disengage two backlight connectors at the top and the bottom, and pull out  
the touch panel cable.  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
Removing and Fitting The Touch Panel Cable  
Removing The Touch Panel Cable:  
Pull the arrow-marked sections up to the cable side to unlock the connector,  
and remove the cable.  
Fitting The Touch Panel Cable:  
While unlocking the connector, insert the touch panel cable fully. Then, lock  
the connector.  
Not locked  
completely  
Locked  
Unlocked  
5. Loosen two mounting screws, and remove the backlight.  
When loosening or tightening screws for backlights, be sure to use a mag-  
netized Phillips screwdriver. If any screw falls inside the Unit, it must be ex-  
tricated without fail.  
6. Fit new backlights.  
The backlight for the top is different from that for the bottom.  
Each backlight has three projections. Slot these projections into slits on the  
Unit, and tighten the screws while lightly holding the backlight by fingers.  
Make sure that the cable does not come out of the backlight. If it comes  
out, put it in the backlight and then tighten the screws.  
The tightening torque must be 0.2 N·m.  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
7. Engage backlight connectors at the top and the bottom respectively in  
place. The backlight cable has a polarity; refer to the figure below.  
8. Fit the touch panel cable. Be sure to lock the connector as in step 4 after  
fitting.  
9. Close the rear case, and tighten four screws. Make sure that the internal  
cable is not trapped.  
10. Reconnect the wiring, cables, and Units disconnected in 2, and tighten the  
screws at a torque of 0.4 N·m.  
Turn the power on, and check that the RUN LED is not flashing and that no  
buzzer is sounding.  
If the RUN LED flashes at 1-s intervals and a buzzer sounds intermittently,  
the touch panel cable is disconnected. Follow the above steps from 1, and  
check the lock status of the connector.  
11. Before starting normal operation, confirm that the following tests can be  
executed correctly by using the I/O check in the Maintenance menu. Also  
perform a communications test with the host.  
Touch switch  
• Backlight  
12. On confirming that all the tests in 11 can be executed normally, start oper-  
ation.  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
NT631C-CFL02 (for NT631C-ST141@-EV2)  
Procedure  
1,2,3...  
1. Turn the power supply to the PT OFF.  
Be sure to do so to avoid an electric shock.  
2. Disconnect the terminal block wiring, the communications cable, and the  
printer cable. If a Memory Unit or Interface Unit is mounted, remove that  
Unit also.  
3. Loosen four screws at corners on the rear face of the NT631C, and remove  
the rear case.  
Be careful not to lose these screws.  
From this step on, exert added care not to touch any electronic parts or  
printed circuit boards inside the Unit. Otherwise the PT may sustain static  
damage.  
4. Disengage two backlight connectors at the top and the bottom, and pull out  
two touch panel cables at the top.  
Removing and Fitting The Touch Panel Cable  
Removing The Touch Panel Cable:  
Pull the arrow-marked sections up to the cable side to unlock the connector,  
and remove the cable.  
Fitting The Touch Panel Cable:  
While unlocking the connector, insert the touch panel cable fully. Then, lock  
the connector.  
Not locked  
completely  
Locked  
Unlocked  
5. Loosen mounting screws, and remove backlights.  
Shift the backlight to the right, and pull it out.  
When loosening or tightening screws for backlights, be sure to use a mag-  
netized Phillips screwdriver. If any screw falls inside the Unit, it must be ex-  
tricated without fail.  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
6. Fit new backlights.  
The backlight for the top is different from that for the bottom.  
Fit projections and dents of the backlight with those on the fixture, and shift  
the backlight to the left. Check that the backlight is in contact with the left  
end of the fixture and the cable comes out from the notch without being  
trapped.  
When the backlight is correctly fit, tighten the screws at a torque of  
0.1 N·m.  
Top part  
Fixture  
Backlight fixture on the PT  
Mounting screw  
Backlight  
Cable  
Cable  
Backlight  
Bottom part  
Backlight fixture on the PT  
Mounting screw  
Backlight  
Fixture  
Backlight  
7. Engage backlight connectors at the top and the bottom respectively in  
place. The backlight cable has a polarity; refer to the figure below.  
White  
Red  
Red  
White  
8. Fit two touch panel cables at the top. Be sure to lock the connectors as in  
step 4 after fitting.  
9. Close the rear case, and tighten four screws. Make sure that the internal  
cable is not trapped.  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance of the NT631/NT631C  
Section 7-3  
10. Reconnect the wiring, cables, and Units disconnected in 2, and tighten the  
screws at a torque of 0.4 N·m.  
Turn the power on, and check that the RUN LED is not flashing and that no  
buzzer is sounding.  
If the RUN LED flashes at 1-s intervals and a buzzer sounds intermittently,  
the touch panel cable is disconnected. Follow the above steps from 1, and  
check the lock status of the connector.  
11. Before starting normal operation, confirm that the following tests can be  
executed correctly by using the I/O check in the Maintenance menu. Also  
perform a communications test with the host.  
Touch switch  
• Backlight  
12. On confirming that all the tests in 11 can be executed normally, start oper-  
ation.  
7-3-1 Replacing the Battery  
The NT631/NT631C uses a lithium battery to back up the memory contents.  
The battery life is about 5 years if the NT631/NT631C is used in a location  
where the ambient temperature is 25°C. If the temperature at the location of  
use is higher than this, the battery life will be shorter. Change the battery at  
suitable intervals in accordance with the operating environment of the NT631/  
NT631C.  
It is advisable to keep a spare battery so that the battery can be replaced  
immediately when replacement becomes necessary.  
Battery Type  
3G2A9-BAT08 (for both NT631 and NT631C)  
Guide to Replacement  
Replace the Battery in the following cases.  
If the power supply to the PT is left turned OFF after a low battery voltage has  
been detected, the memory backed up by the battery may be corrupted.  
Replace the Battery within 5 minutes of turning OFF the power supply to the  
PT.  
• When 5 years have passed since the installation of a new battery.  
• When the RUN LED is lit in orange (during operation) or in red (when  
stopped).  
• When the message The voltage is lowered. is displayed on switching on  
the power or resetting the NT631/NT631C.  
• When The voltage is lowered is displayed in the Battery check in the bat-  
tery check menu of the Maintenance mode.  
Battery Replacement Method  
Replace the battery by following the procedure given below.  
To protect the contents of the memory, the battery must be replaced within 5  
minutes.  
Procedure  
1,2,3...  
1. Keep the power ON for at least 5 minutes and then turn it OFF.  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Inspection and Cleaning  
Section 7-4  
Reference:  
Unless the power is kept ON for at least 5 minutes, the memory contents  
cannot be retained for more than 5 minutes without a battery.  
2. Insert a flat blade screwdriver at the top of the battery cover located at the  
left of the rear face of the NT631/NT631C and pull it toward you.  
3. Remove the battery that is secured under the battery cover, grip the cable,  
and pull the connector straight out.  
4. Insert the connector of the new battery into the connector on the NT631/  
NT631C and fit the battery under the battery cover.  
When inserting the battery connector, make sure that the projection on it  
faces to the left, and press it fully home while keeping it straight.  
The connector of the new battery must be connected within 5 minutes after  
disconnecting the old battery’s connector. However, the battery can be re-  
placed while the NT631/NT631C power is on, and in this case there is no  
time restriction.  
5. Close the battery cover, making sure that the cable is not trapped.  
7-4 Inspection and Cleaning  
Clean and inspect the NT631/NT631C regularly to ensure that it is always  
used in its optimum condition.  
Cleaning Method  
If the display is dirty the screen is difficult to see. Clean the screen from time  
to time as follows.  
• In daily cleaning, wipe the display with a soft dry cloth. If the soiling is par-  
ticularly heavy, attempting to remove it by wiping with a dry cloth may  
damage the front sheet of the Unit. In this case, wipe with a damp cloth.  
• If the soiling cannot be removed with a dry cloth, wet the cloth with diluted  
neutral detergent (2%), wring it out well and wipe the display with it.  
• If rubber or vinyl products, tape, etc., are left stuck to the display for long  
periods they will cause staining. If such items are stuck to the display,  
remove them during cleaning.  
Note  
Never use volatile solvents such as benzene or thinners, or chemical dusters.  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Inspection and Cleaning  
Section 7-4  
Inspection Method  
In normal environments, inspect the NT631/NT631C at intervals of between 6  
months and a year. In environments that are extremely hot and humid, or very  
dusty environments, shorten the inspection interval.  
Items Required for The Inspection  
Prepare the following items before starting the inspection.  
• Screwdrivers (Phillips, flat head)  
Tester (or digital voltmeter)  
• Industrial alcohol  
• 100% cotton cloth  
• Hygrometer (required in some cases)  
• Thermometer (required in some cases)  
• Synchroscope (required in some cases)  
• Pen-writing oscilloscope (required in some cases)  
Points Inspected  
Inspect the following points to determine if there is any divergence from the  
stated criteria. If there is, either improve the surrounding environment so that  
the values fall within the stated range, or adjust the NT631/NT631C, for exam-  
ple by re-tightening screws.  
Point  
Inspected  
Inspection Details  
Criterion  
Inspection  
Instrument  
Power supply  
voltage  
Fluctuation in power supply terminal  
voltage  
Permissible voltage fluctuation range  
20.4 to 26.4 VDC (24 VDC –15% to  
+10%)  
Tester  
Ambient envi-  
ronmental con- the operation panel)  
ditions  
Ambient temperature (temperature in 0 to 50°C  
Thermometer  
Hygrometer  
Ambient humidity (humidity in the  
35% to 85% RH  
operation panel)  
Presence/absence of dust  
Dust must not be settled  
Visual inspection  
Phillips screwdriver  
Phillips screwdriver  
Mounting condi- Looseness of mounting brackets, etc. To be no looseness  
tions  
Connector connections of connecting To be fully inserted and locked, with no  
cable  
looseness  
Looseness of screws in external wir-  
ing  
To be no looseness  
Phillips screwdriver  
Visual inspection  
Visual inspection  
Conditions of external connecting  
cables  
Faults such as incipient disconnection  
Must be sufficiently bright.  
Components  
Brightness of the backlight  
with limited lives (NT631C only)  
Backlight life:  
(Under the normal range of ambient tem-  
perature and humidity)  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2: Approx.  
25,000 hours or longer  
NT631C-ST151@-EV2: Approx.  
30,000 hours or longer  
NT631C-ST152@-EV2/ST153@-EV3:  
Approx. 50,000 hours or longer  
(Brightness setting is not available for  
the NT631C-ST151/152@-EV2/  
ST153@-EV3 and the backlight can-  
not be replaced.)  
Note  
1. Do not disassemble for repairs or modification.  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Inspection and Cleaning  
Section 7-4  
2. The disposal of the Unit (including batteries to be disposed and backlight)  
may be regulated by national or local authorities. Dispose of them in accor-  
dance with the laws and regulations of the relevant country and local au-  
thority.  
Reference:  
• Desire on replacing the NT631/NT631C  
• When replacing the NT631/NT631C after discovering a fault during  
inspections, note the following points:  
• Be sure to switch the power OFF before starting replacement.  
• After replacement, check that the new NT631/NT631C is not subject to  
the same error.  
• If a faulty Unit is returned for repairs, write as detailed a description of the  
fault as possible and send this description together with the Unit to the  
OMRON address indicated on the back cover of this book.  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Specifications  
General Specifications  
Item  
Specifications  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
Rated power supply voltage 24 VDC  
NT631C-ST153@-EV3  
Allowable power supply  
voltage range  
20.4 VDC to 26.4 VDC (24 VDC –15% to +10%)  
Allowable power interrup-  
tion time  
No regulation  
Power consumption  
Power starting time  
30 W max.  
18 W max.  
200 ms max.  
---  
0 to 50°C*1  
Operating ambient temper- 0 to 50°C  
ature  
0 to 40°C  
–20 to +60°C*1  
Storage ambient tempera-  
ture  
10% to 90%*1 (with no con-  
densation)  
Operating ambient humidity 35% to 85% (with no condensation)  
Operating environment  
Noise immunity  
No corrosive gases  
Common mode: 1000 Vp-p (between power supply termi- Conforms to IEC61000-4-4.  
nals and panel)  
2 kV (power line)  
Normal mode:  
300 Vp-p  
Pulse width of 100 ns to 1 µs, pulse rise time of 1 ns  
57 to 150 Hz with 9.8 m/s2  
Vibration resistance  
(operating)  
10 to 57 Hz with 0.075-mm  
5 to 9 Hz with 3.5-mm single  
amplitude and 9 to 150 Hz  
single amplitude for 30 min-  
utes each in X, Y, and Z  
directions  
and 10 to 57 Hz with  
0.075-mm single amplitude for with 9.8 m/s2 acceleration  
30 minutes each in X, Y, and Z 10 times each in X, Y, and Z  
directions  
directions (1 octave/min)  
147 m/s2 3 times each in X,Y, and Z directions  
Shock resistance  
(operating)  
Dimensions  
315 × 250 × 54 (W × H × D) mm  
(With Expansion Unit mounted: 315 × 250 × 74 (W × H × D) mm)  
Panel cutout dimensions  
303+0.5× 238+0.5 mm  
0
0
Circle of panel pressure 1.6 to 4.8 mm  
Weight  
2.5 kg max.  
Front panel: Protection equivalent to oil-proof IP65 (NEMA4). *2  
Degree of protection  
Grounding  
D-type grounding (Ground to 100 or less)  
*1: Use the NT631C-ST153@-EV3 within the following temperature and humidity ranges.  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
Specifications  
Appendix A  
Storage  
Wet bulb temperature (°C)  
Operating  
Temperature (°C)  
*2: The NT631/NT631C may not be used at a location where it is exposed to splashing oil for a long period.  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Appendix A  
Performance Specifications  
Display Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2 NT631C-ST153@-EV3  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
EL  
(monochrome)  
Display panel Display device  
Color STN LCD  
(with backlight)  
Color TFT high-preci-  
sion LCD  
(with backlight)  
Number of dots (resolution) 640 dots horizontally × 480 dots vertically  
Size of a standard charac- 5.28 mm  
ter  
5.76 mm  
5.28 mm  
Effective display area  
211 mm horizontally ×  
158 mm vertically  
(10.4 inches)  
229 mm horizontally ×  
172 mm vertically  
(11.3 inches)  
211 mm horizontally ×  
158 mm vertically  
(10.4 inches)  
View angle  
(No restriction)  
Up/down: 30°  
Left: 55°  
Right: 45°  
Up: 35°  
Down: 65°  
Left: 60°  
Right: 60°  
Display color  
Orange, black  
(2 colors)  
8 colors (and intermediate colors can be dis-  
played with tiling patterns)  
Life expectancy  
30,000 hours min. (until 50,000 hours min.  
brightness reduced by  
30%)  
(until brightness reduced by 50%)  
Contrast adjustment  
(Not provided)  
Adjustable in 100 levels (Not provided)  
by operation at the  
touch panel  
25,000 hours min.*1  
50,000 hours min.*1  
Backlight  
(white cold  
cathode tube)  
Life expectancy  
Replacement  
---  
---  
Can be replaced from  
the rear by the user  
Cannot be replaced by  
the user  
Brightness adjustment  
(Not provided)  
Adjustable in 3 levels by (Not provided)  
touch switch operation  
at the touch panel*2  
Automatic turn-off function Can be set to turn off in 1 to 255 minutes, or to remain on  
Indicators  
POWER (green LED)  
RUN  
Lit while power is being supplied  
Lit in green: Operating normally, Memory Unit automatic transmission com-  
pleted  
Flashing in green: Memory Unit automatic transmission being executed,  
Memory Unit automatic transmission error  
Lit in orange: Low battery voltage (during operation)  
Lit in red: Low battery voltage (when operation is stopped)  
*1: Time taken for brightness to reduce to half at normal temperature and humidity  
*2: Sharp brightness adjustment is not available.  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Specifications  
Appendix A  
Panel Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
Touch panel  
Type: Resistive type  
Number of switches: 768 (32 horizontally × 24 vertically)  
Maximum number that can be registered on one screen: 256  
Cell size: NT631-ST211@-EV2  
NT631-ST141@-EV2  
5.9 × 5.9 mm  
6.5 × 6.5 mm  
5.9 × 5.9 mm  
NT631-ST153@-EV3  
Input: Pressure-sensitive type  
Operating force: 1 N minimum  
Life expectancy: One million operations minimum  
External Interface Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
Serial communications Serial port A  
Conforms to EIA RS-232C.  
D-SUB 9-pin connector (female)  
+5 V (250 mA max.) output at pin No. 6  
Serial port B connec- EIA RS-232C (Serial port B terminal block selectable by memory switch  
tor*  
setting)  
D-SUB 9-pin connector (female)  
Serial port B terminal EIA RS-422A/485 (Serial port B connector selectable by memory switch  
block*  
setting)  
Terminal block  
Parallel interface  
Conforms to Centronics standard, 20-pin half pitch connector  
Dedicated connector  
Expansion interface  
* Serial port B is used for either a connector or terminal block.  
Note Check that the current capacity of the equipment to be supplied is within 250 mA before using the +5 V  
output of pin No. 6.  
The +5 V output of the Unit delivers +5 V 5% and 250 mA maximum.  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Specifications  
Appendix A  
Programming Environment  
Item  
Specification  
Programming System Programming support software  
Programming Tool  
Programming support software  
NT-series Support Tool for Windows (Ver. 4.@), made by OMRON  
Special Features  
Item  
Specifications  
Three kinds of buzzer sound (continuous, short intermittent, and long intermittent)  
Buzzer  
ON:  
On reception of a command from the host, display of a screen with a buzzer  
setting, or display of an error screen such as for a receive error.  
OFF:  
On reception of a command from the host, or display of a screen with no  
buzzer setting.  
Setting: Set “ON” for “Buzzer Sound” in the memory switch menu, or set “ERROR  
ON” for the buzzer to sound only when an error occurs.  
The buzzer sounds three times in response to prohibited input.  
Touch switches  
Touch switch input sound  
Maintenance function  
Input sound: Sounding for 0.2 seconds  
Setting: Set “ON” for “Key Press Sound” in the memory switch menu.  
- Memory switch setting  
- Self-test functions, such as for the memory and external interface  
- Setting condition confirmation function  
- Communications check function  
- Initialization of internal memory data  
- Display of display/alarm history data  
- Registered data test display function  
Battery backup  
- Backup of numeral/character string memory table data in the NT631/NT631C  
- Backup of display/alarm history data  
- Backup of calendar and clock setting  
Battery life:  
5 years (at 25°C)  
When voltage becomes low:  
RUN LED lights in orange or red  
The communications flag to the PLC (BAT LOW)  
comes ON (1).  
Resume function  
Retains the contents of the numeral/character string memory tables (i.e., they are not  
initialized) when the power is turned ON, when the NT631/NT631C is reset, and when  
the operation mode is changed.  
Setting: Set “ON” for “Resume Function” in the memory switch menu.  
Screen print function  
Functions:  
- Prints a hard copy of the screen display  
- Prints display/alarm histories  
Setting:  
Set the printing protocol (“Print Controller”) and printing type (“Print  
Method”) in the memory switch menu.  
“ESC/P”, “Color”:  
Color printing conforming to ESC/P 24-J83C  
“PC-PR201H”, “Color”: Color printing conforming to PC-PR201PL  
“ESC/P”, “Tone”:  
Monochrome printing in 8 grayscale levels,  
conforming to ESC/P 24-J82  
“PC-PR201H”, “Tone”:  
“PCL 5”, “Tone”:  
Monochrome printing in 8 grayscale levels,  
conforming to PC-PR201PL  
Monochrome printing in 8 grayscale levels,  
conforming to PCL 5  
However, the NT631 supports monochrome printing only.  
Calendar and clock function  
- Displays the current time in accordance with the built-in clock  
- Displayed and set with “Calendar Check” in the “MAINTENANCE MODE” menu  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Specifications  
Appendix A  
Item  
Specifications  
Programming Console function  
Executes functions equivalent to those of a C200H-PRO27-E Programming Console  
for CPM1, CPM1A, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1 (-EV1 only), CQM1H, C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z)E, and SRM1 (C02-V2 only) PLCs.  
Executes functions as a Programming Console for CS/CJ-series PLC.  
Device Monitor function  
Mathematical function  
The Device Monitor function can be used to change the PLC’s operating mode, read/  
change words in the PLC’s data areas, and display the PLC’s error log. Compatible  
PLCs include the CPM1, CPM1A, CPM2A, CPM2C, CQM1, CQM1H, C200HX/HG/  
HE(-Z)E, SRM1, and CS/CJ-series PLCs.  
Up to 256 calculation expressions can be registered along with the screen data. The  
mathematical function reads the required data from numeral memory tables or host  
words, executes the registered calculations, and writes the results.  
Arithmetic operators, logic operators, bit operators, and comparative operators can be  
used.  
Transmission System program Downloads the system program from the system installer  
functions  
transmission  
Downloads/Upload the system program with a Memory Unit.  
Screen data  
transmission  
- Function for downloading screen data to and uploading screen data from the  
Support Tool  
- Function for transmitting screen data to and from the Memory Unit.  
Function for uploading display/alarm history data from PT.  
History data  
uploading  
Communications Specifications  
For a Host Link, RS-232C  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-232C  
Start-stop synchronization  
Communications speed: 9600, 19200 bps  
Data length:  
Stop bit:  
Parity:  
7 bits  
2 bits  
Even  
Connector  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A, B)  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
1:1  
Max. 15 m*  
C-series SYSWAY (1:N)  
* When using an NT-AL001, the specifications are as follows.  
• RS-232C cable:  
• RS-422A cable:  
Max. 2 m  
Total length 500 m max.  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Specifications  
Appendix A  
For a Host Link, RS-422A  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-422A  
Start-stop synchronization  
Communications speed: 9600, 19200 bps  
Data length:  
Stop bit:  
Parity:  
7 bits  
2 bits  
Even  
Connector  
Terminal Block (serial port B)  
1:1  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
Max. 500 m  
C-series SYSWAY (1:N)  
For an NT Link, 1:1, RS-232C  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-232C  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A, B)  
1:1  
Max. 15 m*  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
* When using an NT-AL001, the specifications are as follows.  
• RS-232C cable:  
• RS-422A cable:  
Max. 2 m  
Total length 500 m max.  
For an NT Link, 1:1, RS-422A  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-422A  
Terminal block (serial port B)  
1:1  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Max. 500 m  
For an NT Link, 1:N, RS-232C  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-232C  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A, B)  
1:1 to 8  
Max. 15 m*  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
* To connect two or more PTs, NT-AL001 Adapters are required. When using an NT-AL001, the specifications  
are as follows.  
• RS-232C cable:  
Max. 2 m  
• RS-422A/485 cable:  
Total length 500 m max.  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Appendix A  
For an NT Link, 1:N, RS-422A/485  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-422A/485  
Terminal block  
1:1 to 8  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Max. 500 m  
For a High-speed NT Link, 1:N, RS-232C  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-232C  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A, B)  
1:1 to 8  
Max. 15 m*  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
* To connect two or more PTs, NT-AL001 Adapters are required. When using an NT-AL001, the specifications  
are as follows.  
• RS-232C cable: Max. 2 m  
• RS-422A/485 cable: Total length 500 m max.  
For a High-speed NT Link, 1:N, RS-422A/485  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-422A/485  
Terminal block (serial port B)  
1:1 to 8  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Max. 500 m  
For a Memory Link, RS-232C  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-232C  
Start-stop synchronization  
Communications speed: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400bps  
Data length:  
Stop bit:  
7, 8 bits  
1, 2 bits  
Parity:  
None, even, odd  
None, RS/CS, XON/XOFF  
Presence/absence  
Flow control:  
Response:  
Connector  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A, B)  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
1:1  
Max. 15 m*  
Memory link  
* When using NT-AL001, specification is as follows:  
• RS-232C:  
• RS-422A:  
Max. 2 m  
Max. total length 500 m  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Appendix A  
For a Memory Link, RS-422A  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-422A  
Start-stop synchronization  
Communications speed: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400 bps  
Data length:  
Stop bit:  
7, 8 bits  
1, 2 bits  
Parity:  
None, even, odd  
None, XON/XOFF  
Presence/absence  
Flow control:  
Response:  
Terminal block  
1:1  
Connector  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
Max. 500 m*  
Memory link  
For a Bar Code Reader  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-232C  
Start-stop synchronization  
Communications speed: 4,800, 9600, 19200 bps  
Data length:  
Stop bit:  
7, 8 bits  
1, 2 bits  
Parity:  
None, even, odd  
RS/CS  
Flow control:  
Connector  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female) (serial port A)  
Number of Units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
Data format  
1:1  
Max. 15 m  
Non-protocol mode  
[STX] Data (0 to 40 bytes) [ETX]  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
Appendix A  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B  
Dimensions  
Body  
302.5 (11.91)  
POWER  
RUN  
237.5 (9.35)  
250 (9.84)  
7.5 (0.30)  
54 (2.13)  
315 (12.40)  
With memory unit  
installed (NT-MF261)  
Units: mm (inch)  
237.5 (9.35)  
7.5 (0.30)  
74 (2.91)  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dimensions  
Appendix B  
Mounting Dimensions  
Mounting panel  
Mounting fixture  
POWER  
RUN  
140 (5.51)  
259 (10.20)  
15.5 (0.61)  
7.5 (0.30)  
34  
240 (9.45)  
(1.34) (min.)  
38 (1.5) (max.)  
Units: mm (inch)  
324 (12.76)  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dimensions  
Appendix B  
Cable Connection Dimensions (with NT-MF261)  
35 (1.38)  
96 (3.78)  
RESET  
RDA  
TRM  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
CSA  
CSB  
91 (3.58)  
20.4 (0.94)  
24V  
+DC  
PRINTER  
PORT  
B
PORT  
A
31 (1.22)  
75 (2.95)  
118 (4.65)  
Units: mm (inch)  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Dimensions  
Appendix B  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
This section outlines the external dimensions, procedure for mounting and removal, and specifications of an  
RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter (NT-AL001-E). Refer to this information when designing the control panel. For  
details, refer to the instruction manual supplied with the NT-AL001-E.  
Dimensions  
53.5  
(2.11)  
110 (4.33)  
NT-AL001-E  
omRon  
74.5 (2.93)  
4 (0.16)  
100.2 (3.94)  
(30)  
105 (4.13) max.  
(1.18)  
45 (1.77)  
30 (1.18)  
Units: mm (inch)  
30 (W) × 114 (H) × 100.2 (D) mm: with the RS-422A terminal block cover closed  
30 (W) × 114 (H) × 119.5 (D) mm: with the RS-422A terminal block cover open  
Methods for Mounting and Removal  
The RS-232/RS-422 Adapter (NT-AL001-E) can be mounted on a DIN rail or in an operation panel.  
The RS-422A terminal block of the Adapter can be easily removed.  
Mounting to a DIN Rail  
Latch the top part of the rear face of the Adapter (a in the figure) onto the top edge of the DIN rail, and push the  
PT in the direction indicated by b in the figure.  
Now fit end plates at the right and left of the Adapter to secure it and ensure that it cannot shift laterally.  
(a)  
(b)  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Appendix C  
Removal from a DIN Rail  
Remove the end plates at right and left of the Adapter and, as shown in the figure below, insert a flat-blade  
screwdriver into the rail stopper at the bottom face of the Adapter and pry it free.  
Mounting to an Operation Panel  
Drill two mounting screw holes in an operation panel with a thickness of at least 2 mm (0.08 inch) and secure  
the Adapter with screws.  
30  
(1.18)  
100  
(3.94)  
110  
(4.33)  
Two, M4  
21  
(0.83)  
Units: mm (inch)  
Note In order to ensure a secure and strong mount, mount the Adapter in an operation panel with a thickness  
of at least 2 mm (0.08 inch).  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Appendix C  
Specifications  
The general specifications and communications specifications of the Adapter are shown below.  
General Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
Dimensions  
30 (W) × 114 (H) × 100.2 (D) mm: with the RS-422A terminal block cover closed  
30 (W) × 114 (H) × 119.5 (D) mm: with the RS-422A terminal block cover open  
Weight  
200 g max.  
Operating ambient temperature  
Operating ambient humidity  
Rated power supply voltage  
Rated power supply current  
Rush current  
0 to 55°C  
10 to 90% RH (with no condensation)  
+5 V 10% (using pin No. 6 of the RS-232C connector)  
150 mA max.  
0.8 A max.  
Insulation resistance  
20 Mor higher, measured between all RS-422A terminal signal lines collectively and  
functional ground terminal at 500 VDC  
Dielectric strength  
1500 VAC for 1 minute between all RS-422A terminal signal lines collectively and  
functional ground terminal  
Leakage current: 10 mA max.  
No corrosive gases  
20 to +75°C  
10 to 57 Hz with 0.075-mm single amplitude and 57 to 150 Hz at 9.8 m/s2 for 60 min-  
utes each in X, Y, and Z directions  
Operating environment  
Storage ambient temperature  
Vibration resistance  
147 m/s2 3 times each in X,Y, and Z directions  
Shock resistance  
Communications Specifications  
RS-232C Interface  
Item  
Specification  
Communications speed  
Transmission distance  
Connector  
Max. 64k bps  
Max. 2 m  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female)  
RS-422A/485 Interface  
Item  
Communications speed  
Transmission distance  
Connector  
Specification  
Max. 64k bps (depends on the RS-232C communications speed)  
Max. 500 m  
8-terminal detachable terminal block, M3.0  
DIP Switch Settings  
The Adapter has 6 digits DIP switch for setting the RS-422A/485 communications conditions.  
Before connecting the cable to the Adapter, make the DIP switch settings.  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Appendix C  
(Factory settings)  
ON  
NT-AL001-E  
om on  
1
2
3
4
5
6
[SW1-1] Not used (always ON)  
[SW1-2] Setting for built-in terminal resistance  
- OFF Terminator not set  
- ON Terminator set  
[SW1-3, 4] Selection of 2-wire type/4-wire type  
SW1-3 SW1-4  
OFF  
2-wire type (RS-485)  
4-wire type (RS-422A)  
ON  
SW1-3 SW1-4  
OFF  
ON  
[SW1-5, 6] Selection of the RS-422A send mode  
SW1-5 SW1-6  
OFF  
Continual sending  
ON  
SW1-5 SW1-6  
OFF  
ON  
Complies with CS control of RS-232C  
(Data sent at CS H)  
SW1-5 SW1-6  
OFF  
ON  
Complies with CS control of RS-232C  
(Data sent at CS L)  
When using the host link or NT link (1:1), set the RS-422A send mode to continual sending (set both SW1-5  
and 6 OFF).  
When using the NT link (1:N), set the RS-422A send mode to complies with CS control of RS-232C (i.e., one of  
SW1-5 and SW1-6 must be ON).  
Note (1) Do not set both SW1-5 and SW1-6 ON at the same time. This may damage internal circuits.  
(2) The power supply to the device supplying +5 V must be turned OFF before starting wiring work.  
(3) Before connecting the RS-232C cable and turning on the power to an RS-232C device such as a  
PT (i.e., turning on the power to the Adapter), check that the cable is wired correctly and that the  
DIP switch settings are correct. If the power is turned on while there is a wiring fault, the internal  
circuits of the Adapter or the RS-232C device may be damaged.  
(4) When the Adapter is connected to an OMRON C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1H, or CS/CJ-series  
PLC as an RS-422A device, set DIP switches SW1-5 and SW1-6 as indicated below.  
SW1-5 SW1-6  
OFF  
ON  
5
6
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Appendix C  
Pin Arrangement  
The Adapter has a terminal block for an RS-422A/485 interface connection and a connector for an RS-232C  
interface connection.  
The pin arrangements for the RS-422A/485 terminal block and the RS-232C connector are as follows.  
RS-422A/485 Terminal Block  
Terminal  
block pin  
No.  
Signal name  
Abbreviation  
Signal direction  
(Adapter RS-422 device)  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Request to send ()  
CSA  
8
7
5
3
Request to send (+)  
Receive data ()  
Receive data (+)  
Send data ()  
CSB  
6
4
RDA  
RDB  
2
1
SDA  
Send data (+)  
SDB  
Signal ground  
SG (GND)  
Functional ground  
* The CSB and CSA signals are for specialized applications.  
RS-232C Connector  
Connector  
pin No.  
Signal name  
Abbreviation  
Signal direction  
(Adapter RS-232C device)  
1
Not used  
1
2
2
3
4
Send data  
SD  
RD  
RS  
6
7
8
Receive data  
3
4
Request to send  
(shorted to CS internally)  
9
5
5
Clear to send  
(shorted to RS internally)  
CS  
6
7
+5 V (150 mA) input for Adapter  
+5 V  
DR  
Data set ready  
(shorted to ER internally)  
8
9
Data terminal ready  
(shorted to DR internally)  
ER  
SG  
Signal ground  
* The hood is connected to the functional ground terminal of the RS-422A terminal block.  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Appendix C  
Block Diagram  
A diagram showing the internal blocks of the Adapter is shown below. Refer to this diagram when making  
cables yourself, or when connecting devices with special interfaces.  
RS-232C side  
D-SUB 9P CASE  
RS-422A/485 side  
8P terminal block  
POWER  
LED  
RS-422A/485 Dr/Rec  
Convertor  
DC-DC  
R
1
Fuse  
6
IS_5 V  
IS_0 V  
FG  
+5 V  
L
L
REG  
9
2
SG  
SG  
Photocoupler  
R
R
R
RS-232C  
Dr/Rec  
3
4
SDB  
SDA  
2-wire type/  
3
SW1-6  
SW1-5  
RD  
4-wire type  
R
SW1-3  
SW1-4  
2
SD  
5
6
RDB  
RDA  
4
RS  
R
SW1-2  
Terminator  
5
CS  
RS-422A Dr  
7
DR  
7
8
CSB  
CSA  
8
ER  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix D  
Transporting and Storing the NT631/NT631C  
• When transporting the NT631/NT631C, use the packaging intended for it.  
• When storing the NT631/NT631C, observe the following conditions.  
Storage ambient temperature: –20 to +60°C  
Storage ambient humidity:  
35% to 85%  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Transporting and Storing the NT631/NT631C  
Appendix D  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Making the Cable  
The procedure for making up the cable is described below.  
Also refer to this procedure for making a connecting cable for use with RS-422A/485 connections.  
Cable Preparation  
The preparation of the cable differs according to whether or not the shielding wire is to be connected to the FG.  
Cable with Shielding Wire Connected to FG  
1,2,3....  
1. Cut the cable to the required length.  
2. Remove the external vinyl insulation from the cable with a razor blade. Take care not to damage the shielding  
underneath.  
3. Cut back the shielding wire with scissors.  
4. Use wire strippers to strip the insulation from each wire.  
5. Fold back the shielding wire.  
6. Wrap aluminum foil tape around the folded-back shielding wire.  
(1)  
(2)  
40 (1.57) (RS-232C)  
25 (0.98) (RS-422A)  
(3)  
10  
(0.39)  
(4)  
5
(0.19)  
(5)  
(6)  
Units: mm (inch)  
Aluminum foil tape  
Cable with Shielding Wire Not Connected to FG  
1,2,3...  
1. Cut the cable to the required length.  
2. Remove the external vinyl insulation from the cable with a razor blade. Take care not to damage the shielding  
underneath.  
3. Cut back the shielding wire with scissors.  
4. Use wire strippers to strip the insulation from each wire.  
5. Wrap vinyl tape over the cut off end of the shielding wire.  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Making the Cable  
Appendix E  
(1)  
(2)  
40 (1.57) (RS-232C)  
25 (0.98) (RS-422A)  
(3)  
(4)  
5
(0.19)  
(5)  
Units: mm (inch)  
Vinyl tape  
Soldering  
1,2,3...  
1. Slide heat-shrink tube over each wire.  
2. Pre-solder each wire and connector terminal.  
3. Solder each wire to each connector terminal.  
1 mm  
Soldering iron  
Heat-shrink tube  
(F, 1.5 mm dia., l = 10 mm)  
4. Push the heat shrink tube over the soldered joint and heat the tube to shrink it in place.  
Heat-shrink tube  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making the Cable  
Appendix E  
Hood Assembly  
Assemble the connector hood as shown below.  
Aluminum foil tape  
End not connected to FG  
End connected to FG  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making the Cable  
Appendix E  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix F  
Making the Cable for Connecting a PLC  
Refer to the following when making a cable for connecting the Support Tool.  
Assembly of Connecting Cables  
Wiring should be carried out in one of the following ways, depending on the type of RS-232C connector.  
25-pin Connector  
2
3
4
2
3
4
5
9
SD  
RD  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
SG  
RS  
CS  
Personal computer  
Connector for peripheral devices on PT  
5
7
1
SG  
FG  
Shielding wire  
Connector hood  
Connector hood  
Note Connect a shielding wire to the connector hood of the connectors both at the personal computer end  
and the PT end.  
Use the following recommended products when making the connecting cable.  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
Remarks  
XM2D-2501  
XM2A-0901  
XM2S-2511  
XM2S-0911  
25-pin, made by OMRON, for personal computer side  
9-pin, made by OMRON, for PT side  
Connector hood  
Cable  
25-pin, made by OMRON, for personal computer side  
9-pin, made by OMRON, for PT side  
AWG28×5P IFVV-SB  
CA-MA-VV-SB 5P×28AWG  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Fujikura Ltd.  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
9-pin Connector  
2
2
3
SD  
RD  
3
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
SG  
4
5
9
7
RS  
Personal computer  
Connector for peripheral devices on PT  
8
CS  
5
SG  
Shielding wire  
Connector hood  
Connector hood  
Note Connect a shielding wire to the connector hood of the connectors both at the personal computer end  
and the PT end.  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Making the Cable for Connecting a PLC  
Appendix F  
Use the following recommended products when making the connecting cable.  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
Remarks  
XM2D-0901  
XM2A-0901  
XM2S-0911  
XM2S-0913  
9-pin, made by OMRON, for personal computer  
9-pin, made by OMRON, for PT  
Connector hood*  
Cable  
9-pin, mm pitch screw, made by OMRON  
9-pin, inch pitch screw, made by OMRON  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Fujikura Ltd.  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
AWG28×5P IFVV-SB  
CA-MA-VV-SB 5P×28AWG  
* One XM2S-0911 (for PT) and either one XM2S-0911 or -0913 (for your personal computer) are needed.  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix G  
Making the Cable for Connection to a Bar  
Code Reader  
Refer to the following when making the cable for connection to a bar code reader.  
Wiring Method  
NT631/NT631C side  
Bar code reader side  
Abbr.  
Pin No.  
Abbr.  
SD  
RD  
1
2
SD  
RD  
RS  
3
4
5
6
RS  
CS  
RS-232C  
interface  
CS  
ER  
SG  
+5 V  
7
8
+5 V  
SG  
9
When using the +5 V output of serial port A of the NT631/NT631C, limit the cable length to within 2 m. If a  
cable longer than 2 m is used, connect an external power supply to the bar code reader.  
Connector and Related Parts  
Use the parts which are specified by bar code reader and following recommended products when making the  
connecting cable.  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
Remarks  
XM2A-0901  
XM2S-0911  
9-pin type, made by OMRON, PT side  
9-pin, made by OMRON  
Connector hood  
Cable  
AWG28×5P IFVV-SB  
CA-MA-VV-SB 5P×28AWG  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Fujikura Ltd.  
Multi-core shielded cable, made by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Making the Cable for Connection to a Bar Code Reader  
Appendix G  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix H  
Making the Cable for Connection to a Printer  
The following product is recommended as the cable for connecting a printer.  
NT-CNT121 (made by OMRON, cable length 1.5 m, 20-pin – 36-pin)  
Refer to the following when making a cable for connection to a printer.  
• Connector pin arrangement and wiring  
Connector for a printer  
on PT side  
Printer side  
36  
Pin No.  
Pin No.  
Abbr.  
18  
Shielding wire  
11  
1
Connector hood  
Connector hood  
1
0 V  
20  
9
D7  
11  
2
N.C.  
N.C.  
8
12  
D6  
D5  
7
21  
6
3
13  
4
0 V  
D4  
14  
5
N.C  
D3  
N.C.  
5
20  
10  
22  
23  
15  
6
0 V  
0 V  
D2  
1
19  
4
16  
7
N.C.  
D1  
N.C.  
3
17  
8
D0  
2
24  
1
0 V  
18  
9
STROB  
N.C.  
N.C.  
11  
19  
10  
20  
BUSY  
0 V  
19  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Making the Cable for Connection to a Printer  
Appendix H  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix I  
Relationship between system program and  
hardware  
Here, relationship between system program and hardware is described.  
System programs indicated below are installed for the models shown above in the default state. Also, system  
programs are supplied with the Support Tool as follows.  
Model  
History  
System program  
NT631-ST211@-E  
Conventional product  
System Program version 1.@ Same for pre-version-1 and  
version-2 hardware, but  
(supplied with the  
NT631C-ST141@-E  
NT631C-ST151@-E  
NT631-ST211@-EV1  
NT631C-ST141@-EV1  
NT631C-ST151@-EV1  
there are restrictions to  
NT-ZJCMX1-EV2)  
some functions depending  
on the hardware version that  
is installed.  
Version upgrade of the  
above products  
(December 1998)  
System Program version  
2.0@ or 2.1@  
(supplied with the  
NT-ZJCMX1-EV3)  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2  
NT631C-ST151@-EV2  
Version upgrade of the  
above products  
(December 1999)  
System Program version  
3.0@ or 3.1@  
(supplied with the  
NT-ZJCMX1-V4.00)  
NT631C-ST152@-EV2  
Version upgrade of the  
above products  
(October 2004)  
System Program version  
3.1@  
(supplied with the  
NT-ZJCMX1-V4.05)  
NT631C-ST153@-EV3  
Version upgrade of the  
above products  
(September 2006)  
System Program version  
4.1@  
(supplied with the  
NT-ZJCMX1-V4.08)  
Only for hardware for ver-  
sion-3 (EV3) PTs. Cannot be  
installed with pre-version-1  
or version-2 hardware.  
Note NT System Installer version 2.0 or higher is required to transfer the NT631-EV3-compatible system pro-  
gram. (NT System Installer version 2.0 is provided with the NT-series Support Tool version 4.08 or  
higher.)  
These system programs have mutual compatibility, therefore, they can be installed and used for NT631-  
ST211@-E/NT631C-ST141-E/NT631C-ST151@-E, NT631-ST211@-EV1/NT631C-ST141@-EV1/NT631C-  
ST151@-EV1, and NT631-ST211@-EV2/NT631C-ST141@-EV2/NT631C-ST151@-EV2/NT631C-ST152@-EV2  
each.  
However, there will be a limitation on function depending on the combination. Refer to the following table.  
System program version 4.0@ is only for NT631C-ST153@-EV3. The system program cannot be installed in  
pre-version-2 hardware. System program earlier than Ver. 3.1@ cannot be installed in NT631C-ST153@-EV3.  
The following table shows only the relationship between the hardware and system program.  
For details of the relationship with the screen data created using the Support Tool, refer to NT-series Support  
Tool for Windows (Ver. 4.@) Operation Manual (V061-E1-@).  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Relationship between system program and hardware  
Appendix I  
Combining a -EV1 Version and Version without a -EV@ Suffix  
Hardware  
NT631-ST211@-E  
NT631C-ST141@-E  
NT631C-ST151@-E  
NT631-ST211@-EV1  
NT631C-ST141@-EV1  
NT631C-ST151@-EV1  
System program Ver. 1.0@  
The following functions can not be used:  
• Analogue meter  
The following functions can not be used:  
• Analogue meter  
• High-definition font display  
• Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit  
• High-definition font display  
• Connection to Mitsubishi PLCs  
• Memory link  
• Connection to Mitsubishi PLCs  
• Memory link  
• Window control from the host  
• Multiple display of window screens  
• Moving a window  
• Refer to the following table for details on  
new functions supported by the -V2 ver-  
sions.  
• Window control from the host  
• Multiple display of window screens  
• Moving a window  
• Refer to the following table for details on  
new functions supported by the -V2 ver-  
sions.  
* Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit is possible.  
System program Ver. 2.0@ or  
Ver. 2.1@  
The following functions can not be used:  
The new functions supported by the -V2  
versions cannot be used. Refer to the fol-  
lowing table for details.  
• Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit  
• High-definition font display  
• Refer to the following table for details on  
new functions supported by the -V2 ver-  
sions.  
* The system program’s version can be checked from the System Menu.  
Combining a -EV1 Version and -EV2 Version  
Hardware  
NT631-ST211@-EV1  
NT631C-ST141@-EV1  
NT631C-ST151@-EV1  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2  
NT631C-ST151/152@-EV2  
System program Ver. 2.0@ or  
Ver. 2.1@  
The following functions (new functions supported by the -V2) cannot be used:  
• Additional data areas accessible in CS/CJ-series PLCs  
• The CS/CJ-series high-speed 1:N NT Link  
• Interlock function that controls touch switches, numeral inputs, and character string  
inputs  
• Mathematical function  
• Device Monitor function  
• NT30/620 compatible mode  
• Expanded capabilities for label (guide character) displays, including multiple lines of  
text, ON/OFF switching displays, numeral memory table displays, and character string  
memory table displays  
System program Ver. 3.0@  
All of the functions described in the Setup Manual and Reference Manual can be used.  
* The system program’s version can be checked from the System Menu.  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relationship between system program and hardware  
Appendix I  
Combining a -EV2 Version and Version without a -EV@ Suffix  
Hardware  
NT631-ST211@-E  
NT631C-ST141@-E  
NT631C-ST151@-E  
NT631-ST211@-EV2  
NT631C-ST141@-EV2  
NT631C-ST151/152@-EV2  
System program Ver. 1.0@  
The following functions cannot be used:  
• Analogue meter  
The following functions cannot be used:  
• Analogue meter  
• High-definition font display  
• Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit  
• Connection to Mitsubishi PLCs  
• Memory link  
• Window control from the host  
• Multiple display of window screens  
• Moving a window  
• High-definition font display  
• Connection to Mitsubishi PLCs  
• Memory link  
• Window control from the host  
• Multiple display of window screens  
• Moving a window  
• Additional data areas accessible in CS/  
CJ-series PLCs  
• Additional data areas accessible in CS/  
CJ-series PLCs  
• The CS/CJ-series high-speed 1:N NT  
Link  
• The CS/CJ-series high-speed 1:N NT  
Link  
• Interlock function that controls touch  
switches, numeral inputs, and character  
string inputs  
• Interlock function that controls touch  
switches, numeral inputs, and character  
string inputs  
• Mathematical function  
• Device Monitor function  
• NT30/620 compatible mode  
• Mathematical function  
• Device Monitor function  
• NT30/620 compatible mode  
• Expanded capabilities for label (guide  
character) displays, including multiple  
lines of text, ON/OFF switching displays,  
numeral memory table displays, and  
character string memory table displays  
• Expanded capabilities for label (guide  
character) displays, including multiple  
lines of text, ON/OFF switching displays,  
numeral memory table displays, and  
character string memory table displays  
* Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit is possible.  
System program Ver. 3.0@  
The following functions can not be used:  
All of the functions described in the Setup  
Manual and Reference Manual can be  
used.  
• Installation of system programs using  
Memory Unit  
• High-definition font display  
* The system program’s version can be checked from the System Menu.  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relationship between system program and hardware  
Appendix I  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
Model List  
PTs  
Model  
Specification  
NT631-ST211-EV2  
NT631-ST211B-EV2  
NT631C-ST141-EV2  
NT631-ST141B-EV2  
NT631C-ST153-EV3  
High-intensity EL display (yellow), beige  
High-intensity EL display (yellow), black  
STN color display, beige  
STN color display, black  
High-intensity STN color display, beige  
NT631C-ST153B-EV3 High-intensity STN color display, black  
Host Link Units  
Model  
Specification  
Applicable PLC  
C-series  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C-series  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
3G2A6-LK202-EV1  
CPU-mounting Unit with RS-232C connector  
CPU-mounting Unit with RS-422A connector  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200H-LK202-V1  
Rack-mounting Unit with RS-232C connector for C200H  
Rack-mounting Unit with RS-422A connector for C200H  
C200HS  
C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
Features a selectable RS-232C/RS-422A connector  
C-series  
C1000H  
C2000H  
C500-LK203  
Rack-mounting Unit for C500  
C-series  
C1000H(F)  
C2000H  
CV500-LK201  
Features an RS-232C connector and a selectable RS-232C/  
RS-422A connector  
CVM1/CV-series  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
Rack-mounting Unit for CVM1/CV  
CompoBus/S Master Control Unit  
Model  
Specification  
Model Name  
SRM1-C02-V2  
Features an RS-232C port  
SRM1  
Communications Unit  
Model  
Specification  
Applicable PLC  
CS1W-SCU21(-V1)  
RS-232C (2 ports)  
Rack-mounting Unit  
RA-422A/485 (2 ports)  
Rack-mounting Unit  
RS-232C (2 ports)  
RA-422A/485 (2 ports)  
RS-232C (1 port)  
CS-series  
CS1G/H/D  
CS1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU21(-V1)  
CJ1W-SCU31-V1  
CJ1W-SCU41(-V1)  
CJ-series  
CJ1G/H/M  
RA-422A/485 (1 port)  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Model List  
Appendix J  
CPU Units for Connection via a Host Link  
Model  
Specification  
PLC Type  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
RS-232C adapter/RS-422A adapter connected to the  
peripheral port  
C-series  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
CPM1  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CPM2A  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
The PLC’s communications connector can be split into an  
RS-232C port and peripheral port with a CPM2C-CN111  
Connecting Cable. (The CS1W-CN114/118 Connecting  
Cables convert the connector to a single RS-232C or  
peripheral port.)  
C-series  
CPM2C  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CQM1  
CQM1-CPU41-EV1  
CQM1-CPU42-EV1  
CQM1-CPU43-EV1  
CQM1-CPU44-EV1  
CQM1-CPU45-EV1  
CQM1H-CPU11  
CQM1H-CPU21  
CQM1H-CPU51  
CQM1H-CPU61  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
(The CQM1H-CPU11-E has only a peripheral port.)  
C-series  
CQM1H  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HE(-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HG(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HX(-Z)E  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
CS-series  
CS1G/H/D  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ-series  
CJ1G/H/M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ CVM1/CV-series  
9-pin)  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
* Either of the Communications Boards C200HW-COM02/COM04/COM05/COM06-EV1 is required.  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Model List  
Appendix J  
CPU Units for Connection via a 1:1 NT Link  
Model  
Specification  
PLC Type  
CPM1-10CDR-@  
CPM1-20CDR-@  
CPM1A-10CD@-@  
CPM1A-20CD@-@  
CPM1A-30CD@-@  
CPM1A-40CD@-@  
RS-232C adapter connected to the peripheral port  
(RS-422A adapter cannot be used.)  
C-series  
CPM1  
CPM2A-30CD@@-@  
CPM2A-40CD@@-@  
CPM2A-60CD@@-@  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CPM2A  
CPM2C-10@@@@@@-@  
Connect to the RS-232C port of a CPM2C-CN111 Connecting  
Cable.  
C-series  
CPM2C  
C-series  
CQM1  
CPM2C-20@@@@@@-@  
CQM1-CPU41-EV1  
CQM1-CPU42-EV1  
CQM1-CPU43-EV1  
CQM1-CPU44-EV1  
CQM1-CPU45-EV1  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
CQM1H-CPU21  
CQM1H-CPU51  
CQM1H-CPU61  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CQM1H  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/9-pin) C-series  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/9-pin) C-series  
C200HE(-Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/9-pin) C-series  
C200HG(-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/9-pin) C-series  
C200HX(-Z)E  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV2  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV2  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/9-pin) CVM1/CV-series  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
* Either of the Communications Boards C200HW-COM02/COM04/COM05/COM06-EV1 is required.  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Model List  
Appendix J  
CPU Units for Connection via a 1:N NT Link  
Model  
Specification  
PLC Type  
CQM1H-CPU51(*1)  
CQM1H-CPU61(*1)  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
C-series  
CQM1H  
C200HE-CPU32-(Z)E(*2)  
C200HE-CPU42-(Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HE(-Z)E  
C200HG-CPU33-(Z)E(*2)  
C200HG-CPU43-(Z)E  
C200HG-CPU53-(Z)E(*2)  
C200HG-CPU63-(Z)E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HG(-Z)E  
C200HX-CPU34-(Z)E(*2)  
C200HX-CPU44-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU54-(Z)E(*2)  
C200HX-CPU64-(Z)E  
C200HX-CPU65-ZE  
C200HX-CPU85-ZE  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (selectable/ C-series  
9-pin)  
C200HX(-Z)E  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
CS-series  
CS1G/H/D  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
CJ-series  
CJ1G/H/M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
*1: A CQM1H-SCB41 Serial Communications Board is required.  
*2: Either of the Communications Boards C200HW-COM02/COM04/COM05/COM06-EV1 is required.  
CPU Units for Connection via a High-speed NT Link (1:N)  
Model  
Specification  
PLC Type  
CS-series  
CS1G/H/D  
CS1G-CPU42/43/44/45-E(V1)  
CS1H-CPU63/64/65/66/67-E(V1)  
CS1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CS1H-CPU63H/64H/65H/66H/67H  
CS1D-CPU65H/67H  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
CJ1G-CPU44/45  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections (9-pin)  
CJ-series  
CJ1G/H/M  
CJ1G-CPU42H/43H/44H/45H  
CJ1H-CPU65H/66H/67H  
CJ1M-CPU11/12/13/21/22/23  
Reference: CS-series PLCs earlier than versions -V1 and H, and Serial Communications Boards and Units  
and Serial Communications Units with lot number 991220 (12/20/99) and later support the high-  
speed 1:N NT Link. Boards and Units with earlier lot numbers cannot be used.  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Model List  
Appendix J  
RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter  
Model  
Specification  
NT-AL001  
RS-232C: 9-pin connector  
RS-422A: 8-pin terminal block  
RS-232C Adaptor, RS-422A Adaptor  
Model  
Specification  
CPM1-CIF01  
Links the RS-232C port of an NT631/NT631C and the peripheral port of a CPM1,  
CPM2A, CPM2C, or SRM1 (compatible with host link, and NT Link (1:1))  
CPM1-CIF11  
Links the RS-422A port of an NT631/NT631C and the peripheral port of a CPM1,  
CPM2A, CPM2C, SRM1 (compatible with host link)  
Related Parts and Equipment for PT  
Name  
Model  
Remark  
Support Tool*  
NT-ZJCAT1-EV4  
Compatible with PC/AT personal computers  
For Windows 95/98/NT4.0/2000/XP (English version)  
CD-ROM  
Options  
NT631C-CFL01  
NT631C-CFL02  
NT610C-KBA04  
NT625-KBA01  
NT-MF261  
Replaceable backlight (for NT631C-ST151@-EV1)  
Replaceable backlight (for NT631C-ST141@-EV1)  
Reflection suppressing protective sheet for NT631/NT631C  
Chemical-resistant cover for NT631/NT631C  
Memory Unit for NT631/NT631C  
3G2A9-BAT08  
Spare battery  
Reference: The Support Tool indicated above includes the system installer and the standard system programs  
(Ver. 3.@/Ver. 4.@) for the NT31, NT31C, NT631, and NT631C. System programs for the earlier  
NT30/620 PTs are also included.  
Cables with Connectors for PT PLC/NT-AL001  
Model  
Cable Length  
Applicable Units  
Host Link Units with a 25-pin con- Serial port A host link  
nector (RS-232C only)  
Host lInk Units with a 9-pin con- Serial port A host link, NT link  
Communications Method  
Specification  
XW2Z-200S 2 m  
XW2Z-500S 5 m  
9-pin 25-pin  
XW2Z-200T  
XW2Z-500T  
2 m  
5 m  
9-pin 9-pin  
nector  
(1:1) (RS-232C only)  
XW2Z-S002 2 m  
Personal computer with a 9-pin  
connector  
Serial port A for using NT Sup-  
port Tool  
9-pin 9-pin  
Note The following PLCs can supply +5 V: C200HX/HG/HE(-Z)E, CQM1H, CPM2A, CPM2C, CS1G/H/D, and  
CJ1G/H/M.  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Model List  
Appendix J  
Cables with Connectors for Connecting PT and Personal Computer  
Model  
CV500-CN228  
Cable Length  
Specification  
25-pin (male) 9-pin (male)  
9-pin (female) 9-pin (male)  
2 m  
2 m  
XW2Z-S002  
Connection Cable  
Model  
Specification  
AWG28×5P IFVV-SB  
CO-MA-VV-SB 5P×28AWG  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Fujikura, Ltd.  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
Applicable Connectors  
Name  
Model  
Specification  
25-pin type (male), made by OMRON  
Connector  
XM2A-2501  
XM2D-2501  
XM2A-0901  
XM2D-0901  
DB-25P  
25-pin type (female), made by OMRON (for personal computers)  
9-pin type (male), made by OMRON  
9-pin type (female), made by OMRON (for personal computers)  
25-pin type (male), made by JAE  
Connector hood  
XM2S-2511  
XM2S-2513  
XM2S-0911  
25-pin type, mm pitch screw, made by OMRON  
25-pin type, inch pitch screw, made by OMRON  
9-pin type, mm pitch screw, made by OMRON  
XM2S-0911-E 9-pin type, mm pitch screw, made by OMRON  
XM2S-0913  
DB-C2-J9  
9-pin type, inch pitch screw, made by OMRON  
25-pin type, made by JAE  
Printer Cable  
Model  
Specification  
NT-CNT121  
Printer cable for half pitch (1.5 m), made by OMRON  
Cable for Peripheral Port of CS/CJ-series PLC  
Model  
CS1W-CN118  
Specification  
Made by OMRON (CS-series peripheral port D-sub, 9-pin, female)  
Connecting Cable for the CPM2C Communications Connector  
Model  
CPM2C-CN111  
Specification  
Made by OMRON (CPM2C communications port D-sub, 9-pin, female, C-series periph-  
eral port)  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix K  
Option List  
Replaceable Backlights ... NT631C-CFL01 (for NT631C-ST151@-EV2)  
These are backlights for NT631C for replacement purposes. Two pieces make a set.  
Replaceable Backlights ... NT631C-CFL02 (for NT631C-ST141@-EV2)  
Protective Sheet ... NT610C-KBA04  
Stuck to the display to prevent irregular reflection or contamination. The entire sheet is colorless and transpar-  
ent. The five sheets make a set.  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Option List  
Appendix K  
Chemical-resistant Cover ... NT625-KBA01  
Covers the front panel and protects it from various chemical agents. The entire sheet is milky white and made  
of silicone rubber.  
The sheet offers protection against the following chemical agents.  
Protects against  
Does not protect against  
Hexane  
Boric acid  
Sulfuric acid  
Nitrogen  
Lubricating oil  
Benzene  
Ammonia gas  
Carbonic acid gas  
Phenol  
Butane  
Carbonic acid  
Chlorinated solvents  
Napthalene  
Soy bean oil  
Toluene  
Glycerin  
Ammonia water  
Calcium chloride  
Developing fluid (hypo)  
Acetaldehyde  
Lard  
For information on chemical agents not listed in the table above, please inquire whether or not protection is  
offered (if the chemical agent is one against which silicone rubber is recognized as offering protection, please  
use this product even if the agent is not listed in the “Protects against” column of the table above).  
Replacement Battery ... 3G2A9-BAT08  
This is a lithium battery used for memory backup.  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Option List  
Appendix K  
Memory Unit ... NT-MF261  
This is a dedicated unit for reading/writing the screen data and the system programs in an NT631/NT631C.  
Data is transmitted by DIP switch setting at the Memory Unit.  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Option List  
Appendix K  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Comm. A Method, 153  
Comm. B Method, 153  
Comm. B Select, 153  
Communications Board, 62, 66, 70, 95  
Communications Boards, 106  
Communications by Using Memory Link, 21  
Numerics  
1:N connection among RS-422A ports, 119  
1:N connection among RS-485 ports, 121  
1:N connection between RS-422A/485 at the NT631/  
NT631C and RS-232C at the host, 86  
Communications condition settings for bar code readers,  
A
Allowable power supply voltage range, 245  
Applicable connectors, 286  
Communications condition settings for the host link method,  
153  
Automatic transmission (memory unit), 41  
Communications method for communications with the host,  
152  
B
Communications method settings, 154  
Communications methods, 26  
Communications port, 26  
Communications specifications, 250  
Communications type, 26  
Backlight (for NT631C only), 235  
Backlight brightness adjustment, 189  
Battery cover, 30  
Before operating, 23  
Communications Unit, 281  
Comparison between NT631 and NT631C, 7  
Connecting a bar code reader, 36  
Connecting a printer, 36  
Connecting directly between RS-232C ports, 73  
Connecting to other model PLCs, 21  
Connecting to the Support Tool, 35  
Connection cable, 286  
C
Cable connection dimensions, 257  
Cable for peripheral port of CS1-series PLC, 286  
Cables with connectors, 285  
Calling the System Installer mode, 134  
Calling the System Menu, 133  
Cell size (Touch panel), 248  
Connection method, 26  
Changing the system settings, 147  
Checking communications at serial ports, 210  
Checking communications with a printer, 213  
Checking communications with the Support Tool, 209  
Checking interfaces, 209  
Contrast adjustment, 187  
CPU Unit, 95  
CPU Units, 62, 66, 70, 106, 108, 112  
CPU Units connectable with Host Link Units or Communi-  
cations Board, 95  
Checking screen data, 198  
Checking the backlight (for NT631 only), 204  
Checking the battery voltage, 208  
Checking the buzzer, 202  
Checking the LCD (screen display), 204  
Checking the PT setting status, 193  
Checking the RUN LED, 203  
D
Device check, 201  
Device Monitor function, 220  
Dimensions, 245  
Direct connection function, 18  
Disabling/enabling System Menu display, 147  
Disabling/enabling writing to the screen data memory, 147  
Display, 29  
Display color, 247  
Display device, 247  
Checking touch switches, 207  
Chemical-resistant cover, 288  
Cleaning method, 242  
Clearing screen data, 135, 148  
Clearing/installing the system program, 145  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Display specifications, 247  
Installation environment, 32  
Displaying and printing the display history record, 194  
Displaying/setting the calendar and clock, 191  
Downloading the system program, 146  
Installation in the operation panel, 32  
L
Life expectancy (backlight), 247  
Life expectancy (display panel), 247  
Life expectancy (touch panel), 248  
E
Effective display area, 247  
Enclosure ratings, 245  
Error messages, 229  
M
Errors in the system installer mode and their remedies, 232  
Errors occurring at start of operation, 229  
Maintenance Mode, 132  
Making the cable, 267  
Making the cable for connecting a PLC, 271  
Making the cable for connection to a bar code reader, 273  
Making the cable for connection to a printer, 275  
Manual transmission (memory unit), 43  
Manuals, 23  
Errors occurring on screen data initialization and transmis-  
sion, 232  
Errors when using a memory unit, 45  
Expansion interface connector, 30  
Expansion Mode, 132  
External interface specifications, 248, 249  
Memory initialization, 135  
Memory link method, 73, 114  
Memory switch, 152  
Memory switch setting screen, 164  
Memory unit, 289  
F
Functional ground terminal, 34  
Menu tree, 132  
Mounting dimensions, 256  
G
General specifications, 245  
GR terminal, 30  
Grounding, 34, 245  
N
Noise resistance, 245  
NT link, 19  
NT link (1:1) method, 61  
high-speed, 70, 112  
NT-AL001, 259  
Number of dots, 247  
H
Host link, 19  
Host link method, 48, 94  
Host link unit, 48, 281  
Number of switches (touch panel), 248  
I
O
I/O settings, 187  
In the panel, 4  
Operating ambient humidity, 245  
Operating ambient temperature, 245  
Operating environment, 245  
Operating force, 248  
Operation at startup, 129  
Operation modes, 130  
Initializing alarm history record data, 138  
Initializing display history record data, 137  
Initializing the memory switches, 143  
Initializing the memory tables, 141  
Initializing the recipe tables, 140  
Inspection method, 243  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Serial port B, 18, 26  
Serial port B connector, 30  
P
Peripheral devices that can be connected, 17  
Power consumption, 245  
Power input terminals, 30  
POWER LED, 29  
Power supply connection, 33  
Set, 155  
Setting "Screen Saver Movement", 170  
Setting the "Buzzer Sound", 166  
Setting the "Key Press Sound", 166  
Setting the "Print Method", 169  
Setting the "Printer Controller", 168  
Setting the "Start-up Wait Time", 165  
Setting the automatic reset function, 179  
Setting the bar code reader input function, 184  
Precautions to be observed when transmitting screen data,  
151  
Principal Functions of NT631/NT631C, 10  
Printer cable, 286  
Printer connector, 30  
Programming console function, 214  
Protective sheet, 287  
Setting the conditions for communications with the memory  
Setting the display language in the System Installer mode,  
144  
PT, 281  
Setting the history display method, 175  
Setting the host link method, 155  
Setting the Memory Link Method, 160  
Setting the NT link (1:1) method, 157  
Setting the NT link (1:N) method, 158  
Setting the resume function, 177  
Setting the retry count, 182  
Setting the screen saver start-up time, 173  
Setting the terminal resistance, 92, 124  
Setting the time-out interval, 181  
Shock resistance (operating), 245  
Special features, 249  
R
Rated power supply voltage, 245  
Recipe function, 6  
Recommended printers, 36  
Relationship between system program and hardware, 277  
Relationships among modes, 130  
Replaceable backlight, 287  
Replacement battery, 288  
Replacing the backlight, 236  
Replacing the battery, 241  
Reset switch, 30  
RS-232C adaptor, 285  
RS-422A adaptor, 285  
RUN, 130  
RUN LED, 29  
Starting operation, 163  
Starting the NT31/NT31C, 129  
Storage ambient temperature, 245  
Support Tool, 285  
Switching from the System Menu to the RUN mode, 135  
Switching to the RUN mode, 163  
System configuration, 16  
RUN mode, 130  
System Installer Mode, 130  
System Menu, 130  
S
T
Screen data composition and transmission units, 150  
Screen data memory check, 205  
Selecting menu items, 134  
Terminal resistance setting terminals, 92  
Transmit Mode, 131  
Serial Communications Board, 48, 66, 70, 94  
Serial Communications Unit, 48  
Serial port A, 18, 26  
Transmitting the screen data, 149  
Transporting and Storing the NT631/NT631C, 265  
Serial port A connector, 30  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
U
Usable systems (programming console function), 215  
Using a Memory Unit (NT631/NT631C with V1), 39  
Using an RS-232C/RS-422A Adapter, 259  
V
Vibration resistance (operating), 245  
View angle, 247  
W
Warning label, 30  
waterproof, 4  
Weight, 245  
294  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Revision History  
A manual revision code appears as a suffix to the catalog number on the front cover of the manual.  
Cat. No. V063-E1-03  
Revision code  
The following table outlines the changes made to the manual during each revision. Page numbers refer to the  
previous version.  
Revision code  
Date  
Revised content  
1
July 2000  
June 2004  
Original production  
02  
CS1 was changed to CS, and the abbreviation for Programmable Controllers was unified to  
PLC.  
The following changes were also made.  
Page 4: Added new models and details on battery replacement.  
Page 5: Added new models to table.  
Page 22: Corrected and added information on reference manuals to table.  
Page 27: Added new models to table.  
Page 32: Added information for new models to table, added note on recommended terminals,  
removed Note 1, and also Fig.(a) from Note 3.  
Page 36: Added new models to introduction for 3-5.  
Pages 71 and 73: Added information on connecting the PT.  
Page 76: Added CS-series PLC to diagram.  
Page 79: Added information on cables for CS-series CPU Units.  
Page 85: Changed information on shielding, and corrected diagram.  
Page 86: Removed information on cables with connectors.  
Page 87: Removed information on cables with connectors, and added information on cables for  
CS-series CPU Units.  
Pages 89, 90, and 91: Changed information on shielding, and corrected diagrams.  
Pages 92 and 93: Removed information on cables with connectors.  
Pages 113, 114, 115, 116, 117, 118, 119, and 120: Changed information on shielding, and  
corrected diagrams.  
Page 122: Added sub-section on shielding.  
Page 140: Added information on System Installer mode versions.  
Page 174: Corrected “0” to “1” in the time-out interval setting range.  
Page 175: Removed 00 from the setting sequence in the diagram.  
Page 183: Added new model numbers.  
Page 213: Added information on CS1G/CS1H connections and changed “can” to “cannot” in  
final paragraph.  
Pages 214 and 219: Changed “can” to “cannot” in *1, and changed note on error screen.  
Page 218: Changed note on error screen.  
Page 229: Added information to touch switch operation.  
Page 232: Added information on backlight replacement for new models.  
Page 235: Changed “NT631C” to “PT” in step 1.  
Page 239: Changed and added information in table on power supply voltage and backlight  
brightness.  
Page 241: Changed specifications tables to add information on new models, and added dia-  
gram.  
Page 242: Changed specifications tables to add information on new models.  
Page 243: Added model number.  
Page 255: Changed “JIS C0911” to “JIS C0040” and “JIS C0912” to “JIS C0041” in table.  
Page 263: Changed diagrams and added note.  
Pages 269, 270, 271, and 273: Added model numbers.  
03  
September 2007 New models added, descriptions added, and errors corrected.  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Revision History  
296  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Terms and Conditions of Sale  
1. Offer; Acceptance. These terms and conditions (these "Terms") are deemed  
part of all quotes, agreements, purchase orders, acknowledgments, price lists,  
catalogs, manuals, brochures and other documents, whether electronic or in  
writing, relating to the sale of products or services (collectively, the "Products")  
by Omron Electronics LLC and its subsidiary companies (“Omron”). Omron  
objects to any terms or conditions proposed in Buyer’s purchase order or other  
documents which are inconsistent with, or in addition to, these Terms.  
2. Prices; Payment Terms. All prices stated are current, subject to change with-  
out notice by Omron. Omron reserves the right to increase or decrease prices  
on any unshipped portions of outstanding orders. Payments for Products are  
due net 30 days unless otherwise stated in the invoice.  
ITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OF THE PRODUCTS.  
BUYER ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT ALONE HAS DETERMINED THAT THE  
PRODUCTS WILL SUITABLY MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF THEIR  
INTENDED USE. Omron further disclaims all warranties and responsibility of  
any type for claims or expenses based on infringement by the Products or oth-  
erwise of any intellectual property right. (c) Buyer Remedy. Omron’s sole obli-  
gation hereunder shall be, at Omron’s election, to (i) replace (in the form  
originally shipped with Buyer responsible for labor charges for removal or  
replacement thereof) the non-complying Product, (ii) repair the non-complying  
Product, or (iii) repay or credit Buyer an amount equal to the purchase price of  
the non-complying Product; provided that in no event shall Omron be responsi-  
ble for warranty, repair, indemnity or any other claims or expenses regarding  
the Products unless Omron’s analysis confirms that the Products were prop-  
erly handled, stored, installed and maintained and not subject to contamina-  
tion, abuse, misuse or inappropriate modification. Return of any Products by  
Buyer must be approved in writing by Omron before shipment. Omron Compa-  
nies shall not be liable for the suitability or unsuitability or the results from the  
use of Products in combination with any electrical or electronic components,  
circuits, system assemblies or any other materials or substances or environ-  
ments. Any advice, recommendations or information given orally or in writing,  
are not to be construed as an amendment or addition to the above warranty.  
See http://www.omron247.com or contact your Omron representative for pub-  
lished information.  
3. Discounts. Cash discounts, if any, will apply only on the net amount of invoices  
sent to Buyer after deducting transportation charges, taxes and duties, and will  
be allowed only if (i) the invoice is paid according to Omron’s payment terms  
and (ii) Buyer has no past due amounts.  
4. Interest. Omron, at its option, may charge Buyer 1-1/2% interest per month or  
the maximum legal rate, whichever is less, on any balance not paid within the  
stated terms.  
5. Orders. Omron will accept no order less than $200 net billing.  
6. Governmental Approvals. Buyer shall be responsible for, and shall bear all  
costs involved in, obtaining any government approvals required for the impor-  
tation or sale of the Products.  
7. Taxes. All taxes, duties and other governmental charges (other than general  
real property and income taxes), including any interest or penalties thereon, 14. Limitation on Liability; Etc. OMRON COMPANIES SHALL NOT BE LIABLE  
imposed directly or indirectly on Omron or required to be collected directly or  
indirectly by Omron for the manufacture, production, sale, delivery, importa-  
tion, consumption or use of the Products sold hereunder (including customs  
duties and sales, excise, use, turnover and license taxes) shall be charged to  
and remitted by Buyer to Omron.  
FOR SPECIAL, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES,  
LOSS OF PROFITS OR PRODUCTION OR COMMERCIAL LOSS IN ANY  
WAY CONNECTED WITH THE PRODUCTS, WHETHER SUCH CLAIM IS  
BASED IN CONTRACT, WARRANTY, NEGLIGENCE OR STRICT LIABILITY.  
Further, in no event shall liability of Omron Companies exceed the individual  
price of the Product on which liability is asserted.  
8. Financial. If the financial position of Buyer at any time becomes unsatisfactory  
to Omron, Omron reserves the right to stop shipments or require satisfactory 15. Indemnities. Buyer shall indemnify and hold harmless Omron Companies and  
security or payment in advance. If Buyer fails to make payment or otherwise  
comply with these Terms or any related agreement, Omron may (without liabil-  
ity and in addition to other remedies) cancel any unshipped portion of Prod-  
ucts sold hereunder and stop any Products in transit until Buyer pays all  
amounts, including amounts payable hereunder, whether or not then due,  
which are owing to it by Buyer. Buyer shall in any event remain liable for all  
unpaid accounts.  
their employees from and against all liabilities, losses, claims, costs and  
expenses (including attorney's fees and expenses) related to any claim, inves-  
tigation, litigation or proceeding (whether or not Omron is a party) which arises  
or is alleged to arise from Buyer's acts or omissions under these Terms or in  
any way with respect to the Products. Without limiting the foregoing, Buyer (at  
its own expense) shall indemnify and hold harmless Omron and defend or set-  
tle any action brought against such Companies to the extent based on a claim  
that any Product made to Buyer specifications infringed intellectual property  
rights of another party.  
9. Cancellation; Etc. Orders are not subject to rescheduling or cancellation  
unless Buyer indemnifies Omron against all related costs or expenses.  
10. Force Majeure. Omron shall not be liable for any delay or failure in delivery 16. Property; Confidentiality. Any intellectual property in the Products is the exclu-  
resulting from causes beyond its control, including earthquakes, fires, floods,  
strikes or other labor disputes, shortage of labor or materials, accidents to  
machinery, acts of sabotage, riots, delay in or lack of transportation or the  
requirements of any government authority.  
sive property of Omron Companies and Buyer shall not attempt to duplicate it  
in any way without the written permission of Omron. Notwithstanding any  
charges to Buyer for engineering or tooling, all engineering and tooling shall  
remain the exclusive property of Omron. All information and materials supplied  
by Omron to Buyer relating to the Products are confidential and proprietary,  
and Buyer shall limit distribution thereof to its trusted employees and strictly  
prevent disclosure to any third party.  
11. Shipping; Delivery. Unless otherwise expressly agreed in writing by Omron:  
a.Shipments shall be by a carrier selected by Omron; Omron will not drop ship  
except in “break down” situations.  
b. Such carrier shall act as the agent of Buyer and delivery to such carrier shall 17. Export Controls. Buyer shall comply with all applicable laws, regulations and  
constitute delivery to Buyer;  
licenses regarding (i) export of products or information; (iii) sale of products to  
“forbidden” or other proscribed persons; and (ii) disclosure to non-citizens of  
regulated technology or information.  
c. All sales and shipments of Products shall be FOB shipping point (unless oth-  
erwise stated in writing by Omron), at which point title and risk of loss shall  
pass from Omron to Buyer; provided that Omron shall retain a security inter- 18. Miscellaneous. (a) Waiver. No failure or delay by Omron in exercising any right  
est in the Products until the full purchase price is paid;  
d.Delivery and shipping dates are estimates only; and  
e.Omron will package Products as it deems proper for protection against nor-  
mal handling and extra charges apply to special conditions.  
and no course of dealing between Buyer and Omron shall operate as a waiver  
of rights by Omron. (b) Assignment. Buyer may not assign its rights hereunder  
without Omron's written consent. (c) Law. These Terms are governed by the  
law of the jurisdiction of the home office of the Omron company from which  
Buyer is purchasing the Products (without regard to conflict of law princi-  
ples). (d) Amendment. These Terms constitute the entire agreement between  
Buyer and Omron relating to the Products, and no provision may be changed  
or waived unless in writing signed by the parties. (e) Severability. If any provi-  
sion hereof is rendered ineffective or invalid, such provision shall not invalidate  
any other provision. (f) Setoff. Buyer shall have no right to set off any amounts  
against the amount owing in respect of this invoice. (g) Definitions. As used  
herein, “including” means “including without limitation”; and “Omron Compa-  
nies” (or similar words) mean Omron Corporation and any direct or indirect  
subsidiary or affiliate thereof.  
12. Claims. Any claim by Buyer against Omron for shortage or damage to the  
Products occurring before delivery to the carrier must be presented in writing  
to Omron within 30 days of receipt of shipment and include the original trans-  
portation bill signed by the carrier noting that the carrier received the Products  
from Omron in the condition claimed.  
13. Warranties. (a) Exclusive Warranty. Omron’s exclusive warranty is that the  
Products will be free from defects in materials and workmanship for a period of  
twelve months from the date of sale by Omron (or such other period expressed  
in writing by Omron). Omron disclaims all other warranties, express or implied.  
(b) Limitations. OMRON MAKES NO WARRANTY OR REPRESENTATION,  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, ABOUT NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABIL-  
Certain Precautions on Specifications and Use  
1. Suitability of Use. Omron Companies shall not be responsible for conformity  
with any standards, codes or regulations which apply to the combination of the  
Product in the Buyer’s application or use of the Product. At Buyer’s request,  
ADDRESS THE RISKS, AND THAT THE OMRON’S PRODUCT IS PROP-  
ERLY RATED AND INSTALLED FOR THE INTENDED USE WITHIN THE  
OVERALL EQUIPMENT OR SYSTEM.  
Omron will provide applicable third party certification documents identifying 2. Programmable Products. Omron Companies shall not be responsible for the  
ratings and limitations of use which apply to the Product. This information by  
itself is not sufficient for a complete determination of the suitability of the Prod- 3. Performance Data. Data presented in Omron Company websites, catalogs  
user’s programming of a programmable Product, or any consequence thereof.  
uct in combination with the end product, machine, system, or other application  
or use. Buyer shall be solely responsible for determining appropriateness of  
the particular Product with respect to Buyer’s application, product or system.  
Buyer shall take application responsibility in all cases but the following is a  
non-exhaustive list of applications for which particular attention must be given:  
and other materials is provided as a guide for the user in determining suitabil-  
ity and does not constitute a warranty. It may represent the result of Omron’s  
test conditions, and the user must correlate it to actual application require-  
ments. Actual performance is subject to the Omron’s Warranty and Limitations  
of Liability.  
(i) Outdoor use, uses involving potential chemical contamination or electrical 4. Change in Specifications. Product specifications and accessories may be  
interference, or conditions or uses not described in this document.  
(ii) Use in consumer products or any use in significant quantities.  
(iii) Energy control systems, combustion systems, railroad systems, aviation  
systems, medical equipment, amusement machines, vehicles, safety equip-  
ment, and installations subject to separate industry or government regulations.  
(iv) Systems, machines and equipment that could present a risk to life or prop-  
erty. Please know and observe all prohibitions of use applicable to this Prod-  
uct.  
changed at any time based on improvements and other reasons. It is our prac-  
tice to change part numbers when published ratings or features are changed,  
or when significant construction changes are made. However, some specifica-  
tions of the Product may be changed without any notice. When in doubt, spe-  
cial part numbers may be assigned to fix or establish key specifications for  
your application. Please consult with your Omron’s representative at any time  
to confirm actual specifications of purchased Product.  
5. Errors and Omissions. Information presented by Omron Companies has been  
checked and is believed to be accurate; however, no responsibility is assumed  
for clerical, typographical or proofreading errors or omissions.  
NEVER USE THE PRODUCT FOR AN APPLICATION INVOLVING SERIOUS  
RISK TO LIFE OR PROPERTY OR IN LARGE QUANTITIES WITHOUT  
ENSURING THAT THE SYSTEM AS A WHOLE HAS BEEN DESIGNED TO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OMRON ELECTRONICS LLC  
1 Commerce Drive  
Schaumburg, IL 60173  
847.843.7900  
For US technical support or  
other inquiries: 800.556.6766  
OMRON CANADA, INC.  
885 Milner Avenue  
Toronto, Ontario M  
1B  
5V8  
416.286.6465  
OMRON ON-LINE  
Global - www.omron.com  
USA - www.omron247.com  
Canada - www.omron.ca  
Brazil - www.omron.com.br  
Latin America - www.espanol.omron.com  
UNITED STATES  
To locate a Regional Sales Office, local Distributor or  
to obtain product information, call: 847.843.7900  
MEXICO SALES OFFICES  
Mexico, D.F.  
Ciudad Juárez  
Monterrey, N.L  
Querétaro  
555.660.3144  
656.623.7083  
818.377.4281  
442.135.4510  
BRAZIL SALES OFFICE  
Sao Paulo  
55.11.2101.6310  
ARGENTINA SALES OFFICE  
Cono Sur  
54.114.787.1129  
OTHER LATIN AMERICAN SALES  
V063-E1-03  
©2008 OMRON ELECTRONICS LLC  
Specifications subject to change without notice.  
Printed in the U.S.A.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Washer t 250 c User Manual
NAD Universal Remote HTR 2 User Manual
NetComm Telephone V90 User Manual
NETGEAR Network Router JWNR2010v3 User Manual
Nextar Speaker NXBT 001 User Manual
Optimus Clock Radio 12 1610 User Manual
Optimus Microcassette Recorder 14 1180 User Manual
Oster Fryer CKSTDFZM70 User Manual
Panasonic Ventilation Hood FV 11VH2 User Manual
Paradyne Network Card DMD15 User Manual